Charles Steinmetz Radiation Light and Illumination
Charles Steinmetz Radiation Light and Illumination
Charles Steinmetz Radiation Light and Illumination
0000102080645
pflggf.
Keep Your
fcfl'g
in
This Pocket
PUBLIC LIBRARY
Kansas
City,
No*
ffWUWffljff
njlWr
^fWf ^p
p|
^pp^f
p ^Pl^^^pp'
KANSAS
CITY,
MO
PUBLIC LIBRARY
AND
BY
A.M., PH.D.
THIRD EDITION
McGRAW-HILL BOOK COMPANY, INC. 239 WEST 39TH STREET. NEW YORK
LONDON: HILL PUBLISHING
6
CO., LTD.
&
BOUVERIE
ST.. E. C.
1918
INC.
AUTHOR'S PREFACE.
THE following lectures were given as a course of instruction to the senior students in electrical engineering at Union University. They are however intended not merely as a text-book of
illuminating engineering, nor as a text-book on the physics of light and radiation, but rather as an exposition, to some extent,
from the engineering point of view, of that knowledge of light and radiation which every educated man should possess, the engineer as well as the physician or the user of light. For this purpose they are given in such form as to require no special knowledge of mathematics or of engineering, but mathematical formalism has been avoided and the phenomena have been described in plain language, with the exception of Lectures and XI, which by their nature are somewhat mathematical, and are intended more particularly for the illuminating engineer, but which the general reader may safely omit or merely peruse the
text.
The
lectures
the important results of the work of the National Bureau of Standards, contained in its recent bulletins, fully utilized.
COMPILER'S PREFACE.
A SERIES
tion" were
of eight experimental lectures on "Light and Radiadelivered by Dr. Steinmetz in the winter of 1907-8
Unfortunately no no was and manuscript prepared by the present stenographer A far more extended course of experimental lectures lecturer. was however given by Dr. Steinmetz at Union University in the winter of 1908-9, on "Radiation, Light, Illumination and Illu" and has been compiled and edited in minating Engineering,
before the Brooklyn Polytechnic Institute.
by
Dr. Stein-
complete even from on the theoretical side of illuminating engineering: Lecture XI on Flux and Distribution" and Lecture "Light "Light
of the subject
Intensity
and Illumination."
element^ of the
With the exception of the latter two lectures the following book contains practically no mathematics, but discusses the subjects in plain and generally understood language. The subject matter of Lecture XII on "Illumination anc
Illuminating Engineering" has been given in a paper before th< Illuminating Engineering Society; the other lectures are ne^
in their
form and, as I
believe, to
ir
their contents.
experiments convenient for the reader or lecturer. Great thanks are due to the technical staff of the McGraw-Hil Book Company, which has spared no effort to produce the boo!
in as perfect a
manner
as possible.
JOSEPH L. R. HAYDEN.
SCHENECTADY, September, 1909.
CONTENTS.
I.
1.
Radiation as energy.
2.
3.
4.
Measurement of the velocity of light. Nature of light. Difference of wave length with differences of urement of wave length and of frequency. The ether.
refraction.
2 4
color.
Meas6
Iridescence.
5. Polarization
Double
7
6.
The
radiation.
7.
9 15
octaves.
8.
16
VECTURE
II.
9. Electric
waves
of
mixed
20 21
frequency.
10.
Refraction.
11.
12.
13.
24 25
Band spectrum.
26 29 30
31
and transmission.
light.
Opaque
18. 19.
and transparent colors. and subjective color. color Objective Effect of excess and of deficiency of certain wave length of the illuminant on the opaque and the transparent
colors
colors.
vii
32
33
34
viii
CONTENTS.
PAGE
III.
LECTURE
Visibility.
20.
The
eye.
sensitivity of the
37
21.
Dependence of
ical
eye on the
color.
Mechan40
equivalent of light.
Comparison
of intensities of
different colors.
eye for different intensities. of of 23. Change sensitivity curve with intensity. shape 24. Harmful effect of excessive radiation power.
22. Sensitivity curves of
43
45 48 50
51
25. Protective action of eye. 26. Specific high frequency effect beginning in blue. Harmful effects of ultra27. Perception of ultra-violet light.
violet.
52
55
Pathological
29.
and Therapeutic
effect
Effects of Radiation.
Power
and
specific
high frequency
effect.
57
59
and
disinfectant.
LECTURE IV.
Chemical
Effects.
by energy
of radiation.
Direct
chemical action.
32.
03
Destructive notion of high frequency
64
Physical Effects.
33. Fluorescence
and phosphorescence.
66
LECTUKE V.
TEMPKHATUKK RAWATION.
by boat, and frequency with temperature.
70
73
and temperature, Carbon incandescent lamp. 38. Evaporation below boiling point.
37.
70
78
Allotropic modifications
of carbon.
39.
40.
41.
HI
42.
Normal temperature radiation, Colored body radiation. Measurement of temperatures by radiation, Colored radiation and heat luminescence.
M
85
89
90
CONTENTS.
LECTURE VI.
LUMINESCENCE.
Ix
PAGE
Fluorescence and Phorphorescenee.
43. Radioluminescence.
Electroluminescence.
ThermolumiChemical phos94 96
98
nescence.
Physical
phosphorescence.
phorescence.
Biological phosphorescence.
44. Pyroluminescence.
Chemical luminescence.
and vapors.
"
Disruptive Conduction.
46. Geissler
47.
Disruptive voltage.
101
105
Continuous Conduction.
48.
49. Distinction
50.
106
Ill
113
by
arcs,
117
122
123
and
color.
53.
Most
54. Electro-conduction
life,
non-consuming
125 126
positive, limitation in the available materials. 55. Arc most efficient method of light production.
LECTURE VII.
56.
FLAMES AS ILLUMINANTS.
128
Hydrocarbon flames.
combustion and of flame shape on
smokiness.
130 132
air.
58. Effect of
luminosity.
59.
60. 61.
134
135
LECTURE VIII.
63.
Stability
142
145
Maximum efficiency length of carbon arc, Maximum efficiency length of luminous arc.
146
148
X
LECTURE VIII.
Arc Lamps.
68.
CONTENTS.
PAGE
(Continued).
The elements
151
153
lamp.
157 160
Arc
Circuits.
72.
Constant potential and constant current. arc rectifier system. The arc machine.
The mercury
160
163
73.
LECTURE IX.
74.
109
170
.172
78.
Comparison of
lights,
79. Flicker
photometer.
178
80. 81.
82.
The luminometer.
Primary standards of light. Proposed primary standards. Illumination and total flux of
photometry. Arc lamp photometry.
175
177
178
light.
83.
Incandescent lamp
179
182
84.
85. Discussion.
Mean
spherical, horizontal,
downwards, maxi184
mum,
LECTURE X.
88.
Symmetrical and approximately symmetrical distribution. Calculation of light flux from meridian cum of Asymmetrical radiator.
188
of
distribution curves.
Point or sphere of
190
tOfi
uniform brilliancy.
90. Straight line or cylindrical radiator, 91. Circular line or cylinder.
197
illustration*
lamp as
200
CONTENTS.
LECTURE X.
Shadows.
93. Circular
tor.
xi
PAGE
meridian curves of a circular radiator, for different sizes of a symmetrical circular shade, and for
different distances of
it.
206
210
95. Circular
Reflection.
212 215
reflection.
Regular
reflection.
98. Reflector
218
Diffraction, Diffusion
99.
and Refraction.
of the illuminant.
221
on the
distribu-
and
reflection.
223 224
LECTURE XI.
102. Calculation of
illuminant for
uniform
.103.
total, horizontal
and
226 229
234
lamps.
105.
Combined
effect of successive
238
Room
242
246
251
from walls and ceiling. 108. Total directed and diffused illumination.
253
xii
CONTENTS.
ILLUMINATION AND ILLUMINATING ENGINEERING,
LECTURE XIL
110. Physical
256 259
and
walls.
Reflectors, diffus-
260
t
illumination.
Subjective
illumination.
Con201
traction of pupil.
direct lighting.
Intrinsic brilliancy.
203
and in
color.
Control of color
Directed and
Shadows and
their control.
205
207
mination,
118.
119.
20t)
Domestic
lighting.
270
of
272
27't
27<1
Tower
lighting.
LECTURE XIII.
PHWIOMXWM^ PHOUUOMB
OF
IU,UMINATW<
KNGINHBHING,
123. Physical Hide of illuminating engineering,
1'hysiologieal
problems,
32*1.
277
difleroneo
Physiological
light.
between
<Uffuno<l
ntul
(tireded
27K
125
HlmdowH
cant
by
dlffuwtl
4
Equivalent
dilTiiHion
nrar light
our< n
of
large extent.
270
by
in
using
wwrnl
light
wim%
(lomplex
2H1
Unociual
diffusion
different
<lin*ofionH.
2HH
2K<t
a vector quantity,
wmrmm,
287
AND
Radiation
is
a form of energy, and, as such, can be produced of energy and converted into other forms of
The most convenient form of energy for the production of radis heat energy, and radiation when destroyed by being intercepted by an opaque body, usually is converted into heat. Thus in an incandescent lamp, the heat energy produced by the
iation
into radiation.
electric current in the resistance of the filament, is converted If I hold hand near the lamp, the radiation
my
intercepted
by the hand
is
and
is felt
as such.
destroyed, that is, converted into heat, the lamp to the hand, how-
ever, the. energy is not heat but radiation, and a body which is transparent to the radiation may be interposed between the
perfectly cold.
7
The terms
"heat radiation'' and "radiant heat/ which are occasionally used, therefore are wrong: the so-called radiant heat is not heat but radiation energy, and becomes heat only when, intercepted by an opaque body, it ceases to be radiation; the same, however, If we do not feel the radiation of a applies to any radiation.
of the moon as heat, while we feel that of a merely because the total energy of the latter is very much greater; a sufficiently sensitive heat-measuring instrument, as a bolometer, shows the heat produced by the interception of the rays of the mercury lamp or the rays of the moon.
of radiation
is light,
and, therefore,
of radiation
this
2
2.
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
made by
The
first
from the astronomers in the middle of the eighteenth century, number of moons the of the Jupiter. observations of eclipses so close them of some the around planet Jupiter, of moons revolve so are and behind earth Jupiter the they pass that seen from moons of orbits the As Jupiter's revolution. eclipsed at every of gravitacalculated from their observations by the law
were
tion, the
moon
sight,
--r
x
FIG. 1.
could be exactly calculated. It was found, however, that sometimes the moon disappeared earlier, sometimes later than caland ktost disappearculated, and the difference between earliest also found that tho It min. was 17 about to amounts ance
omiirol earlior when disappearance of the moon behind Jupiter as of sun the wide same the at was the earth Jupiter, at A, while (Uirt.li wan on the the when occurred the latest disappearance in tho latter B. at from sun of the Now, Jupiter, opposite siclo diameter Uio from distant further is earth Jupilor by case, the or sun tho around earth of the orbit by about tf, ASB of the
must bo due to 195,000,000 miles and tho delay of 17} min. thus distance additional travenso to tho the the time taken by light 10>10 min. nre one-third and Seventeen of 195,000,000 miles.
sec.
..
,
(MO
sec.
light of
IIMU
Later, the velocity of light was measured directly in a number be a clwk perFor instance, let, in Fig. 2, of different ways. its light wends forated with holes at its periphery, lamp
through a hole
a con-
reflected
of the disk into the telescope T. i passes through another hole If the disk is turned half the pitch of the holes the light is blotted out as a tooth stands in front of both the lamp and the telescope. Again turning the disk half the pitch of the holes in the same
beam
of light
5j*I J?
U-=--r
rznnii
FIG.
2.
If the disk is slowly revolved, alternate light and darkness will be observed, but when the speed increases so that more than from 10 to 20 holes pass per second, the
eye is no longer able to distinguish the in-lividual flashes of light but sees a steady and uniform light; then increasing the speed still more the light grows fainter and finally entirely disappears.
This means
hole is in front of the lamp, a beam of Q the hole. light passes through During the time taken by the light to travel the 10 miles to the mirror and back, the disk has ff was in front of the which and the hole moved, telescope v when the light from the lamp passed through the hole Q has
when a
D
,
in front of the telescope and the at the speed at which the light light. Therefore, intercepts to move half the pitch of a disk time it takes the the disappears,
is
now
hole
equal to the time it takes the light to travel 10 miles. Increasing still further the velocity of the disk D, the light appears ag dn, and increases in brilliancy, reaching a maximum
is
at twice the speed at which it had disappeared. Then the light reflected from the mirror At again passes through the center of
a hole into the telescope, but not through the same hole H l through which it would have passed with the disk stationary, but through the next hole f/2 that IB, the disk has moved a distance
,
equal to the pitch of one hole while the light traveled 10 miles. has 200 holes and makes Assume; for instance, that the disk
94 rev. per
the light has again reached = 18,800 holes pass the 94 X 200 full brilliancy the time of motion by the pitch of one telescope per second, and
the
moment when
case,
In this
hole
is
18 800
;
S ec.,
and as
this is the
-^
^
is
The
For
empty
space, thus
the velocity of light, and there Herz, and found to be the same as travel with the same is very good evidence that all radiations through space (except perhaps the rays of radioactive
velocity
3.
substances).
of radiation,
that light rays consisted of proposed. Newton suggested off by the lightextremely minute material particles thrown that is, a kind of bomgiving bodies with enormous velocities, bardment. This theory has been revived in recent years to exthe radiations of radium, etc. Euler and others explained
plain
the light as a wave motion. Which of these explanations Ls correct can be experimentally decided in the following manner: Assuming light to be a bombardment of minute particles, if wo combine two rays of light in the same path they must add to
each other, that is, two equal beams of light together give a beam of twice the amplitude. If, however, wo assume light is a wave the motion, then two equal beams of light add to one of twice in A amplitude only in case the waves are in phase, as l and /^ not A 7i and are 2 2 If, however, the two beams Fig. 3 add to (7r their resultant C2 is less than their sum, and if the in
phase,
two beams
and
B3
in Fig. 3
happen to be iu opposition
(180 degrees apart), that is, one-half wave length out of phase with each other, their resultant Ls zero, that is, they blot each
other out.
(Fig. 4) and a illuminate and slightly curved plate 5, touching each other at C, as the them by a beam of uniform light yellow light given by coloring the flame of a bunsen burner with somo sodium Halt a part of the light 6, is then reflected from the lower surface of
glass plate
reflected
beam
of
Ba
FIG. 3.
reflected light a, thus is a combination of a beam 6 and a beam c. The two beams of light which combine to a single one, a, differ
from each other in phase by twice the distance between the two At those points di9 d2 etc. at which the distance glass plates.
,
4,
between the two glass plates is } wave length, or f etc., the two component beams of a would differ by i, f |, etc. wave lengths, and thus would blot each other out, producing darkness,
,
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
while at those points where the distance between the glass plates is |, 1, Ij, etc. wave lengths, and the two component beams a
thus differ in phase by a full wave or a multiple thereof, they would add. If, therefore, light is a wave motion, such a structure would show the contact point C of the plates surrounded by This is actually the alternate dark rings, d, and bright rings, y. "interference" called this therefore and phenomenon, case, and has the universal lead to be a wave to motion, proves light
acceptance of the Eulerian theory. Measuring the curvature of the plate 5, and the diameter of the dark rings d, the distance between the plates B and A at the dark rings d, can be calculated and as this distance is one-
wave length, or an odd multiple thereof, the wave can be determined therefrom. length The wave length of light can be measured with extremely high accuracy and has been proposed as the absolute standard of 7 length, instead of the meter, which was intended to be 10~ of the quadrant of the earth. 4. It is found, however, that the different colors of light have different wave lengths; red light has the greatest wave length, and then in the following order: red, orange, yellow, green, blue, indigo, violet, the wave length decreases, violet light having the
quarter
shortest
If in
wave
length.
experiment (Fig. 4) instead of uniform light (monochromatic light), ordinary white light is used, which is a mixture of all colors, the dark and bright rings of the different colons appear at different distances from each other, those of the violet nearest and those of the red the furthest apart, and HO superimpose upon each other, and instead of alternately black and light ringH, colored rings appear, so-called interference rings. Wherever a
thin film of air or anything else of unequal thickness in interposod between two other materials, such interference colors tlmn
They show, for instance, between sheets of mica, etc. The colors of soap bubbles arc thus produced. The production of such colors by the interference of ray of
appear.
light differing from called iridescence.
many
butterflies, etc.
Is
Light, therefore,
a wave motion*
of light,
is
about
60 microcentimeters,* that is, 60 X 10~6 cm. (or about = 3 X 10 10 cm. the frequency innyffe in.) and since the speed is S o 12 is / = r- = 500 X 10 or 500 millions of millions of cycles per
LW
second, that
is,
with which
If,
we
inconceivably high compared with the frequencies are familiar in alternating currents.
is a wave motion, there must be some thing a medium, and from the nature of the wave moving, its motion, extremely high velocity, follow the properties of this medium: it has an extremely high elasticity and extremely low
as proven, light
is
which
density,
and
it
must penetrate
this
it
all
substances since no
vacuum can
be produced for
medium, because light passes through any cannot be any known gas, but must be essentially different, and has been called the "ether." Whether the ether is a form of matter or not depends upon the definition of matter. If matter is defined as the (hypothetical) carrier of energy (and all the information we have of matter is that it is the seat of energy), then the ether is matter, as it is a carrier of energy: the energy of radiation, during the time between the moment when the wave leaves the radiator and the moment when it strikes a body and is absorbed, resides in the
vacuum.
Hence
ether.
a wave motion or vibration, it may be a longitudior a transversal vibration. Either the particles of nal vibration, which transmit the vibrations may move in the the medium the in wave travels, as is the case with sound which direction
5.
,
If light is
waves
in air.
If in Fig.
B in
to B.
the
beam
* As measures of the wave length of light, a number of metric units have survived and are liable to load to confusion: The micron, denoted by a, equal to one thousandth of a millimeter. The ftp, equal to one millionth of a millimeter. The Angstrom unit, equal to one ten-millionth of a millimeter. As seen, the basis of those units is the millimeter, which was temporarily used as a standard unit of length before the establishment of the present absolute system of units, the (C,G,S), which is based on centimeter length, gram mass, and second time measure. A radiation of the wave length of 60 microcentimeters thus can be expressed also as: 6000 Angstrom units, or 0.6 /x, or 600 pp.
8
of light
RADIATION, LIGHT,
moves
AND ILLUMINATION.
in Fig. 6 perpendicularly to the plane of the paper, the vibrating particles move in any one of the directions oa, ob, to the ray etc. in the plane of the paper, and thus perpendicular
FIG. 5.
of light.
In the former case (a longitudinal vibration, as sound) the directions at there obviously can be no difference between vibratransversal In a wave. motion of the right angles to the
tion,
may move
either irregularly in
any
to of the infinite number of directions at right angles thc^ray directions the different in exists no difference thus and 6) (Fig. or they may vibrate in one direction perpendicular to the beam In the latter case, the wave is as the direction boa (Fig. 7) only, * 11 // i j) i, _ _ .li-cr " called polarized" and has different characteristics in three directions at right angles to each other:
;
.
'
-i
FIG. 6,
FIG.
7.
pendicular to progression electric field of a conductor carrying alternating current is a to the conductor is the polarized wave the direction parallel direction of energy flow; the direction concentric to the con:
is the direction of of wave travel; the or propagation, of vibration direction the is second direction j is j lir( t the and perand to vibration. For instance, the
one direction
ductor
the direction of the electromagnetic component, and the direction radial to the conductor is the direction of the electrostatic component of the electric field. exTherefore, if light rays can be polarized, that Is, made to
is
hibit different properties in two directions at right angles to each other and to the direction of wave travel, thin would prove tfee the case. light wave to be a transversal vibration* This is actually For instance, ,if a beam of light is reflected a number of times
sharp angle, as shown in Fig. 8, this beam becomes polarized; that is, for instance, the reflection from the mirror o; which produced the polarization, set like the mirrors v 2 *
under a
fairly
m m
greater, and the absorption less than from a mirror set at right angles thereto, as w/. Some crystals, as Iceland spar (calcium carbonate) , show "double refraction/' that is, dissolve a beam of light, a, enter-
ing them, into two separate beams, b and c (Fig. 9) which are polarized at right angles to each other.
In a second crystal, beam & would then enter as a single 2J beam, under the same angle as in the first crystal v if 2 were in the same position as K^ while if K were turned at right angles z to v beam 6 would enter I 2 under the same angle as beam c in
crystal
6.
Kr
As
seen, light
and radiation
wave
10 3 X 10 cm. per sec. in a hypomotions of very high speed, S thetical medium, ether, which must be assumed to fill all space
and penetrate
"Radiation
all
substances.
as light, in a
12
narrow range of frequencies and 770 X 10 12 cycles per sec. cor6 c responding to wave lengths from 76 X 10~" cm. to 39 X 10~ cm.* All other radiations are invisible and thus have to be observed by other means. I have here a pair of rods of cast silicon (10 in. long, 0.22 in. in diameter, having a resistance of about 10 ohms each), connected
is visible,
10
* The 50 X 10"* visibility of radiation IB greatest between the wave lengths 8 8 to 60 X lO"" and good between the wave lengths 41 X 10" to 76 X 10""% but extends more or loss indistinctly ovor the range of wave lengths from 8 NT*. 10"* and faintly even as far as 30 X 10~ to 100 10~ to 77 33
10
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
40 ohms in series with each other and with a rheostat of about current a I establish When circuit. 120-volt resistance in a heat into converted is by the through the rods, electric energy and into converted is heat This rods. energy resistance of the off carried the of the with part exception sent out as radiation, and convection. Reducing the resistance, I
increase the heat,
Still
by heat conduction and thereby the radiation from the silicon rods.
nothing
is
visible
holdtoo low frequency, or great wave length, to be visible. By and show as the I feel can heat, the energy hand near rods, ing Crookes' to this near rods radiometer, the it to bringing
my
you by
FIG. 9.
an instrument showing the energy of radiation. It consists (Fig. 10) of four aluminum vanes, mounted in a moderately One side of each high vacuum so that they can move very easily. of radiation waves The other blackened. the vane is polished, the on blackened of Hide the the on are reflected vane; polished
which
is
side they are absorbed, produce heat, thus raise the temperature of the air near the vane ; the air expands and pushes the vanes ahead, As you see, when I bring the heated rotates the wheel that
is,
rods near the radiometer, the wheel spins around at a rapid rate by the radiation from the rods, which to the eye are invisible*
II
Increasing still further the energy input into the silicon rods, and thereby their temperature, the intensity of radiation increases, but at the same time radiations of higher and higher frequencies
appear, and ultimately the rods become visible in the dark, giving a dark red light; that is, of all the radiations sent out by the rods, a small part is of sufficiently high frequency to be visible.
Still
but the waves of high frequency increase more rapidly than those of lower frequency; that is, the average
frequency of radiation increases or the average wave length decreases and higher and higher frequencies orange rays, yellow, green, appear, blue, violet, and the color of the light thus gradually changes to
bright red, orange, yellow. Now I change over from the silicon rods
which are near the maximum temto a tungperature they can stand
sten
lamp (a 40-watt 110-volt lamp, connected in series with a rheostat of 2000 ohms resistance in a 240-
For comparison I also volt circuit)* turn on an ordinary 16 c. p. carbon filament incandescent lamp, running
normal voltage and giving its usual yellow light. Gradually turning out the resistance, the light of
at
from
FIG. 10.
yellowish white and ultimately, with all the resistance cut out and the filament running at more than double voltage, is practically white; that is, gives a radiation containing all the frequencies of visiIf ble light in nearly the same proportion as exist in sunlight. temand increase the further still wo should go very greatly perature, because of the more rapid increase of the higher frequencies (violet, blue, green) than the lower frequencies of light (red, orange and yellow) with increase in temperature, the light
orange to yellow,
12
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
light
However, we are close to the limit of even which tungsten can stand, and to show you temperature or short wave length I use a different of frequency
should become bluish.
high conversion of electric energy apparatus in which a more direct the takes into radiation mercury arc lamp. Here the place, is bluish green, containing only the highest frequencies
light of visible radiation, violet, blue and green, but practically none of the lower frequencies of visible radiation, red or orange.
A \
SJJJLQJU
....240-VOLT8-00 CYCLES
FIG. 11.
In the tungsten lamp at high brilliancy and more still in the mercury arc, radiations of higher frequencies appear, that in, shorter wave lengths than visible light, and these radiations arc again invisible. As they arc of frequencies boyomi the violet " rays of light, they arc called ultra- violet rays/' while tho radia-
which we produced from tho heated silicon rods at moderate temperatures were invisible because of too low frequency and
tions
outside of and
ultra-red rays/' or "infra-red rays/' as they are below the red end of the range of visible radiation.
"
To produce powerful ultra-violet rays, I use a condenser clis** charge between iron terminals, a so-called ultra-violet arc lamp. Three iron spheres, / in Fig. 11, of about f in. diameter, are mounted on an insulator B. The middle sphere is fixed, the
13
outer ones adjustable and set for about T3F in. gap. This lamp is connected across a high voltage 0.2-mf. mica condenser C, which
is
connected to the high voltage terminal of a small'step-up transformer T giving about 15,000 volts (200 watts, 110 + 13,200 The low tension side of the transformer is connected to volts).
the 240-volt 60-cycle circuit through a rheostat R to limit the The transformer charges the condenser, and when the current. voltage of the condenser has risen sufficiently high it discharges
through the spark gaps I by an oscillation of high frequency (about 500,000 cycles), then charges again from the transformer, discharges through the gap, etc. As several such condenser discharges occur during each half wave of alternating supply voltage
the light given by the discharge appears continuous. You see, however, that this iron arc gives apparently very little light; most of the radiation is ultra-violet, that is, invisible to the
eye.
To make
it visible,
called
a frequency
converter of radiation.
of willemite (native
I put it under zinc silicate), a dull greenish gray looking stone. the iron arc and it flashes up in a bright green glare by convert-
ing the higher frequency of ultra-violet rays into the lower frequency of green light. This green light is not given by the
iron arc, as a piece of white paper held under the arc shows only the faint illumination given by the small amount of visible radiation.
I
now move a
thin sheet of glass, or of mica, between the lump of willemite, and you see the green light
disappear as far as the glass casts a shadow. Thus glass or mica, while transparent to visible light, is opaque for the ultra-violet thick piece of crystallized gypsum (sellight of the iron arc. of the ultra-violet light does not stop it, in the onitc) put path
hence
is transparent, as the lump of willemite continues to show the green light, or a piece of cast glaSxS its blue light. I have here some pieces of willemite in a glass test tube. They appear dull and colorless in the ultra-violet light, as the glass is
opaque for this light. I shift them over into a test tube of fused quartz, and you sec them shine in the green glare. Quartz is transparent to ultra-violet light. When investigating ultra-violet light, quartz lenwes and prisms must, therefore, be used. Still higher frequencies of ultra-violet light than those given by a condenser discharge between iron terminals are produced by a low temperature mercury arc. Obviously this arc must not be
14
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
is
opaque
about
8
for these rays. These ultra-violet radiations carry us up to frequencies of 10 12 cycles per sec., or to wave lengths of about 10 3000
X KT
the highest Then, however, follows a wide gap, between the and radiation frequencies of X-rays. frequencies of ultra-violet someof radiations In this very interesting properties may
cm.
gap, times be found. At the extreme end of the scale we find the X-rays and the if indeed these radiations radiations of radio-active substances has been which questioned. Since at these are wave motions,
refraction cease, but extremely high frequencies reflection and
methods
of
measuring wave
quite lengths and frequencies difas a of atoms the and crystal of a range by using frequency as measured been has wave their length fraction grating, average 18 6 sec. 10 X 0.3 of a per cycles 0.1 X 10~ cm., giving frequency vibrations of greatly differing frequencies, the In
octave, that
is,
n octaves lower, a frequency (|) as high. By this .scale all the intervals are of the same character; one octave means the amo relative increase, which ever may be the absolute frequency or
One octave represents a doubling of the frequency of acoustics. n octaves higher then means a frequency 2 n times as high, n
centual change of the physical quantity causing the perception (Fechner's law), in the acoustic or logarithmic scale the steps are
by
them.
somewhat leas than one octave; observed beyond this for about have boon ultra-violet radiations Nine octaves two more octaves. higher is the estimate* frequency
The
of X-rays.
or
15
have been observed in the radiations of bodies of very low temperature, as liquid air, or in the moon's rays.
7.
electric
waves.
They
jmq
Iju&J
X
FIG. 12.
the condenser
of the
ultra-violet arc, to a spark gap v of which the one side is connected to ground v the other side to a vertical aluminum rod v
about 8 feet long. The charge and discharge of the aluminum rod A l by the oscillating condenser current, send out an electric, wave of about 50 feet length. This wave passes through you, and when striking the aluminum rod A 2 back of you, induces therein an electric charge. A 2 is separated from ground B2 by a narrow and the arrival of the spark gap C?2 between graphite terminals, to a small electric wave at A a causes jump across the gap spark the of 62 which closes the circuit tungsten lamp L, thereby continues. lighting it as Jong as the wave train
,
16
RADIATION, LIGHT,
The
electric
AND ILLUMINATION.
less to 10,000 feet or more, corresponding lengths from 100 feet or 5 7 or less. sec. to 10 to 10 cycles per are the fields of alternating curwaves Still very much longer electrostatic field of an alternaand rent circuits: the magnetic of radiation from the conductor, wave a as ting current progresses is But as the wave length very great, due to the low frequency, 1Q 3 X 10 _ i t ot wave a length current gives a 60-cycle alternating
500 X 10 cm. or 3100 miles the circuit extends is an insignificant of the length, and the wave propagation
6
thus
is
usually not
considered.
Electric
waves
of higher frequencies
Herzian waves, produced by electric telegraphy are the conductor cut in the tors, "that is, a moderately long straight as middle by a gap and terminated by spherical condensers^ of propagation On these waves the velocity 13. shown in
Fig.
BNERGY-SU PPUY" -
<
o
cycles, or 0.0
-o
FIG. 13,
has been measured by Herz by producing standing waves by combination of main wave and reflected wave. between the Still much higher frequoncieH arc the oscillations limit of frethe and arresters, of multi-gap lightning cylinders bo given by tho oscillaquency of electric waves would probably each other when small two of against spheres ting discharge l is at about 5 X 10 It narrow a probably gap. separated by
cm. wave length. The blank space between the shortest electric wave and the thun has become fairly narrow longest ultnwecl light wave four octavos about or from 0.0 to 0.03 cm., only known forms of radiadifferent tho 8. In tho tables,
following
tion are arranged
by their frequency and wave length, and are middle c of the in octaves, choosing as aero point the given also sec. of 128 cycles per piano, or a frequency
17
Speed of radiation S
These radiations are plotted graphically in Fig. 14, with the octave as abscissa). As seen, the total range of frequencies of radiation is enormous, covering nearly GO octaves, while the range of sound waves is only about nine octaves, from 15 to 8000 cycles. There are two blank spaces in the range of radiation, one between electric and light waves, and a second and longer one between
It
is
light
and X-rays.
waves
is
far
greater than that of light waves. Only a very narrow range of radiation, less than one octave out
of
a total of 60,
is visible.
It is
shown shaded
in Fig. 14.
This
18
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
exhibits the great difficulty of the problem of efficient light production: it means producing as large a part of the total radiation
as possible within this very narrow range of visibility. the eye thus Regarding the range of frequencies covered by it, ten octaves over hears which the than sensitive less ear, is much
as sound waves. While the visible radiations are the most important ones, as of radiation is of interest to the electrical light, the total range
engineer. The ultra-red rays are those radiations which is far as possible when producing light, as they
we
try to avoid
consume power
SOUND WAVES
FIG, 14.
germ
killers.
They
are
more or
loss destructive
visible radiation, and where they life, appear together with the the arc, protection against them in as are of appreciable amount,
to
The X-rays have become of importance in medicine, etc., as they penetrate otherwise opaque bodies and thus
becomes
desirable.
allow seeing things inside of other bodies. The total range of electric waves, between tho frequencies of alternating currents and the limits of electric waves, has been of
harmful and destructive are to be guarded against, which phenomena tho with and only in recent years, development of wireless found a useful comhave telegraphy, some such electric waves which IB of their mercial application. The main object study
importance to the
electrical engineer a#
in electric circuits,
is still,
however, to
and discharge
19
frequency, 133 cycles, and realizing that the total range of waves, which may appear in electric circuits, is many hundred times
greater than the difference between high and low frequency alternating currents, it can be realized that the differences in the
character of electric waves are enormous between the low frequency surges of near machine frequency and the high frequency oscillations of a multi-gap lightning arrester, near the upper limits of
electric
against
wave frequencies, and the problem of protecting circuits them thus is vastly more difficult than appears at first the conclusions drawn from experimental investigations and sight of electric waves may be very misleading when applied to waves
many
octaves different from those used in the experiment. This explains the apparently contradictory evidence of many experi-
of electric circuits.
LECTUEE
II.
total
classes,
the
electric
and
the ultra-violet radiation and the non-refrangible radiations, as X-rays, etc., separated from the latter by the second blank
space of the radiation spectrum. In the following, mainly the light waves, that is, the second or high frequency range of radiation, will be discussed. The electric waves are usually of importance only in their relation to the
radiator or oscillator which produces them, or to the receiver on which they impinge, and thus are treated in connection with the radiator or receiver, that is, the electric conductor, in the theory of transient electric phenomena and oscillations.*
may bo of a single frequency, that is, a single of different frequencies, that is, a mixture mixture or a wave;
radiation
of different
The
and frequently
of
an
infinite
number
of
waves.
Electric radiation usually is of a single frequency, that is, of the frequency or wave length determined by the constants of the
which produces the radiation, mainly the inductthe capacity C. They may, however, have different wave shapes, that is, comprise, in addition to the fundamental wave, higher harmonics or multiples thereof, just as the sound waves which represent the same tone with different musical instruments are of the same frequency but of different wave
electric circuit
ance
L and
shapes, that is, contain different higher harmonics. Light radiations usually are a mixture of a number of
waves
of
different frequencies, and very commonly a mixture of an infinite number of frequencies, as is, for instance, the case with the
*
of Transient Electric
Phenomena and
Oscilla-
tions,"
20
21
body as a lamp filament, which the frequencies from long ultra-red waves over visible light waves to ultra-violet waves. In the action of vibrations on our senses there is a characteristic difference between the perception of sound waves by the ear and
contains
all
that of light waves by the eye: the ear is analytic, that is, can separate the individual waves in a mixture of different 'sound
waves, as an accord on the piano, and distinguish the individual components of the mixed sound which reaches the ear. Thus we can hear and distinguish an individual voice amongst a mass
The eye, however, perceives only the resultant of other noises. of all the visible radiations which reach it, but cannot separate
their components,
and very
of blue
and yellow
as green light, that is, appear green, while obvious that mixtures of blue and yellow light physically, are essentially different from green light. It is interesting to imagine how nature would look to us if the eye were analytic, that is, could separate the different component radiations, and if it could perceive waves over as great a range of frequency as the car, about ten octaves instead of less than one octave as is now the case. The information given to us by the
we would
see
many
10.
differences
us.
However, while the eye cannot distinguish the different component radiations but sees only their resultant, the specific effects of the component radiations, as the physiologically harmful action of an ultra-violet component of light, still remain, even if the oye docs not see the components, and in the study of radiation for the purpose- of its engineering use for illumination it is therefore necessary to analyze the mixed radiation given by a
source as a lamp, by resolving it into its component waves. This is done by using some feature of the radiation which Such is the case with the velocity of varies with the frequency.
,
propagation.
velocity of light in empty space is 3 X 10 cm. per sec. It is practically the same in air and other gases. In denser bodicB, however, as water, glass, etc., the velocity of light is less
The
10
arid, as will
be seen,
is
22
RADIATION, LIGHT,
then, in Fig. 15, a
AND ILLUMINATION.
of light
Assume
beam
striking
under an
and water W, as air angle the boundary between two media, is at right of beam in the ether the of light vibration the particles the and of successively the direction propagation BC, angles to the back as As . a b a b however, reach soon, waves thus 2 z
l
lj
edge of the
beam
D its speed
changes
FIG. 15.
speed of propagation in
of tho txuim propagation in medium W. Then, while the center in the denser the back medium, moves the distance EC, edge, a moves only the distance D/ EC, and the wave front of the
=
back half of the beam thus changes to 01 while that of tho front half of the beam, which is still in the medium A, romahw GC. Then, while the front edge of the beam movon from G to //, tho
center and the whole back half of the
O[
beam moves
in tho denser
**
^GH, &i
is
now
EL.
the wave front and difference in velocity in the two media of the beam, and thereby its direction of propagation, IB changed
,
is,
due to the
23
the
is,
= angle of refraction, that is, the angle between the outor refracted beam and the perpendicular CP on the going It is then: boundary.
and a 2
CM
FDH =
hence,
a 1 and
LED =
t
a2
FH - DH sin
and
DL - DH sin
(1)
The front edge of the beam moves the distance in medium A, while the back edge moves the distance DL in medium W;
that
'
FH
is,
SI
hence, substituting
(1)
+ s3
(2)
the ratio of the sines of the angle of incidence and the angle of refraction equals the ratio of the speed of propagation iu the two media, hence the ratio of the sines of these two angles
That
is,
IH
the law of refraction, and this ratio of sines As is called the refractive index between the two media A and W. its rethe refractive index of one medium W, then, is understood
constant.
This
is
air
sm
where S
is
c^
* $x
10
(4)
Sl
the velocity of light in empty space = 3 X 10 , and the velocity in the medium, of which <Jt is called the refractive
index.
is the refractive index From equation (4) it follows, that, if the refractive index medium and _ 1 between medium 2, 3 3 - refractive = -* $ _ medium 2 between medium and 3, ^_ 3 2 3 the refractive inde:s that medium index of medium 1 and is, -3;
,
M
<S
between any two media is derived as the ratio of their refractive indices against a third medium, as ; for instance, against air.
24
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
In an
wave
is,
when
ductor:
S=
where
VLC
-,L=>
(5)
the capacity of the conductor per unit length (the length measured in the same measure as the
is
the inductance,
medium surrounding the conductor, that is, the medium through which the electric wave propagates; that is,
A
where
A
1
The ratio
media
electric
wave in two
for
empty
space,
/i
and
K.
hence,
_
(8)
in tho
mcdiuni
of constants
Comparing equation
(S)
with
'/V<t
(4) it follows:
--'V;
(9)
the square of tho refractive index 8 equate the product of permeability p and dielectric constant /c, that
is,
*
/i
1 7 for all
except
(10)
<V-
25
This relation between the constant of the electric circuit K and the constant of optics $ was one of the first evidences of the identity of the medium in which the electric field exists with
medium which carries the light waves. It is, however, only approximately correct, as the refractive index 8 varies with the frequency and is derived for the extremely high frequencies of
the
better light radiation, while K refers to stationary conditions. agreement is thus reached when using as d the refractive index
extrapolated for infinite wave lengths. 12. It is found that the different component frequencies of a beam of radiation are deflected differently when passing from one
medium
FIG. 16.
frequencies, thus showing that the velocity of propagation decreases with an increase of frequency, that is, a decrease of wave length.
its
com-
ponent waves, that is, into a spectrum, by refraction. A narrow beam of light B (Fig. 16) is passed through a prism P of transparent material, and the component frequencies then appear on the screen A (or are seen by the eye) side by side, the reel R below, the violet V above, in Fig. 16, and the green G
in the middle.
prism must be transparent to the radiation; thus, when studying ultra-violet radiation, to which glass is opaque, glass prisms cannot be used, but some material transparent to ultra-violet light such as a quartz or
It is obvious that the material of the
fluorite
26
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION,
The beam of light also can be resolved into its components by a diffraction grating, in which case the lower frequencies are deflected more than the higher frequencies; that is, the red more than the violet. These two forms, the refracting spectroscope and the diffracting spectroscope, now enable us to resolve a beam of mixed radiation into its components and thus study its spectrum. 13. I show you here a number of typical spectra: (1). The spectra of an incandescent lamp and an alcohol lamp with Welsbach mantel. These are continuous spectra, that is, show all the radiations from red over orange, yellow, green, blue, indigo to violet, uniformly shading into each other, This is a line (2a). The spectrum of the mercury lamp. spectrum, that is, shows only a finite number of bright lines on
black background.
It contains five bright linos
violet,
;
greenish yellow,
line, aucl
Fia. 17.
a number of very
(25).
faint red
and orange
lines, of
The spectrum
This also
is
trodes.
power
of the spectroscope which you have, the linen blurr into each other and we see only the most prominent or brightest lines on a uniformly luminous background, which latter requires a more powerful spectroscope to resolve into linen. The band spectrum. This shows a number of bright bands, (3) frequently gradually fading out at their edge and separated by dark spaces. It thus differs from the continuous spectrum (1) in
.
being discontinuous, that is, missing certain ranges of frequency, and differs from the line spectrum (2) in that the band spectrum has a number or range of frequencies in each band, where the line
27
Such
of luminescent
compounds
or of gases and vapors at high pressure, while elementary gases or vapors give line spectra. Absorption and fluorescence also give band spectra, and I thus
show you a band spectrum by operaa in of uranium glass, behind a transa tube ting mercury lamp screen colored rhodamine (an aniline dye which parent by As you see, the spectrum shows a broad red fluoresces red). band, due to the reddish screen; and a greenish yellow band due to the uranium glass, while the normal mercury lines are decreased in intensity. (4). If you now look with the spectroscope at the Welsbach mantel through the mercury arc stream, you see the continuous
spectrum of the mantel and superimposed upon it the line spectrum of the mercury lamp. The light giving mercury vapor thus is transparent for the light of the Welsbach mantel back of it, and lets it pass through, with the exception of those particular frequencies which it gives itself; that is, a luminous gas absorbs those frequencies of radiation which it produces, but is transparent for all other frequencies. This is easily understood: an atom on which a vibration impinges will be set in motion by it and thus absorb the energy of the impinging vibration if it is able to vibrate with the frequency of the impinging vibration; that is, to resonate with it, but will not be affected by any other frequency to which it cannot respond, and thus is transparent to all frequencies of vibration, except to those to which it can respond; that is, which it produces when vibrating. When looking at a continuous spectrum through a luminous gas or vapor, two cases thus may occur: either the spectrum lines of the gas arc brighter than the continuous spectrum, as in the present case, and then appear as bright lines on a bright background, or the continuous spectrum is brighter than the lines of
the gas spectrum in front of it and the lines of the gas spectrum appear less bright than the background, that is, appear as dark Such a spectrum is called a lines on a bright background. or reversed spectrum, absorption spectrum. It shows the lines of
the gas or vapor spectrum, by contrast, dark on the brighter background of the continuous spectrum. The sun and many fixed stars present such a reversed spectrum the sun's spectrum shows the spectrum lines of all the elements
:
28
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
which are in the sun's atmosphere as dark lines on the continuous spectrum given by the inner core of the sun. Whether the line spectrum of a gas or vapor is reversed by the continuous spectrum of a solH or liquid back of it or not depends upon the relative intensity, and thus, to some extent, on the relaSome fixed stars show bright lines on a less tive temperature. luminous background, due possibly to a higher temperature and and sometimes bright lines greater thickness of their atmosphere, or dark lines may change to occur lines and dark simultaneously, at such at lines which, by some activity, as a templaces bright
perature
rise, their brilliancy is
greatly increased.
18.
Combinations of the different types of spectra: continuous spectrum, line spectrum, band spectrum, reversed spectrum, frequently occur, as we have seen bands and linos together in the modified mercury spectrum, and in this case, by turning on an
incandescent lamp, we can still add a continuous spectrum due to the light of the incandescent lamp reflected from the walls of
also in the continuous spectrum of incandescent or dark bands occasionally appear, that in, bands bodies, bright in the will be regions spectrum of greater or lessor intensity, discussed in the paragraphs on colored radiation and selective
the room.
So
radiation.
29
it is
When
beam
of
:
radiation impinges
upon a body
resolved into three parts one part is reflected, that is, does not enter the body at all, but is thrown back. The second part is absorbed in the body, that is, converted into another form of
energy (which other form of energy usually is heat, but may be chemical energy, some other frequency of radiation, etc.) and the third part is transmitted, that is, passes through the body, and out of it, if the body is not too thick. No body reflects, or absorbs, or transmits all the radiations, but even the most perfectly reflecting body absorbs and transmits some radiation, the
reflects
radiation, etc.
be either regular reflection, or irregular reflecIn the former case (Fig. 18) the beam of light is reflected tion. under the same angle under which it impinges upon the body, and the body thus acts as a mirror, that is, gives a virtual image
may
FIG. 19.
back
In the latter case in clotted lino in Fig. 18. in all directions. (Fig. 19) the light is reflected irregularly radiation of uniformly, body which reflects all the frequencies
of
it
as
shown
which the percentage of the impinging radiation, which is reflected, is the same for all frequencies of radiation, is called a colorless b0dj/ and a body which reflects a higher percentage of the radiation of some frequency than of other frequencies, is called a colored body, and its color is the color of radiation, that is, the frequency or frequencies which it reflects more than other
that
is,
in
frequencies.
Most nearly white bodies are silver, body which reflects none of the radiation
all, is
The
30
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
most nearly black bodies are lampblack, charcoal, etc. A body that is, which reflects a constant part of the impinging radiation, is called a grey all for frequencies, the same part or percentage reflected light to the total impinging body, and the ratio of the
or albedo. light is called its whiteness
perfectly white
body
a body thus has albedo 1, a perfectly black body albedo 0, and other the absorbs and three-quarters which reflects one-quarter
of the radiation of
it,
would be
said to
have albedo 0.25. not considered as colors in Black, white and grey thus -are
of colorless bodies I
physics.
As examples
Regular
show you
here:
reflection: polished silver, white; polished iron, grey. Irregular reflection: powdered magnesia, white; lampblack,
black; powdered zinc, barium sulphide, grey. As example of colored bodies I show you:
Regular
reflection: polished
copper, red;
polished gold or
mercury sulphide (cinnabar), red; potassium bichromate, orange; magnesium chromate, yellow; copper acetate-arsenite (paris green), green; copper oxide hydrate
by ammonia, blue; ultra-marine, indigo; magnesium permanganate mixed with magnesia, violet. 15. Of the radiation which enters a body, that part which is absorbed is usually converted into heat. Thus a black body, when exposed to radiation, becomes hotter than a white body, which reflects, or a transparent body, which transmits, most of the radiation. Thus the globe of a colored incandescent lamp, which absorbs more of the radiation than a transparent globe, becomes hotter than a clear glass globe. When scattering dirt on the snow it can be made to melt down far more rapidly in the etc. spring, under the rays of the sun, than when remaining clean, chemical into radiation the absorbed Some bodies convert
precipitated
energy, into other frequencies of radiation, etc. Bodies which convert the absorbed radiation, or rather a part thereof, into radiation of different, as far as known always
lower, frequencies, are called fluorescent bodies. Thus the solution of rhodamine in alcohol, which 1 show you here, fluoresces It transmits red light, but absorbs green, blue and violet red.
light,
light.
This
is
best
31
illustrated by exhibiting it in a source of light which contains no red rays, as the mercury lamp. You see in the rays of the mercury lamp the rhodamine solution looks bright red, the red light seems to come from the inside of it ; and especially through a red
glass the solution looks like a red hot incandescent body.
Here
then, as
no red
light reaches the solution, the red light given by it produced by frequency conversion from other radiation.
mercury
line
The phenomena of conversion of absorbed light into other forms of energy will be more fully discussed in the following
paragraphs. 16. By the transmitted light, that is, the radiation which passes through them, bodies are again divided into colorless bodies; that is, such bodies which transmit the same percentage
of radiation for every
wave length
bodies; that is, bodies which transmit a larger percentage of radiation of some frequencies than of others, and as the trans-
parent color of a body, then, is understood the color, that is, the frequency, of that radiation of which the greatest percentage is
Thus a red glass is one which transmits a higher percentage of red radiation than of any other radiation. A body, then, is called transparent, if it transmits all the radiation, and opaqv&, if it transmits no radiation, but absorbs or If only a part of the radiation is transmitted, but reflects all. in such manner that it is the same part for all frequencies, the
transmitted.
is called grey; or imperfectly transparent, if the part which not transmitted is absorbed in the body; and translucent, if the part which is not transmitted is irregularly reflected inside of the body.
body
is
perfectly transparent bodies, for visible light, are water, quartz, etc.; the most opaque are the metals, and perfectly, or almost perfectly opaque are the magnetic metals, perhaps due to the very low speed of propagation in these metals, which would result from the high value of the permeability /* by
glass,
The most
equation
(8)
paragraph
11.
As example
of colorless bodies I
glass
tube
filled with water, transparent; a tube filled with nigrosine solution in alcohol, opaque and black; a very diluted solution of
32
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
emulsion of water with alcohol, as grey, and a tube filled with an in white of chloroform a solution paraffin oil, which latter solutranslucent. same tion has the specific gravity as water,
carmine solution, Samples of transparent colored bodies are: bichromate solution, orange; potassium chromate red; potassium nickel sulphate solution, green; copper nitrate solution, yellow; diluted potassium permanganate solution, or solution, blue;
diluted solution of iodine in chloroform, violet. " As seen, the terms colorless" and "colored
ferent
7
'
have two
radiation
dif-
meanings when
applied to
the reflected
and the color and frequently is differbody in reflected light maybe different, some bodies may be and transmitted in color light, ent, from its in transmitted colored but colorless in reflected light, light, and and the transmitted of low materials In absorption, inversely. thus must be the reflected colors approximately complementary;
when
and of a
is
Colors are, therefore, distinguished into opaque colors and shown by the transparent colors. The opaque colors are those
light reflected
from the body, the transparent colors those shown by the light transmitted through the body. In reflected light, the transparent colors, therefore, show only when covering a white, that is reflecting, surface, and then, because the light
reflected
body traverses this body twice, before and after reflection, and, The therefore, depend in their brilliancy on the background. difference between opaque and transparent colors, the former reflecting from the surface, the latter reflecting from back of
the colored substance, is seen by comparing the appearance of the two classes of colors shown in 14 and in 16.
In its general use, the terms colorless, white, black, transparent, opaque, refer only to the visible radiation, that iw, to the frequencies within that octave which the eye perceives as light. More in terms broadly, however, these may physics bo applied to the total range of radiation, and then many substances which are colorless for visible light, would be considered as strongly colored, that is, show for different frequencies great differences in the percentage of radiation which they reflect or transmit. Thus we have seen that glass, which is transparent for visible light, is
33
entirely opaque for some ultra-violet light and also opaque for ultra-red light of low frequency; so in this broader sense would
have to be called colored] the color of clear glass, however, is that of the visible spectrum; or, for instance, iodine solution, which is opaque for visible light, is transparent for ultra-red light, that is,
its
color
is
ultra-red, etc.
In this broader sense, referring to the total range and not merely to the visible range, glass, water, mica, etc., are not colorless transparent but colored, and quartz is probably the most
transparent and colorless body. 18. The color of the body, thus, is represented b^ that frequency or those frequencies of radiation of which a higher perof radiation. of the
centage are reflected or transmitted than of the other frequencies This color, therefore, is a characteristic property
its
of the character of the light and of on effect the eye, and can thus be called the physiological If we consider diffused actual or objective color of the body.
as white, then the body appears to the eye in its objective or actual color when compared with a white body, that is, a body uniformly reflecting all radiation in the diffused Under other conditions, as, for instance, in artificial daylight.
daylight
illumination, bodies do not always appear to the eye in their objective colors, but may show a very different color depending
on the character of the source of light. For instance, I have here a plate of colored glass looking through it at the mercury lamp you sec the glass has an olive green color; but when I turn
:
it is
Its objective color is red, its subjective color in the mercury Looking through this glass in daylight it light is green. it more red light than other colors of red as transmits appears
light thus contains a higher perthan diffused daylight. The rays of the mercury lamp, however, contain very little red light and very much green light, and while by this red glass a much higher percentage of the rod light from the mercury lamp is transmitted than of its green light, this higher percentage of transmitted red light is very much less than the lower percentage of
light,
the transmitted green light, and, therefore, in the transmitted in the diffused daylight, green still preponderates more than For instance, if in the light, that is, the glass appears green.
34
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
to green light is only one mercury lamp the ratio of red light the red glass transmits and in is it hundredth of what daylight, of green light, then in as red of a ten times as high percentage transmitted through this red glass the light of the mercury lamp
of what the ratio of red light to green light is still only one-tenth thus the appears green. it is in daylight, and glass We have to distinguish between the actual or objective color of a the body, and its apparent or subbody, which is a constant of the light in which we view the which
jective color,
depends upon different for different illumibody, and therefore may be very colors in one illuminant same the have which nants, and bodies illuminant and another in colors may have entirely different the body corof color the It subjective however,
inversely.
is,
illuminant used which we see, and responding to the particular of which is, therefore, importance in illuminating engineering, and the study of the subjective colors, therefore, is of foremost failure of an illumination depends importance, and the success or
on the production of the desired subjective colors. in which 19. Broadly, an illuminant discriminates for the color color The rich. it is which in color the it is deficient and in the red as is deficient mercury lamp, in which the illuminant blue and violet in the incandescent lamp appears black; the as yellow in color in which the illuminant is abnormally rich in the appears as the incandescent lamp, green mercury lamp as or more colors colors, beless; disappear, white; that is, both incandescent in the lamp, opaque come colorless. Thus yellow and violet appear yellow appears the same as white, opaque blue more or less as black; transparent yellow appears colorless, transparent blue and violet appear colorless and from light transparent grey to opaque black. In the green mercury lamp, opaque green and white appear the same, opaque red appears as black; transparent green appears colorless, and transparent red appears decolorless, from "clear transparent to grey, to opaque black,
its intensity. It is interesting to see the difference between opaque and transparent colors in this respect: 'as opaque colors the deficient
pending upon
both become
colorless and more or less transparent. Thus, mercury lamp, red and green as transparent colors both
35
may
give the
same impression
to the eye, but when blotting out certain radiations, as red and green, in the mercury lamp, these different combinations of radia-
not give the same resultant any more, that is, become and inversely, different colors, which differ such component radiations as are blotted out by an only by become equal in this iUuminant. For instance, a illuminant, mixture of red and blue, as a diluted potassium permanganate In the mercury light it solution, appears violet in daylight. is as the red blotted out, and in the light of the appears blue, incandescent lamp it appears red, as the blue is blotted out. I show you here, in the light of an incandescent lamp, two I turn off the incandescent lamp and pieces of black velvet. turn on the mercury lamp, and you see the one piece is blue, and the other black. Now I show you two pieces of brownish black cloth in the mercury light. Changing to the incandescent lamp is a bright crimson, and the other still practithe one that see you In both cases the color deficient in the illuminant cally black.
tion
may
of different colors,
appeared as black. This tube of copper chloride crystals appears bright green in the incandescent lamp. In the mercury light it is a dirty white.
The
is
blotted out.
These crystals of didymium nitrate, which are a light pink In the in daylight, are dark pink in the incandescent light. is a blue: color of red and are the mixture mercury light they in the is the and one blotted out the and mercury light blue,
other in the incandescent light.
*
These two tubes, one containing a concentrated solution of manganese chloride, the other a solution of didymium nitrate, are both a dark pink in the incandescent light. In the mercury light the first becomes a faint pink, the second becomes grass
green.
These tubes, one containing a solution of didymium nitrate, the other a diluted solution of nickel sulphate, appear both light green In the incandescent lamp the former is in the mercury light. dark pink, the latter dark green. [Didymium, which formerly Was considered as an element, has been resolved into two elements, praseodymium, which gives green salts, and neodymium, which gives pink salts. It is interesting to see that this separa-
36
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
tion is carried out photometrically by the light: the mercury lamp showing only the green color of the praseodymium, the
incandescent lamp the pink color of neodymium]. I have here a number of tubes, which seen in the light of the incandescent lamp contain red solutions of nearly the same
Changing to the mercury lamp you see that they exhibit almost any color. As the red disappeared in the mercury lamp the other component colors, which did not show in the incandescent lamp as they were very much less in intensity than the red, now predominate potassium permanganate solution turns blue,
shade.
:
the same or nearly .the same blue color, turn to very different colors when seen in the incandescent lamp, due to the appearance
of red
light.
rhodamine and methyl green (aniline dyes), which is grey in the light of the incandescent lamp, turns brownish red in the mercury lamp, the green is blotted out, while the rhodamine shows its
of
red fluorescence. Thus, you see, the already very difficult problem of judging the subjective colors of bodies under different iiluminants is still greatly increased by phenomena as fluorescence. To conclude then: we have to distinguish between colorless and colored bodies, between opaque colors and transparent colors, between color, as referred to the visible range of radiation only,
or to the total range, including ultra-reel and ultra-violet, and especially we have to realize the distinction between objective or
and between subjective or apparent color, with dealing problems of illuminating engineering.
actual color,
when
LECTURE
III.
20. The most important physiological effect is the visibility of the narrow range of radiation, of less than one octave, between wave length 76 X 10~ 6 and 39 X 1Q- 6
.
The range
see with practically equal comfort, is enormous: the average intensity of illumination at noon of a sunny day is nearly one
million times greater than the illumination given by the full moon, and still we can see fairly well in either case; that is, the human
itself to enormous differences in the intensity of and that so perfectly that it is difficult to realize the illumination, differences in intensity without measuring them. The photorealizes camera An in it. taken second T graphic exposure
with iV opening of the diaphragm in full sunlight usually gives a better photograph than an exposure of 10 minutes at full opening, The ratio of time of exposure in in the light of the full moon. the two cases, however, is about 1 to 1,000,000, thus showing the
difference in the intensity of illumination. Also, the disk of the moon, when seen in daylight, has about the same intensity as the somewhat more than the cloudless sky, less than white sky
As the surface of the moon's disk, of one-half reflecting clouds. degree diameter, is about JV^QW the surface of the sky, it thus follows that the daylight reflected from the sky is about 100,000
human eye elements of a modern photographic camera an achromatic lensc the lensc L, of high refractive power, enclosed between the two transparent liquids A and B which correct the color dispersion, that is, give the achromatic property; a diaphragm: the iris /, which allows the increase or
(Fig. 20), contains all the
:
times more intense than the light of the full moon. The organ by which we perceive the radiation, the
38
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION
back of the
the sensitive plate or retina R. The nerves of vision end at the retina, and in the center of the retina is a spot F, " " the "sensitive spot or fova," at which the retina is very thin, and the nerve
ends specially plentiful. At this spot we thus see sharpest and clearest, and it is this spot we use for seeing by turning
the eye so as to fix on it the image of the subject we desire to see ; while the image on the rest of the retina is used
The
FlG 20
-
adaptability
to
the
enormous which
as seen
we meet
secured:
(1). By changing the opening and thereby the amount of light admitted to the eye, by contracting or opening the pupil \ This
action
thus
automatic. In low intensity of illumination the pupil wide open and contracts at higher intensities. As this automatic action takes an appreciable, though short time, a flash light photograph shows the pupil of the eye fully open and thereby gives a staring impression to the faces which is avoided by keeping a photographically inactive light, as a candle, burning outside of the field of the camera when preparing for a flash light photois
is
graph.
By the fatigue of the optic nerves, exposed to high intenof sity illumination, the nerves becomes less sensitive, while at low intensity they rest and thus become more sensitive, and the
(2).
differences of sensation are hereby made very much less than corresponds to the differences of intensity of radiation. Therefore,
ness
brightly illuminated room from the darkin the first moment, until the eye gets
accustomed to the light, that is, the nerves become fatigued and so reduce the sensation of light. Inversely, when stepping from a bright room into the darkness wo first see almost nothing until
the eye gets accustomed to the darkness, that is, the nerves of vision are rested and their sensitivity thus increased so as to perceive the much lower intensity of illumination.
(3).
39
intensity of the light, the sound, etc., but is approximately proportional to its logarithm and the sensation, therefore, changes very much less than the intensity of light, etc*, which
Thus a change of intensity from 1 to 1000 is 1000 times as great a change of intensity as from 1 to 2 but the change of sensation in the first case, log 1000 = 3, is only about 10 times as great as the change in the latter case, = 0.301. log 2 This logarithmic law of sensation (Fechner's Law), while usually not clearly formulated, is fully familiar to everybody, is continuously used in life, and has been used from practical experience
causes the sensation.
}
It means that the same relative or percentsince by-gone ages. in age change intensity of light, sound, etc., gives the same change
of sensation, or in other words, doubling the intensity gives the same change in sensation, whether it is a change of intensity from
one candle power to two candle power, or from 10 to 20, or from 1000 to 2000 candle power. It is obvious that the change of sensation is not proportional to the change of intensity; a change of intensity of light by one candle power gives a very marked change of sensation, if it is a change from one to two candle power, but is unnoticeable, if it is a change from 100 to 101 candle power. The change of sensation thus is not proportional to the absolute change of intensity one but to the relative or percentage candle power in either case change of intensity, and as this is 100 per cent in the first, 1 per
first,
cent in the latter case, the change of sensation unnoticeable in the latter case.
is
marked
in the
This law of sensation we continuously rely upon in practice. For instance, when designing an electrical distribution system for
lighting,
we
by
1 per cent
is
permissible as it gives a change of candle power of about 5 per cent, and 5 per cent variation is not seriously noticeable to the eye.
Now this 5 per cent change of candle power may be a change from
by fa candle power, or it may be a change from 1000 by 50 candle power, and both changes we assume, and are justified herein from practical experience, to give the same
1 to 0.95, or
to
90,
or
is,
to
is,
40
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
wave
length,
is:
L = A
where
log
~
xo
a proportionality constant (depending on the physiois the minimum perceptible value of logical measure of L) and \ " threshold value/' below which sensation illumination or the
is
ceases.
of change of intensity
i,
which
is
still
the average human eye, is about 1.6 per cent. just perceptible to limit of the human eye for changes This, then, is the sensitivity
of illumination.
value \, the sensiObviously, when approaching the threshold decreases. for intensity changes tivity of the eye The result of this law of sensation is that the physiological effect
not proportional to the physical effect, as exerted, for instance, on the photographic plate. The range of intensities permissible on the same photographic plate, therefore, is far more restricted. A variation of illumination within the field of vision of 1 to 1000, as between the ground and the sky, would not be seriously felt by the eye, that is, not give a very great difference in the sensation. On the photographic plate, the brighter portions would show 1000 times more effect than the darker portions and thus give bad halation while the latter are still under exposed. A photographic
is
smaller plate, therefore, requires much than the field of vision permissible to the eye.
variations of intensity in
ner the variations of intensity of the voice, used in speaking, are far beyond the range of impression which the phonograph cylinder can record, and when speaking into the phonograph a more uniform intensity of the voice is required to produce the record, otherwise the lower portions of the speech arc not recorded, while at the louder portions the recording point jumps and the voice
breaks in the reproduction. 2L The sensitivity of the eye to radiation obviously changes with the frequency, as it is zero in the ultra-red, and in the ultraand thus gradually violet where the radiation is not visible of the end red increases from zero at the spectrum to a maximum the of somewhere near the middle spectrum and then decreases
is,
the physi-
41
as one ological effect produced by the same radiation power is a maximum near the middle of the watt of radiating power visible spectrum and decreases to zero at the two ends, about as illustrated by the curves in Fig. 21. Inversely, the mechanical of or the power required to produce the same equivalent light, is a as one candle power of light effect physiological minimum near the middle of the spectrum and increases from
there to infinity at the end of the visible range, being infinite
FIG. 21.
in the ultra-reel
and
ultra-violet,
It
thus varies about as indicated in Fig. 22. produce visibility. The mechanical power equivalent of light, thus, is not constant,
which is 426 kgm. as the mechanical energy equivalent of heat of the frequency, is a function but or 4.25 kilo-joule per calorie
that
is,
very far from 0.02 watt per candle power in the middle of the
spectrum. When comparing, however, the physiological effects of different frequencies of radiation, that is, different colors of light, the diffithat different colored lights cannot be compared photometrically, as all photometers are based on making the illuculty arises
mination produced by the two different sources of light equal, and when these sources of light are of different color they can never become equal. As long as the colors are not very different the two different shades of yellow or yellowish white and white
eye can
still
42
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
thus compare them, though not as accurately as when the two sources of light are of the same color. With very great color
differences, as green light
no longer made on be still can feasible. However, an accurate comparison the purAs the basis of equal ease in distinguishing objects.
and orange
light, this is
YELLOW
GREEN
FIG. 22.
is
used
is
comparison
of lights obviously
is
by them; that is, two lights, regardless whether of the same or of different colors, give the same candle
of objects illuminated
power, that
same physiological effect, if they enable us to distinguish objects with the same ease at the same distance. Experience has shown that the sharpest distinction, that is, the greatest accuracy in comparing different lights in this manner, is reached by determining the distance from the source of light at
is,
the
43
For this size just ceases to be readable. must be a mixture of letters which do not form words and the point which can be determined most
of
moderate
accurately is where large letters, as capitals, are still readable, while small letters are already unreadable (see p. 174). Obviously, in comparing different colors of light the object must be colorless,
that
is,
meter," is theoretically the color of light. It is, however, not as accurate as the comparison by photometer, and thus the average of a number of observaThe only error which this method leaves is tions must be used.
that due to the difference in the sensitivity of different eyes, that the sensitivity curves (Fig. 21), is, due to the differences between
This method of comparison been called the "luminohas what by the most correct, as it is independent of
and
this in
however, that the sensitivity curve for different is a function of the intensity of radiation; that maximum the sensitivity point of the eye is not at a definite is, varies with the intensity of illumibut or wave length, frequency nation and shifts more towards the red end of the spectrum for for low intensity of high, towards the violet end of the spectrum
22.
It is found,
colors of radiation
illumination,
and
maxi-
mum physiological effect takes place in the yellow light, while for
very low intensity of illumination it occurs in the bluish green less power light; that is, at high intensity yellow light requires for the same physiological effect than any other color of light,
while for low intensity, bluish green light requires less power for the same physiological effect than any other color of light. Thus,
an orange yellow light, as a flame carbon arc, and a bluish green of the same intensity from the light, as a mercury lamp, appear distance of 100 feet, by going nearer to the lamps the orange in intensity than the yellow appears to increase more rapidly bluish green, and from a veiy short distance the former appears not showing glaring bright, while the latter is disappointing by
if
Inversely, when anywhere near the same apparent intensity. the two lamps the orange going further and further away from than the bluish green, more out fade to seems rapidly yellow light and has practically disappeared while the bluish green is still markedly visible. A mercury lamp, therefore, can be seen from distances from which a much brighter yellow flame arc is practi-
44
cally unnoticeable,
but inversely, from a very short distance the while a mercury lamp of higher yellow light appears dazzling, candle power appears less bright. of sensitivity with intensity, by Fig. 23 illustrates the change
variation of the relative sensitivity of approximate curves of the the intensity i of illumination in with human the average eye
FIG. 23.
meter candles (or rather log i] as abscissas, for red light, wave bluish green length 65.0; orange yellow light, wave length 59;
light,
violet light,
wave length
45.0.
As
the sensitivity is low, while for orange the visible spectrum near the middle of the bluish as green light yellow as well
visible
the sensitivity is high. For bluish green light, however, the sensitivity
range
is
high at low
for high intensities, while and moderate intensities but the for orange yellow light sensitivity is high at high intensities intensities and ultimately vanishes, low and falls off at medium and
falls off
becomes invisible at intensities many times higher than those at which green light is still well visible. Red light vanishes from visibility still earlier than orange yellow light, while violet light remains visible even at very low
that
is,
intensities.
The vanishing
is,
45
approxi-
are,
mately, at:
Color
Wave
67
0.06
green 50.5
blue
violet
47
43 X
KT
.?,=
po
Relative radiation
power
10,000
1000
100
20
That
is,
the
the least
amount
light
blue light 20 times as much, but yellow light 100 times and red light even 10,000 times as much power as green light at the threshold
of visibility.
minimum visible amount of green light represents of power; the minimum visible amount of requires twice as much power as green light; violet
While the intensity of radiation varies inversely proportional to the square of the distance, it follows herefrom that the physiological effect of radiation does not vary exactly with the square
of the distance, but varies somewhat faster, that is, with a higher power of the distance for orange yellow or the long-wave end of
the spectrum, and somewhat slower, that is, with a lesser power of the distance than the square, for bluish green or the short-wave end of the spectrum.
This phenomenon is appreciable even when comparing the enclosed alternating carbon arc with the open direct current carbon arc by photometer, where a fairly high intensity of illumi:
nation
is
somewhat
used, the relative intensity of the two arcs is found different than by luminometer, that is, by reading
distances nearer the lower limit of visibility. For low intensities, the alternating arc compares more favorably than for high
intensities.
photometric comparison of differences exist, the intencolor where illuminants, appreciable is made must be at which the of illumination comparison sity or the candle the influences as it power and the result, given,
distance of observation stated. 23. Not only the sensitivity
maximum is
different for
low and
for high intensity of illumination, but the shape of the sensitivity curve also is altered, and for low intensity is more peaked,
that
is,
the sensitivity decreases more rapidly from a maximum it does for high intensity
46
of
RADIATION, LIGHT,
illumination as
indicated
AND ILLUMINATION.
by the curves
in Fig. 24
which
shows approximate sensitivity curves of the average human eye: low illumination near the treshold value of visi(a) for every for medium illumination, 4.6 bility or 0.001 meter-candles; (b) for very high illumination, 600 meter-candles. meter-candles; (c)
1.70
50.0
FIG. 24.
the illumination produced by 1 candle power meter distance; meter-candles, thus, the candle power at 1 illumination produced by a light source of
(1
meter-candle
is
of light intensity at 1
VN
=r
meter distance,
6
etc.).
ends at wave length lw = 61 X 10~ ; that is, for longer waves or orange and red light, 0.001 meter-candles is below the threshold value of visibility; hence is no longer visible. The maximum visibility, that is the sensitivity maximum of
the
Z
human
eye, lies at
wave
length.
Z
Z
= =
very low intensity, curve (a). medium intensity, curve (6) for 53.7, yellowish green for 56.5, yellow high intensity, curve (c).
51.1, bluish green for
The shown
sensitivity maximum varies with the intensity about as in Fig. 25; that is, it is constant in the bluish green for intensities, changes at medium intensities in the range be-
higher intensities.
is l Q wo is the wave length at maximum sensitivity and the sensitivity at this wave length, that is, the maximum sensitivity and ks is a constant which is approximately 120 for low,
where
LOG
42
0.01
-i 01
Ji-
57
FIG. 25.
62 for high intensities and changes in approximately the same range of intensities in which 1WQ changes; &s is also plotted in
Fig. 25.
This effect of the intensity of illumination on the sensitivity of the eye is very important in illuminating engineering as it determines the color shades which are most effective for the particular
purpose.
for signalling, etc., the bluish green of the mercury lamp is best arc the poorest; the suited, carries farthest, and the yellow flame flame to the arc arc, even where the white carbon yellow superior a big glare of where latter is of Inversely, intensity.
greater
light
is
the yellow
desired, as for decorative purposes, for advertising, etc., flame carbon arc is best suited, the bluish green mer-
cury lamp disappointing. the long waves of Apparent exceptions may exist: for instance, the short waves of than better the orange yellow penetrate fog the where bluish green, and for lighthouses, important problem is in distance to reach the greatest possible fog, yellow light, thus, may be superior. la general, however, the bluish green is superioi
48
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
and inversely,
times more
in visibility to the orange yellow for long distances, is superior for short distances. the
orange yellow
At the
limits of
visibility the
eye
is
very
many
than sensitive to green light and, in general, high-frequency light, in light. to orange yellow and, general, low-frequency result of the sensitivity of the eye for green
A necessary
higher
light is the
As preponderance of green in gas and vapor spectra. more should lines exists appear no special reason why spectrum at any other and as the radiafrequently at one wave length than the in visible tion is most green, this explains, somewhat, the illuminants towards a greenish efficient most highly tendency of Welsbach mantel, the Nernst the for or yellow color (as, instance,
lamp,
etc.).
Pathological
24.
and Other
Effects
on
the Eye.
a form of energy, and thus, when intercepted and absorbed, disappears as radiation by conversion into another form of usually heat. Thus the light which enters the
Radiation
energy,
is
if its power is considerable it may eye is converted into heat, and or even destructive, causing inflammation or burns. be harmful of excessive radiation is not incident to any effect This harmful form of frequency, but inherent in radiation as a
particular
therefore, greatest for the same physiological effect, same amount of visibility, for those frequencies of or highest power equivalight which have the lowest visibility least for the green and and violet and the red for the lent, that is, of visibility represent amount same the for which the yellow, and least power. greenish yellow light arc the most Hence, green
is,
harmless, the least irritating to the eye, as they represent the feel this effect and express it by speaking of least power. "cold as the green light light' and of the red and orange light as
We
working very much to due this energy effect, largely of amount incident to the large orange, reel, and ultra-rod bodies used for illuminants incandescent the in the radiation of " cold exist with not and thus does light/' as the light of the
"hot" or "warm."
The harmful
is
effect of
light,
light,
is
however, are just as energetic, or "hot/' and the reason that they arc usually not
that
efficiently
49
powerful blue and violet light, and if we could produce it would not be able to use it for illumination, clue to the specific effects of this light which will be described in the following. In Fig. 26, let the curve A represent roughly the mechanical power equivalent of light for average intensity, that is, the power required to produce the same physiological effect or the same candle power. The distribution of power in an incandescent
FIG. 26.
lamp carbon filament would be somewhat like C. Hence, the physiological effect falls off somewhat towards the green, as C drops more than A, and almost vanishes in the blue and violet, as C rapidly decreases, while A, the power required to give the same
physiological effect, rapidly increases. From the yellow towards the red the physiological effect again decreases somewhat, but
50
RADIATION, LIGHT,
still
AND ILLUMINATION.
C",
Dividing C increases towards the ultra-red. curve of the effect, distribution the then gives physiological by showincandescent the in lamp spectrum, that is, of visibility,
the radiation
is yellow. Hg gives the^ distribuing that the color of the light It is shown in dotted tion of power in the mercury spectrum. not is continuous, but the power massed lines, as the distribution f Hg then gives at definite points, the spectrum lines of mercury. the visibility curve by dividing Hg by A. As seen, the ratio of f the area of Hg to Hg, that is, the ratio of the physiological effect to C; to the power, is much less than the ratio of the area of C' far of amount same the for visibility that is, the former produces
less
heat and thus is safer, 25. Excessive intensity, such as produced at a short-circuiting The human organism has by evoluarc, is harmful to the eye.
tion,
by natural
selection,
of excessive power into the eye: against the entrance of radiation the pupil of the eye contracts illumination of at high intensity
light admitted,
and a sudden
This
mechanism is, however, responsive automatic; the yellow light, mainly to long waves of radiation, to the red and The violet and blue of waves light. but not to the short green,
is
apparently that all sources of excessive radiation which are found in nature, the sun and the fire, are rich in red and yellow rays, but frequently poor in rays of short wave
alone would length, and, therefore, a response to short wave lengths in many absent be as not be sufficient for protection they might
intense radiations, while a response to long waves would be sufficient since these are always plentiful in the intense radiations
found in nature.
only of late years that illuminants, as the mercury lamp, which are deficient in the long waves, have been produced, and for these the protective action of the eye, by contracting the pupil, This absence or reduction of the contraction of the pupil fails.
It
is
of the eye in the light of the mercury lamp is noticed when passing from a room well illuminated by incandescent lamps, to one equally
well illuminated
by mercury lamps and inversely. When changing from the incandescent light to the mercury light, the illumination given by the latter at first appears dull and inferior as the pupil
is still
51
opens; and inversely, coming from the mercury light to the incandescent light, the latter first appears as a big glare of light, the pupil still being open, but gradually dulls down by the contraction
of the pupil.
This absence of the automatic protective action of the eye against light deficient in long waves is very important, as it means that exposure to excessive intensity of illumination by mercury light may be harmful, due to the power of the light, against which the eye fails to protect, while the same or even greater power of radiation in yellow light would be harmless, as the eye will proThe mercury lamp, therefore, is the safest tect itself against it. of when that moderate intensity required for good illuminant, but becomes harmful when of excessive intensity, as illumination,
when
closely looking at the lamp for considerable time, when The possibility of a harmful operating at excessive current. This pheeffect is noticed by the light appearing as glaring.
containing only
vertical
glass cylinders of
fairly intense blue violet light, that is, light and violet radiation. It is derived from a
mercury lamp, which is surrounded by two concentric welded together at the bottom. The space be-
tween the cylinders is filled with a fairly concentrated solution potassium permanganate (strong copper nitrate solution or a cupric-ammon salt solution, though not quite so good, may also be used) which is opaque to all but the blue and violet radiations. As you see, the light has a very weird and uncanny effect, is extremely irritating: you can see by it as the intensity of illumination is fairly high, but you cannot distinguish everything, and especially the lamp is indefinite and hazy you see it, but when
:
you
look at
it
it it
to look at
disappears, and thus your eye is constantly trying and still never succeeds, which produces an irritating
It
restlessness.
illumination would result in insanity. The cause of this weird effect which is difficult to describe probably is that the sensitive on the that the is, retina, point on which we focus the image spot
52
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
of the object
F in Fig. 19, is see, or the fova Thus we violet or blue the see not light. blue blind, that is, does outer on the range of other and objects indistinctly see the
which we desire to
when the retina, but what we try to see distinctly disappears often is This F. therefore, spot, focused on the blue blind spot due it on see we as yellow called the "yellow spot/ to^the retina. absence of the vision of blue at this particular place of the the mercury lamp; most other this effect
7
lamp
To produce requires to give illuminants do not have sufficient blue and violet rays if even and color this of they do, no considerable illumination is violet and sufficiently opaque to the screen which passes blue to spoil the effect, if the them of long waves not to pass enough
illuminant
is
and thus
it is
off
aniline dye) which transmits ing of a solution of naphtol green (an in the green the above-described only the green light. As you see, is vision clear, distinct and restful. effect does not exist, but the is no longer visible to the radiation the violet the 27.
Beyond
however, a faint perception of ultra-violet not as distinct light, but rather as an indislight in the eye, some form of dull pain, possibly tinct, uncomfortable feeling, caused by the ultra-violet effects resulting from fluorescence
eye as
light.
There
is,
light
With some practice the presence of radiation inside of the eye. ultra-violet radiation thus can be noticed by the eye and such avoided. In the ultra-violet, and possibly to a very slight
extent in the violet and even in the blue, a specific harmful effect a destruction by appears, which possibly is of chemical nature, in increases effect severity the furchemical dissociation. This to become a seems and into the ultra-violet, ther we reach
the violet.
very short ultra-violet rays are extremely destructive to exposure even to a moderate intensity of them for very
few minutes produces a severe and painful inflammation, the after effects of which last for years, and long exposures would
probably result in blindness. The chronic effects of this inflammation are similar to the effect observed in blue light: inability or difficulty in fixing objects on the sensitive spot F, so that without impairment of the vision on the rest of the retina clear dis-
53
impaired and reading becomes difficult or impossible, It appears as if the sensitive spot Fj or the focusing mechanism of the eye, were over-irritated and when used, for instance in reading, becomes very rapidly
especially in artificial illumination.
If further irritation by fatigued and the vision begins to blur. by attempting to read, etc., is avoided, gradually the rapidity of fatigue decreases, the vision remains
ultra-violet light or
a longer and longer time before it begins to blur and becomes normal again. ultimately The inflammation of the eye produced by ultra-violet light appears to be different from that caused by exposure to highpower radiation of no specific effect, as the light of a short circuit of a high-power electric system, or an explosion, etc. The main differences are:
distinct for
1.
The
effect of
immediately after exposure, while that of ultra-violet radiation (ultra-violet burn) appears from 6 to 18 hours after exposure.
2. The external symptoms of inflammation: redness of the eyes and the face, swelling, copious tears, etc., are pronounced in the power burn, but very moderate or even entirely absent in the ultra-violet burn. 3. Complete recovery from a power burn even in severe cases usually occurs within a few days, leaving no after effects, while
recovery from an' ultra-violet burn is extremely slow, taking months or years, and some after effects, as abnormal sensitivity
wave lengths, may be practically permanent. The general phenomena of a severe power burn are: Temporary blindness immediately after exposure, severe pains in the eyes and the face, redness of eyes and face, swelling, copious tears, etc. These effects increase for a few hours and then
to radiation of short
decrease, yielding readily to proper treatment: application of ice, cold boric acid solution, etc., and complete recovery occurs
gradually, but recovery, if no structural have in the occurred, is rapid and complete by eyes changes of work under artificial and discontinuance treatment proper
symptoms appear
illumination.
Most artificial light is given by temperature radiation (incandescent lamp, gas and kerosene flame), and therefore its radiation
54
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
consists of a very small percentage only of visible light (usually ultra-red less than 1 per cent), while most of its energy is in the or radiation of visible amount same and invisible, and for the
light the total radiated
is many times greater than power thus " with daylight. Regarding chronic power burn," artificial light, than daylight, that is, much therefore, is much more harmful illumination than incandescent under enters the eye more
energy
under much more powerful daylight illumination. In a severe ultra-violet burn no immediate symptoms are uncomfortable noticeable, except that the light may appear from 6 to 18 is the of onset at it. The while symptoms
hours
the exusually during the night following external the in the eyes; posure, by severe deep-seated pains of inflammation is moderate or absent, the vision is
is,
appearance not impaired, but distinction made difficult by the inability to focus the eye on any object. The pains in the eyes and headache yield very slowly; for weeks and even months any attempt of the patient to use the eyes for reading, or otherwise sharply of the vision; the letters distinguishing objects, leads to blurring of the print seem to run around and the eye cannot hold on to them, and severe headache and deep-seated pains in the effects become less; eyes follow such attempt. Gradually these after some months reading for a moderate length of time during or in poor daylight is possible, but when continued too 'long, of the vision to leads blurring light, as in artificial illumination, and head or eye ache. Practically complete recovery occurs
as only after some years, and even then some care is necessary, the eyes temporarily any very severe and extended strain on the case when brings back the symptoms. Especially is this that looking at a light of short wave length, as the mercury arc; an abnormal sensitivity of the eye to light of is, there remains short wave lengths, even such light which to the normal eye is perfectly harmless, as the mercury lamp. In chronic cases of ultra-violet burn, which may occur when
working on unprotected
arcs,
symptoms
are: occasional
headaches, located back of the eyes, that is, pains which may be characterized either as headache or as deep-seated eye ache. These recur with increasing frequency and severity. At the
55
and the patient finds it more and more difficult to keep the eye focused for any length of time on objects, as the print when readThese symptoms increase in severity until the patient ing. is obliged to give up the occupation which exposed him to ultraviolet light, and then gradual recovery occurs, as described above, if the damage has not progressed too far. In mild cases recovery from power burns may occur in a few hours and complete recovery from mild ultra-violet burns in a few weeks. Both types of burn may occasionally occur simultaneously and their symptoms then successively. For instance, in a case of an exposure while working for about half an hour with a flame-carbon arc without enclosing glass globe (such an arc contains large amounts of high-power radiation, of yellow and orange color, but also a considerable amount of ultra-violet rays), the symptoms of the power burn increased in severity for a few hours, and then rapidly vanished by the application of cold water, and recovery was practically complete six hours after exposure; then some hours later, in the middle of the night, the patient was awakened by severe pains in the eyes, the symptoms of the ultra-violet burn, and had to seek
medical attendance.
in a few days, but the blurring of the vision was appreciable for some days longer, and the sensitivity to high-frequency light
for
some weeks.
28. Arcs produce considerable amount of ultra-violet light,* and in former experiments we have used a high frequency iron
arc for producing ultra-violet light and also have seen that even a very thin sheet of glass is opaque for these radiations. For very long ultra-violet rays, that is, the range close to the visible violet,
not quite opaque, but becomes perfectly opaque for about one-quarter to one-half octave beyond the violet, and in this first quarter of an octave the harmful effect of the ultra-violet radiation is still very small and becomes serious only when approaching a distance of about one octave from the visible end of the violet. Clear transparent glass thus offers a practically complete
glass
is
when the
*
protection against the harmful effects of ultra-violet light, except latter is of excessive intensity, and thus arcs enclosed
An
radiation accompanied
by
56
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
however, not safe to look metal arcs for too long a
It is, glass globes are harmless. of the in work into and open light
by
time.
arc gives the least ultra-violet rays, so little that enclosure even without by glass it is fairly safe; metal arcs give arc the gives the greatest amount and reaches more and mercury distance to the farthest beyond the visible, and these very destruc-
The carbon
so far only been observed in very short ultra-violet rays have low of a the radiation temperature mercury arc in a quartz tube: to these rays while glass is opaque. quartz being transparent The high temperature mercury arc in a quartz tube, that is, arc as it is used to some extent operated near atmospheric pressure to be much less danseems for illumination, especially abroad, or vacuum low the arc, but it also than temperature
tive
gerous
In general, no metal arc, spark discharge, or glow discharge should ever be used industrially or otherwise without being enclosed by a glass globe, preferably of lead glass, if located so that Those experimenting with arcs or other it may be looked at. should electric discharges always protect their eyes by the interposition of a glass plate. Thus the sparks of wireless telegraph stations, the discharges of ozonizers, the arcs of nitric acid generators, electric furnaces, enclosure. etc., may be dangerous without glass
While
artificial
an appreciable amount
illuminants, and especially metal arcs, give of ultra-violet light, these ultra-violet
the visible rays extend only to about one-quarter octave beyond is enclosed the illuminant the as is always violet and if, bycase,
the harmful effect of these long ultra-violet rays is negliThe radiation of the sun also contains ultra-violet rays, gible. and a larger percentage compared with the total radiation than
glass,
any glass-enclosed
that
is,
artificial
is
daylight,
illuminant, and as the light of the sun, recognized as perfectly harmless, as far as
this specific destructive action is concerned, the same applies to the artificial illuminants, as they contain less ultra-violet rays
than the light of the sun. This specific destructive action on the eye of short ultra-violet radiation extends beyond the blank space in the spectrum of radiation (Fig. 14) and still exists, though possibly to a lesser
extent; in the X-rays.
57
and Therapeutic
Effects of Radiation.
power and frequency. discussed in the preceding paragraphs. effect in supplying the energy of plant
human body an influence depending on The effect on the eye has been
The
specific chemical
life will
be more fully
discussed in the following under chemical effects. As is to be expected, the effect of radiation on the living protoplasm of the cells is stimulating if of moderate intensity, destructive
if
of excessive intensity; that is, by the energy of the radiation the motions of the parts of the protoplasm-molecule are increased, and, if the intensity of radiation is too high, the molecule thus is torn asunder, that is, destroyed, the living cell
killed
If
of
and inflammation and necrosis (mortification) result. the intensity is moderate, merely an increase of the rapidity the chemical changes in the protoplasm, which we call life,
is, the radiation exerts a stimulating effect, inthe intensity of life, causing an increased renewal of creasing worn-out tissue and reconstruction, and thus is beneficial or curative, especially where the metabolism is sluggish. Just as in the action on the eye, two different effects probably
results; that
a general effect due to the energy of the radiation which with sunlight is a maximum beyond the visible close to the red end of the spectrum, and with most artificial illuminants (those based on incandescence) reaches a maximum still further in the ultra-red and a specific effect depending on the frequency. The power effect is general and probably fairly uniform throughout the exposed tissue, appears simultaneous with or immediately after the exposure, and thus practically no danger of harmful results from destruction of tissue exists, as excessive
exist:
intensity makes itself felt immediately, before far-going destruction of tissue can occur, and, therefore, the only possible danger which could exist would be in the indirect effect of stimulation
of the body, as the heart. Thus the use of incandescent light as stimulant appears fairly harmless. Different is the specific action of high-frequency radiation. This occurs only some time after exposure, from a few hours to
on other organs
As these higher frequencies are not several weeks (with X-rays). felt by the body as such and exert a powerful action even at such
58
low
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
intensities that their energy is not felt as heat, and, furtherbe different, more, the susceptibility of different people may
and thereby harmful nothing to guard against excessive more severe and far is the damage exposure. Furthermore, have occurred cases fatal and the with power effect, lasting than from be as expected may years after exposure. Possibly, killed are tissue the in cells few a living selective action, only
there
is
by the
cells
radiation,
then gradually involve the surrounding living cells, causing their destruction or degeneration, so that the harm is far out of destructive effect of the radiaproportion with the immediate with tion penetrating forms of radiation, as especially
proper,
lesions are correspondingly X-rays and radium rays, in which the
deep-seated.
should High-frequency radiation (violet, ultra-violet, X-ray) of direction the under used experts fully therefore be only and action their clanger. familiar with physiological action of high-frequency radiation is still absent The
specific
in the green, begins slightly in the blue and violet, increases into the ultra-violet and persists up to the highest frequencies of It is shared also by the radiation of the radio-active the
X-rays.
While the substances, as the alpha and beta rays of radium. the in lies also ultra-violet, effect maximum of this probably from one to two octaves beyond the visible spectrum, the effect is profoundly modified by the transparency or opacity of the tissue for different frequencies, and the character of the stimulating
and pathological
effects greatly
Water is transmore and more opaque in the parent for visible light, becomes is and ultra-red as well as in the ultra-violet, again fairly transfor the long parent for X-rays. Blood is fairly transparent for the shorter but visible rays of red and yellow, nearly opaque the to Hence next X-rays which violet and ultra-violet rays. visible can rays of red and through the body, the longest
which the radiation penetrates the body. The largest part of the organism is water.
pass
even yellow penetrate relatively deepest into the body, though from the distance a short they are practically absorbed within of the Thus while the energy maximum sunlight surface. is in the ultra-red, the maximum physiological effect probably the same which are the active is that of the red and yellow rays
:
59
rays in plant life. The violet and ultra-violet rays are absorbed close to the surface of the body by the blood, which is opaque
for them.
done in their therapeutic use by freeing the from blood by compression or other means.
Even then, howthe ultra-violet longest ever, probably only rays penetrate, the ones out the short being kept by opaque character of the very
water in the
tissue.
The penetration of the radiation of the sunlight into the human body is very greatly reduced by acclimatization, which leads to the formation of a protective layer or pigment, more or less opaque to the light. Such acclimatization may be permanent or temporary. Permanent acclimatization has been evolved
during ages by those races which developed in tropical regions, as the negroes. They are protected by a black pigment under the skin, and thereby can stand intensities of solar radiation which would be fatal to white men. A temporary acclimatization results from intermittent exposure to sunlight for gradually increasing periods tanning, and enables the protected to stand
:
without harmful effects exposure to sunlight which would produce severe sunburn in the unprotected. This acquired protection mostly wears off in a few weeks, but some traces remain even after years. slight protection by pigmentation also exists in white men, and its differences lead to the observed great differences in sensi-
who usually have very light sunburn and sunstroke than to more are susceptible pigmentation, the more highly pigmented brunette people.
tivity to solar radiation: blondes,
In sunburn we probably have two separate effects superimposed upon the other: that due to the energy of the solar radiation and the specific effect of the high frequencies, which to a small extent are contained in the sunlight. The two effects
are probably somewhat different, and the high-frequency effect tends more to cause inflammation of the tissue, while the energy
tends towards the production of pigmentation (tanning), and the symptoms of sunburn thus vary with the different proportions of energy radiation and of high-frequency radiation as depending on altitude, humidity of the air, the season, etc. 30. The action of radiation on living organisms is stimulating Thus if of moderate intensity, destructive if of high intensity.
effect
60
it is
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
as alcohol, caffeine, etc. The intensity of light which is destructo which the tive to life largely depends on the amount of light live in the which Those is accustomed. organisms
which is necessary the saprophytic bacilli, Amongst for the life of other organisms. live in the of for instance (the germs putrefaction), many species if not do at least brought into the multiply, light, and die, or dark and are in the live bacilli dark, while other putrefactive the with case the is also latter The pathogenic killed by light. as the bacillus of tuberculosis, bacilli, that is, the disease germs, As these live in the dark, the interior of the body, etc.
killed
by an amount
of light
cholera,
and radiation in general, they are rapidly killed by light. Light, most therefore is one of the powerful germicides and disinfectOne of the most effective prophylactic measures, espeants. of civilization, as tuberculosis, etc., thus cially against the diseases while is to flood our homes with light, especially direct sunlight,
our habit of keeping the light out of our houses by curtains, almost light-tight, when shades, etc., closing our residences
them into breeding places leaving them for some time, converts of disease germs, and then we wonder about mortality.
Obviously excessive light intensity ultimately becomes ful even to the human organism, and it is therefore advisable
harm-
to protect ourselves against the light when it becomes annoying by its intensity. It has even been claimed that the impossibility of white men to become permanently acclimatized in the tropics
of the population of our their immigration: from country within a few generations and "strenuousness," the increased nervousness, restlessness
in the
temperament
more cloudy high-frequency radiation, compared with the this is the Whether climate of our original European home.
case remains to be further investigated.
however, that such a profound effect exposure of a small part of the body, face and hands, to a more intense light, and the failure of acclimatization in the tropics
could well be explained by the higher temperature and its damaging effect, while the change from Europe to America is not merely a change from a more cloudy to a more sunny climate, but
is,
61
and slowly changing temperatures, to a continental climate, with its rapid changes of temperature and enormous temperature extremes, and the difference between continental and maritime climate may be suspected as the cause in the change of the temperament of the races. As men have lived for ages in the
light,
the
cells of
the
human
body are far more resisting which for ages have lived
to the light than the disease germs, in the dark; and light, and more
particularly the high-frequency violet and ultra-violet radiation and the X-rays, thus have found a useful therapeutic application
in killing disease
germs in the human body. Thus, by exposdiseased tissue to high-frequency radiation, the disease the ing or so far damaged that the body can destroy are killed, germs the of the body are still unharmed, but stimuwhile cells them,
lated to greater activity in combating the disease germs. As seen, for this purpose the radiation must be of sufficient intensity
and duration to
as to
kill
or
damage the
bacilli,
Surface infections, as tuberculosis of the skin (scrofulosis, lupus), thus are effectively and rapidly cured by high-frequency light. More difficult and less certain the effect is if the infection is deeper seated, as then the radiation must penetrate a greater thickness of tissue to
cells of
bacilli, and is thereby largely absorbed, and the danger thus exists that, before a sufficient intensity of radiation can be brought to the seat of the infection, the intensity at the surface In of the tissue may become harmful to the cells of the body. this case the more penetrating X-rays would be more applicable, as they can penetrate to any depth into the body. They are,
harm
the
the body.
reach the
however, so far distant in frequency from the light radiation, that the acclimatization of the body to the light radiation probably exists only to a lesser extent against the X-rays; that
is,
the difference in the destructive effect on the bacilli and on the cells of the body, on which the curative effect is based, probably is less with the X-rays than with the long ultra-violet waves.
Since Dr. Finsen introduced phototherapy and radiotherapy, ago, it thus has found a very extended and
within
its limitation.
This greater destructive action of -radiation on micro-organisms than on the cells of the human body, extends not merely to the
pathogenic
bacilli,
but to
all
dark.
62
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
which biologically are independent Thus the spermatozoa be killed by X-rays before any to seem living organisms to is the done body, and permanent sterility then damage cells of the body differences seem to exist the results. Amongst
It is claimed, for instance, that the sensoryin their resistivity. nerves are first paralyzed by violet radiation and that intense
violet light
ficient for
may
In some eruptive into invading bacilli. of the skin ulceration as fections, smallpox, (leading to markto if the patient is kept from the seems be avoided ing) light,
human body
and the course of the disease mitigated. As red light, however, seems to have no effect, instead of perfect exclusion of light, which is not very feasible, the use of red light thus seems to offer an essential advantage.
LECTURE
IV.
is intercepted by a body chemical the heat energy into which the radiation is converted. This, however, is not a direct chemical effect of radiation but an indirect effect, resulting from the energy of the
Where
intense radiation
action
may
result
by
radiation,
Direct chemical effects of radiation are frequent. It is such an effect on which photography is based the dissociating action of
:
radiation on silver salts, the chloride in ordinary photographic paper, the bromide and iodide in the negative plate and the quick printing papers. This chemical action is greatest in the violet
and
ultra-violet
is less
hence
and decreases with increasing wave length, in the green, small in the yellow, and almost absent in ultra-red, so that the short waves, blue, violet and
have sometimes been called "chemical rays." This, a misnomer, just as the term "heat rays" sometimes however, to red and ultra-red rays. In so far as when intercepted applied they are converted into heat, all rays are heat rays, but neither the ultra-red nor any other radiation is heat, but it may become heat when it ceases to be radiation. Thus all radiations are chemical rays, that is, produce chemical action, if they strike a body which is responsive to them. The chemical action of radiation is specific to its frequency and seems to be some kind of a resonance effect. We may picture to ourselves that the frequency of vibration of a silver atom is that of violet or ultra-violet light, and therefore, when struck by a wave of this frequency, is set in vibration by resonance, just as a tuning fork is set in vibration by a sound wave of the frequency with which it can vibrate, and if the vibration of the silver atom, in response to the frequency of radiation, becomes sufficiently intense, it breaks away from the atom with which it is chemically
63
64
RADIATION, LIGHT,
in the
AND ILLUMINATION.
silver
combined
compound, the
bromide,
etc.,
and
this
compound thus splits up, dissociates. as a simple resonance vibration ever, must be more complex,
would be especially pronounced at one definite frequency, the decrease for higher frequency of complete resonance, and rapidly and for lower frequencies. The chemical action of radiation on silver compounds, however, does not show such a response to any
definite frequency, but, while strongest in the ultraviolet^ extends over the entire range from the frequency of green light to the highest frequencies of the ultra-violet and
radiation is some form of X-rays. That the chemical activity of the relation which resonance, is, however, made very probable by the weight of the and exists between the active frequency range radiation. the to Thus, while atom or molecule which responds
beyond
up
the fairly heavy silver atom (atomic weight 108) responds to the much lighter rays near the violet end of the visible spectrum, to much higher oxygen atom (atomic weight 16) responds only most destructive of the rays, those to physiologically
frequencies, about one to
two octaves beyond the visible spectrum. These ozone 3 from oxygen very short radiations energetically produce free atoms, molecules 2 ,into 2 probably by dissociating oxygen O3 = 3 molecules + then atoms free these and join existing
,
, :
,
thus forming ozone. Possibly their destructive physiological action is due to this ability to cause resonance with the oxygen atom and thereby destroy molecular structures.32. Response to the long waves of red and ultra-red light thus may be expected from atoms or groups of atoms which are very much heavier than the silver atom, and this indeed seems to be
on the life of the plants. There not by atoms, but by the much heavier groups of atoms, radicals of carbon compounds, which separate and recombine in response to radiations and thus produce in vegetable
the case in the action of radiation
is
the response
organisms the metabolism which we call life. The action of radiation on plant life thus seems to be a chemical action, and this would be the most important chemical action, as on it depends the life of the vegetation and thereby also the This action by which existence of animal life and, thus, our own. the vegetation converts the energy of radiation into chemical energy is related to the presence of chlorophyl, a green body
solution
65
which chlorophyl is present, that color, is, in the leaves and young stems* In those plants in which the leaves have lost their chloroas the function of protection phyl in taking up other functions attack into conversion the stems by against spines in the cacti and trunks have acquired the function of energy supply from
only in those parts of the plant in
usually shown by its green
When the radiation, and show the green color of chlorophyl. leaves die in the fall their chlorophyl disappears and they change to yellow or red color. Those parts of the plants which contain
chlorophyl, mainly the leaves, take carbon dioxide (C0 2 ) from the air through breathing openings (stomata), absorb the radiation,
and convert
energy in splitting
energy into chemical energy, and use this up or dissociating the C0 2 exhausting the and using the carbon in producing the complex carbon
its
,
fiber
(cellulose),
starch, proto-
The energy of plant life thus is derived from radiaplasm, tion and their work is constructive or synthetic, that is, they produce complex chemical compounds from simple ones: the
carbon dioxide of the air, the nitrates and phosphates of the soil, etc. Inversely, the animal organism is analytic, it converts the
chemical energy of complex compounds into mechanical and heat energy by splitting them into simpler compounds, burning them in the lungs or gills. For the supply of mechanical energy which maintains the life, the animal organism thus depends upon
the synthetic work of the vegetation by consuming as food the complex compounds constructed by the plants from the energy
of radiation, eith'er directly (vegetarians), or indirectly, by eating other animals, which in their turn live on the vegetation. Thus,
while the plants take in from the air carbon dioxide C0 2 exhaust the oxygen 2 and convert the C into complex compounds, the
,
animal takes in oxygen 2 by it burns up the complex carbon compounds derived from the plants, and exhausts C0 2 as product of combustion, but in its ultimate result, all life on the earth depends for its energy on radiation, which is made available in the plants by conversion to chemical energy and used as such by the
,
animals.
The radiations which supply the energy of plant life, probably are the long waves of yellow, red and ultra-red light, while the short waves of blue, violet and ultra-violet cannot be used by the
66
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
do not respond, only and thereby bon radicals, and these thus separate and recombine
This can easily be kill the vegetation. plant, but are harmful, and red of light the atoms waves yellow understood: to the long atoms or carof heavier much the groups but
constitute
what we call life. To very short waves, that is, high of atoms cannot respond, but frequencies, these heavy groups thereto and thus by their separation single atoms would respond resonant atomic the groups. That is, the break up and destroy extends radiation of only low frequency dissociation produced by and their in results separation and of atoms thereby
to the groups
the resonant disrecombination to heavier molecules: life, while to the atom and sociation produced by high frequencies extends of the living organmolecules the and destroys thereby splits up Therefore the short waves of radiation, ism, that is, death. are more or less harmful to plants, are which green, blue, etc., reflected are by the ehlorophyl; hence the green not used but radiation is absorbed by chloroviolet extent To some color.
whether the energy of violet light phyl, but it is questionable chemical action, and it is^ rather the to directly contributes is converted into red light by radiation violet that the
probable
light.
fluorescence
and used as red chlorophyl fluoresces red harmful. be to seems radiation violet Excessive
Physical Effects.
33.
Some
of the
effects of radiation
substances have the property of converting some of the of a different radiation which is absorbed by them into radiation that is, act as frequency converter of radiation, wave
Many
length,
when exposed to radiation store some such a manner as to give it out again
afterwards and thus, after exposure to light, glow in the darkness with gradually decreasing intensity, phosphorescence. These effects belong to the least understood
are very common, but phosphorescence such a short time that it can be observed only a few bodies continue to phosby special apparatus, although Fluorescence also is usually for hours and even days. phoresce
67
very
weak
it is
strong.
of frequency in fluorescence always seems to be a and lowering of the frequency, that is, an increase of wave length, to be out seems the also in phosphorescence always light given fluoresand the absorbed than indeed, of lower light
The change
frequency cence and phosphorescence seem to be essentially the same out again phenomenon, radiation is absorbed and its energy given returned the of that and as radiation of lower frequency part
radiation which appears during the absorption we call fluoresThere is, cence, that part which appears later, phosphorescence. the of of the color light between however, frequently a change
fluorescence and phosphorescence and also between phosphorescence immediately after exposure to light and some time afterwards. For instance, some calcite (calcium carbonate or lime-
The red. stone) fluoresces crimson, but phosphoresces dark in the from blue of calcium sulphide changes
phosphorescence beginning to nearly white some time after, etc. Due to the change of frequency to longer waves the longest visible rays, red, orange and yellow, produce no fluorescence or radiavery little thereof, as their fluorescent and phosphorescent ultra-red. invisible tion would usually be beyond the red, in the the most intense Blue, violet and ultra-violet light produce
a lowering in frequency of these radiations brings them well within the visible range.
effects, as
best suited for studying fluorescence as it is not visible, and thus only the fluorescent light is visible; white not show the same marked effect, since the light, for instance, does direct white light is superimposed upon the light of fluorescence.
Ultra-violet light
is
however, are produced by using a source of the frequencies given by fluorescence light which is deficient in and then looking at the fluorescent body through a glass having
Most
brilliant effects,
the same color as that given by fluorescence. Thus the least traces of red fluorescence can be discovered by looking at the the merbody through a red glass, in the illumination given by As the mercury lamp contains practically no red
cury lamp.
black or rays, seen through a red glass everything appears nearly invisible except red fluorescent bodies, which appear self-lumilike red hot nous, glowing in a light of their own, and appear
bodies.
68
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
In the illumination given by the mercury lamp I here drop a few drops of a solution of rhodamine 6 G, rhodamine B and uranine (aniline dyes) into a large beaker of water. As you see,
when
gradually spreading, they appear as brilliant luminous dark a background especially against seen and and red through a red glass green, clouds of orange, I change to the illumination' like clouds of fire.
sinking
down and
they appear and all the brilliancy disappears, given by the incandescent lamp a dull red colored solution. I have we and fluorescence ceases of a silk store of different colored card the show you here sample red a it at glass, in the mercury light all silks. through Looking which a you can pick out by their lumifew, disappear except but nosity they are different colors, pinks, reds, heliotrope, etc., rhodamine. aniline fluorescent red same dye, all containing the A glass plate coated with a thick layer of transparent varnish, colored by rhodamine, appears like a sheet of red hot iron in the while in the light of especially through a red glass,
:
mercury light,
the incandescent lamp it loses all its brilliancy. This solution of rhodamine 6 G in alcohol, fluoresces a glaring of a carbon arc lamp (or orange in the mercury light, in the light Thus you see less brilliant. and it fluoresces green in
daylight) that the color of the fluorescent light is not always the same, but of radiation which depends to some extent on the frequency
causes the fluorescence. Here I have a sheet of paper covered with calcium sulphide and a lump of willemite (zinc silicate) and some pieces of calcite. fluorescence As see, none of them show any appreciable
in the
you mercury
light.
But
if
mercury
light,
the
calcium sulphide phosphoresces brightly in a blue glow, the others I show you all three under the ultra-violet rays of do not.
Now
and you see all three fluoresce brilliantly, in blue, Turning off the light all three continue to glow with about the same color, that is, phosphoresce, but the red fluorescence of the calcite very rapidly decreases, the green glow of the willemite a little slower, but the blue glow of the calcium
(Fig. 11) green and red.
lamp
little.
now
hold
my
hand back of it and close to it and you see the picture of the hand appear on the screen by an increase of the luminosity where by contact with the hand the temperature of the screen was slightly
69
showing the
effect of
show you, calcium sulphide, calzinc silicate (willemite), are not fluo(calcite), rescent or phosphorescent themselves, but their luminescence is
cium carbonate
to
a small percentage of some impurities contained in them. Chemically pure substances and concentrated solutions of the aniline dyes, or these dyes in their solid form, do not show the luminescence, but only when in very dDuted solutions; that is, luminescence as fluorescence and phosphorescence seems to be
due
the property of very diluted solutions of some substances in Thus a sheet of paper or cardboard colored red by others.
rhodamine does not fluoresce, but if a small quantity of rhodamine is added to some transparent varnish and the paper colored
red by a heavy layer of this varnish it fluoresces brightly red. To show you the fluorescent spectrum, I have here a mercury
lamp surrounded by a very diluted solution of rhodamine 6 G and some rhodamine R, contained between two concentric glass As you see, through the spectroscope a broad band cylinders. in red and the green light has faded considerably. the appears
;
lamp, while still different not does give anything like the ghastly effect of light, human faces, as the plain mercury lamp, but contains considerable red rays, though not yet enough. I also show you a mercury lamp surrounded by a screen of a very dilute solution of uranine: you see, its light is bright greenish yellow, but much less ghastly than the plain mercury light and the spectroscope shows the
also notice that the light of this
You
from white
on a fluorescent spectrum, which extends as a continuous luminous band from the green to and beyond the red.
mercury
lines
You
with this uranine screen the mercury lamp gives more light than without it: considerable of its ultra-violet and violet light is converted to yellow and thereby made visible
also see that
or
more
effective.
LECTURE
V.
TEMPERATURE RADIATION.
The most common method of producing radiation is by its temimpressing heat energy upon a body and thereby raising availmethod the was this time short a only to ago Up perature. able for the production of artificial light. The temperature is
34.
by heating a body by the transformation of chemical and in later years by the transenergy, that is, by combustion, formation of electric energy, as in the arc and incandescent
raised
lamp.
from the increasing temperature of a body the radiation is which the required to mainpower body increases. Thus, also, with increase of increases tain the body at constant temperature In a vacuum (as approximately in the incandes-
With
temperature. cent lamp), where heat conduction and heat convection from the into the body is radiating body is excluded, all the power input radiated from it, and in this case the power input measures the
power
of the radiation.
The
total
black or grey
power or rate at which energy is radiated by a heated body varies with the fourth power of its absolute
temperature, that is, If A = surface area, Tl = absolute temperature of the radiator and T2 = absolute temperature of the surrounding objects on which the radiation impinges the total power radiated by the
:
body
is
(Stefan's
Law)
Pr - kA
(T*
?Y),
(1)
where for a black body, as the carbon filament with in watts per square cm., k is probably between
5
given
10-12
and
x 10~12
,
(2)
T2
is
"if
usually atmospheric temperature or about 300 degrees abs. does not differ much from T 2 that is, when considering t
70
TEMPERATURE RADIATION.
ing temperature, as an electric machine, equation written:
(1)
71
can be
P r = kA
or,
(2\
- T2 ) (T* +
T,
T2
-h
T,T2
+ r
);
approximately,
Pr where
4 kAT* (T,
T),
(3)
room temperature (Tl T) the temperature rise of the radiator above room temperature; that is, for moderate temperature differences the radiation power is proportional to
is
the
rise.
(3) gives the law generally used for calculating temperature rise in electric machinery and other cases where the temperature rise is moderate. Obviously, in air the power given off by the heated body, P, is greater than the power radiated, Pr, due to heat convection by air currents, etc., but as heat conduction and convection also are approximately proportional to the
temperature rise, as long as the latter is moderate, equation (3) can still be used, but with the numerical value of k increased to &t so as to include the heat conduction and convection: in = 25 X 10~ 12 to stationary air & x reaches values as high as k^ 13 50 X 1(T T ) becomes As soon, however, as the temperature rise (Z\ the the absolute with temperature T, equation (3) comparable can no longer be used, but the complete equation (1) must be used, and when the temperature of the radiator, T v is very much 4 greater than the surrounding temperature !T2 T 3 becomes negligible compared with T* and equation (1) can, for high temperatures, thus be approximated by:
. 7
,
Pr That
fcATV;
(4)
is, the radiation power, as function of the temperature, gradually changes from proportionality with the temperature rise, at low temperature rise, to proportionality with the fourth power of the temperature for high temperature rises. Inversely then, with increasing power input into the radiator
and thus increasing radiation power, its temperature first rises proportional to the power input and then slower and ultimately approaches proportionality with the fourth root of the power
output:
T Jl = V V kA
72
RADIATION, LIGHT,
is
AND ILLUMINATION.
In Fig. 27
as
shown the radiation curve, with the temperatures the upper ordinates and the radiated power P r as abscissas,
curve with 100 times the scale of abscissas. from 10 deg. cent, to 20 Thus, to double the temperature rise,
the deg. cent., requires doubling
power input. To double, how1000 from deg. cent, to 2000 deg. cent., ever, the temperature rise, 4 4 the of power input from 1273 to 2273 or requires an increase more than ten fold. At high temperature the power input, therewith the increase of temperature. fore, increase enormously
,
FIG. 27.
With
is
the power
above law can be used to calculate the temperature of the radiator from the power input. In air, however, a large part of the energy is carried away by air currents, and this part of the power does not strictly follow the temperature law of radiation, equation (1). For radiators in stationary air
input and
not exposed to a forced blast, as the centrifugal blast of revolving machinery), the total power input for high temperature (as expended by radiation and heat convection) varies with a high power of the temperature, so that the radiation law equation (1) can still be used to get a rough approximation of the
(that
is,
TEMPERATURE RADIATION.
rise is
73
considerable and even in electrical apparatus of fire-proof construction as some rheostats, etc., where a higher temperature rise is permitted, the calculation of this temperature rise must be
of proporapproximated by the general law (1) and not the law latter would as the give entirely wrong results. tionality (3), a For instance, assuming temperature rise of 50 deg. cent, per at bright incandessilicon in. cast a watt per sq. rod, which in. would 200 watts can cence give by (3), a per sq. dissipate
This obviously is imposabout 1400 at melts deg. cent. sible, as silicon the radiator, the intensity of 35. With increasing temperature the at same time the average and of the radiation increases, that also of radiation increases, is, the higher frequenfrequency
temperature
cies increase
and higher frequencies appear, until ultimately frequencies are reached where the radiation becomes visible to the eye, as light. When with increasing temperature the radiation just begins to be
appears as a faint colorless grey, "gespenster grau" exhibiting the same weird and indistinct appearance as are seen at higher intensities in the monochrome blue and violet radiations that is, we see a faint grey light, but when we look at it, it
visible, it
:
has disappeared the reason is that the sensitivity of the sensitive that of the surroundspot of the eye for very faint light is less than thus of disappears as soon light ing retina and the first glimmer
:
With increasing temperathe visible frequencies appear and become ture, first the lowest of further still with increase of temperature visible as red light, and
as
we
focus
it
on
ultra-violet rays gradually orange, yellow, green, blue, violet and to from red orange, yellow, appear and the color thus changes the latter at that temperature yellowish white and then white,
where
the visible radiations are present in the same proporWith still further increase of temperature, tion as in daylight. the violet end of the spectrum would increase faster than the red end and the light thus shift to bluish white, blue and violet. The invisibility of the radiation of low temperature is not due
all
to low intensity. I have here an incandescent lamp at normal If I decrease the power input and thereby the radibrilliancy.
ated power to fa it becomes invisible, but if we move away from the lamp to 10 times the previous distance, we get only T ta the radiation reaching our eyes and still the light is very plainly
74
visible.
AND ILLUMINATION.
,
is
which is visible to the eye the with increases thus as light, increasing temperature, from the radiator does not give where low at zero temperature and very low values visible to be sufficiently high frequencies a maximum at that to red as visible be to when it light, begins
The
just
of the radiation is in temperature where the average frequency decrease it would and visible the again for still higher range,
of radiation shifting temperature by the average frequency The ultra-violet. the into visible the efficiency of light beyond rises with increasing temperathus incandescence production by If the total ture to a maximum, and then decreases again. the of fourth the with varies radiation temperature, it thus power
follows that the visible radiation first varies with a higher power than the fourth, up to the maximum efficiency of the
temperature
with less than the fourth power point, and beyond that increases The of the temperature. temperature at which the maximum
efficiency of light production
is,
where the average visible range, probably is between 5000 and 8000 cleg. cent, and as the most refractory body, carbon, boils at 3750 cleg, cent., this radiator. temperature thus is unattainable with any solid or liquid
frequency of
in the
Most bodies give approximately the same temperature radiathe tion, that is, follow the temperature law (1), differing only by
numerical value of the constant k; that is, with increase of and the average temperature the radiation intensity increases in the same manner with most increases of radiation frequency solid and liquid bodies, so that at the same temperature all the bodies of normal temperature radiation give the same radiation curve; that is, the same distribution of intensity as function of
the frequency and thus the same fraction of visible to total radiaof light production. tion, that is, the same efficiency If T is the absolute temperature in deg. cent, and lw the wave l and length of radiation, the power radiated at wave length w
temperature
is:
P
or,
(l
w)
- c,AlJ
rV
/
(Wien's law) ;
j-i
1
j
P (k) -
c.AlJ
V&_
(Planck's law) ;
TEMPERATURE RADIATION.
where a
T5
radiation; b
5 for normal temperature radiation or black = 1.42, and A = surface area of the radiator.
l
body
to
>,
Integrating the formula of Wien's law over gives the total radiation
:
w from
thus, for a
"
5;
P =
cAT*;
as discussed above.
The maximum energy rate at temperature T occurs at the wave - lm given by length l w
:
dP
which gives
:
(l
w)
__
'
dlw
m T -1-0.284;
0.284
or,
I'm
_ = =
m
50
>
10" 8
thus gives:
T =
284-
^p-
5 6 80 deg. abs.
With normal temperature radiation the efficiency of light production is thus merely a function of the temperature and does not depend upon the material of the radiating body, provided that the material is such as to withstand the temperature. As the efficiency maximum of normal temperature radiation is far beyond the attainable, within the range of temperature available up to the boiling*point of carbon, the efficiency of light production by incandescence continuously increases, but even then
the octave of visible radiation
is
tion curve, and thus the problem of efficient light production is to operate the radiator at the highest possible temperature. The efficiency of light production is rather low even at the
maximum efficiency point, that is, with the average frequency of radiation in the visible range, since this visible range is less than one octave; under these most favorable conditions the visible
76
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
cent of the total energy probably does not much exceed 10 per visible frequencies. the above and below falls the rest radiation, 36. At the highest attainable temperature, the boiling point
of carbon, the
efficiency is
much
cent and
this
for light production in the temperature radiation. It is utilized flame arc carbon The arc gives practically no carbon lamp. incandescent from the comes the tips of the light light, but all the at are which the boiling carbon electrodes, mainly positive, efficient most the thus and temperature give point of carbon
radiation.
of the Obviously, in the carbon arc lamp a very large part heat the heat conduction carbons, wasted is through by energy the of total the and efficiency air convection by currents, etc,, visible the of the of ratio the that carbon arc power is,
lamp,
power input into the lamp, thus is of the radiation the much lower than efficiency, that is, the ratio radiation. total to the power of the visible Thus the efficiency of the carbon arc is considerably increased of smaller by reducing the loss by heat conduction, by the use is of the life the greatly reduced carbons carbons, however,
thereby,
more rapid combustion. The carbon arc lamp thus gives the most efficient incandescent
due
to their
the boiling point operates at the highest temperature, is radiator so the But by doing continuously conof carbon. This the arc. into fed be to sumed and has requires an operating with feasible mechanism and becomes large units of light. only
light, as it
attain the highest possible efficiency of light production by temperature radiation with a permanent radiator, thus requires
To
the use of extremely refractory bodies, since the efficiency increases with the increase of the temperature, and is still very low at the melting point of platinum. To exclude all the losses of energy by heat conduction and
heat convection, the radiator is enclosed in a vacuum, so that all the power input is converted into radiation. Even in this case
the efficiency of light production is still relatively low. The vacuum used in the incandescent lamp, thus, is not only for the purpose of protecting the filament from combustion.
not attack the carbon Filling the globe with some gas which does would do this and yet it would very greatly lower the efficiency,
TEMPERATURE RADIATION.
as can be seen
77
lamp bulb, when the before it burns through. heat, the of an of indifferent low heat capacity However, presence gas lower the of the and filament so evaporation may permit operation
filament drops
into the
at higher temperature, and the gain in efficiency more than makes up for the increased losses, as in the gas filled tungsten lamps.
A search, thus, has been made and is still being made, throughout the entire range of existing bodies, for very refractory mateSuch materials may be chemical elements or compounds. rials. However, the combination of a refractory element with one of very much lower melting point lowers its melting point, and very
may be expected only amongst the combinations of very refractory elements with each other. The chemical elements, arranged in order of their atomic weight, exhibit a periodicity in their properties which permits
refractory compounds, thus,
FIG. 28.
The height
by the darkness
of the background. is, the most refractory elements, are shown on black background. The elewolfram and carbon, lower of somewhat ments melting point are shown on cross
That
shaded background.
ing point, mercury under the metals and helium under metal-
78
loids,
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
are shown on white background, and the easily fusible metals and gaseous metalloids on lightly shaded background. As seen, there are two peaks of refractoriness, one amongst the metals in wolfram (or metalloids, in carbon, and one under the the all two these refractory elements around and peaks tungsten), two also are there depressions, or points are grouped. Inversely, the metalloids, under helium in of minimum melting point, are elements the all grouped, and in meraround which gaseous all the which around easily fusible metals the metals, cury under are grouped. It is interesting to note that the melting point rises towards wolfram from both sides, as diagrammatically illustrated at the
manner that the maximum point top of Fig. 28, in such a in the should be expected space between wolfram and osmium and the unknown element, which belongs in this space of the to have still a higher periodic system, thus should be expected thus and than give a higher efficiency of wolfram, melting point
light production.
have lower melting points than their most refractory element, very refractory compounds thus may be expected only in the compounds between the very refracthat is, amongst a tory elements, in which at least one is metalloid, and titanides. silicides and borides the carbides and possibly incandescent on work the earliest of lamps was 37. Some and Platinum filaments. metal iridium, howcarried out with
As metal
ever,
were not
good
efficiencies,
and
the very refractory metals were not yet available in sufficient purity. A small percentage of impurities, however, very greatly lowers the melting point, especially with metals of very high
For instance, wolfram carbide contains only atomic weight. of and 97 per cent of wolfram and even 0.1 per carbon 3 per cent cent of carbon in wolfram metal thus means that over 3 per cent of the metal consists of the easily fusible carbide. Very soon, therefore, metal filaments were abandoned and carbon used as lamp filament. While carbon is the most refractory body, remaining solid up to 3750 deg. cent., it was found that the
carbon filament could nbt be operated much above 1800 deg. cent, without shortening the life of the lamp below economic limits by the evaporation of the carbon and the resulting blackening of the lamp globes. All bodies evaporate below their melting point.
TEMPERATURE RADIATION.
79
Thus water evaporates considerably below the boiling point and even below the freezing point ice and snow gradually disappear
:
by evaporation even
the temperature never rises above the Considerable differences, however, exist between
if
Thus water and benzine have practically the same boiling point, but at the same distance below the boiling point, benzine evaporates much
than water; that is, has a much higher vapor tension. Carbon has a very high vapor tension, that is, shows a very rapid evaporation far below the boiling point, and since in the incandescent lamp the carbon vapor condenses and is deposited on the globe and carbon is black, it blackens the globe and obstructs the
faster
Also, the decrease of the filament section by evaporation increases its resistance and thereby decreases the power consumplight.
and so still further lowers the efficiency. While, therefore, carbon remains solid up to 3750 deg. cent., at about 1800 deg. cent, its rate of evaporation is such as to lower the candle power of the lamp by 20 per cent in 500 hr. life, and at this temperature it gives only an output of one candle power for 3.1 watts Operating the carbon filament at higher temperature input. would increase the efficiency and thus reduce the cost of energy for the same amount of light, but would decrease the useful life of the lamp and, therefore, increase the cost of lamp renewals, and the most economical operation, as determined by balancing the cost of lamp renewals against the cost of energy, is reached by operating at such temperatures that the candle power of the lamp decreases by 20 per cent within 500 hr. life. The life of a lamp down to a decrease of candle power by 20 per cent, thus, is called the useful life, and when comparing the efficiencies of incandescent lamps it is essential to compare them on the basis of the same length of useful life: 500 hours with the carbon filament, since
tion
obviously by shortening the life higher efficiencies could be reached in any incandescent lamp. The operating temperature of the carbon filament lamp, thus, was limited by the vapor tension of carbon and not
by
its
boiling poi^itl
This limitation of carbon lead to the revival of the metal filament lamps in recent years. First arrived the osmium lamp,
with 1.5 watts per candle power. The melting point of osmium is very high, but still very much below that of carbon, but the vapor tension of osmium is very low even close to its melting point, so
80
that
RADIATION, LIGHT,
osmium could be operated
AND ILLUMINATION.
at temperatures far closer to its without appreciable evaporation; that is, without melting point and falling off of candle power, or in other words, blackening could be run at a temperature from which carbon was excluded by its too rapid evaporation. Osmium, however, is a very rare metal of the platinum group, and found only in very limited quantities in very few places and is one of those substances of which no search could very greatly increase the supply, and while one pound of osmium is sufficient for some 60,000 filaments, the total amount of osmium which has ever been found on earth would not be sufficient for one year's supply of incandescent lamps. Osmium, therefore, was excluded from general use by its
;
limited supply.
The metal tantalum does not seem to have quite as high a meltat 2 watts per ing point as osmium, as it can be operated only rare is a also Tantalum metal, but, unlike candle power. very in small in is found it quanvery many places, though osmium,
but it is one of those substances, like the rare earth metals used in the Welsbach mantle, of which it seems that the supply could be indefinitely increased when required by the industries and the prices thus would go down with the demand, just as has been the case with the rare earths of the Welsbach mantle. Last of allj however, was made available the most refractory of all metals, wolfram or tungsten, and permitted to lower the specific
tities,
consumption to
to 1.25 watts
and
finally, in
the gas
filled
lamp,
Wolfram melts far lower to less than 0.5 watts per candle power. than carbon, probably at about 3200 deg. cent., but far above the temperature to which the carbon filament is limited by evaporapractically no vapor tension below its melting can be operated far above the temperature of the carbon point, thus and Tungsten (or gives a much higher efficiency. filament, as the metal is called, tungsten is the name of its rather wolfram, ore) is a fairly common metal, its salts are industrially used to a
tion,
and having
it
its
supply practically
differ
that their temperature is limited by their melting point and not by evaporation, as is the case with the carbon filament, and thus
ended by the destruction of the filament some weak spot, but not by blackening. by melting through at
their useful life is usually
TEMPERATURE RADIATION.
vacuum
81
These filament lamps do not blacken the globe, except when the is defective or becomes defective, and by the residual
gases in the lamp globe volatile compounds are formed, as tungsten oxides, which then deposit on the globe and terminate the life of the lamp. Even then their blackening is characteristically different from that of the carbon filament, in that it occurs very rapidly, and the lamp, after running possibly for hundreds or thousands of hours without blackening, suddenl}7 blackens within a few days and thereby becomes inoperative, while with the carbon filament the blackening is gradual throughout
the
life.
38.
light
the use of these refractory metals the efficiency of production by temperature radiation has been greatly
By
increased, by permitting the use of higher temperatures in the radiator than were permissible with the carbon filament clue to its evaporation. However, regarding the rate of evaporation,
different modifications of carbon
tics.
show very different characterisThe carbon filaments first used in incandescent lamps were made by carbonizing vegetable fiber, as bamboo, or by squirting
a solution of cellulose through a small hole into a hardening soluand carbonizing this structureless horn-like fiber. These filaments had a very high vapor tension, thus could not be run as hot as the modern carbon filament and so gave a lower efficiency. They are now used only as base filaments, that is, as core on which a more stable form of carbon is deposited. Such a form of carbon was found in carbon deposited on the filament by heating it in the vapor of gasolene or other hydrocarbons. This carbon deposit is of much lower electric instance than the base on which it was deposited, its negative temperature coefficient of electric resistance is lower and its vapor tension so much lower as to make it possible to operate the lamp at a specific consumption of 3.1 watts per candle power. Of late years a still more stable form of carbon has been found in the so-called "metallic carbon," produced from the gasolene deposited carbon shell of the filament, by exposing it for several minutes to a temperature at the boiling point of carbon; that is, the highest attainable temperature in an electric carbon tube furnace. Hereby the the inner base gasolene deposited carbon of the filament shell
tion
characteristics:
a low
82
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
ture coefficient of electric resistance, metallic luster and elasticity and very low vapor tension, so that it can be run at higher temto a consumption of 2.5 to 2.6
specific perature corresponding watts per candle power, with very little blackening.
These metal-
to the lized carbon filament lamps exhibit characteristics similar limited is life by 'breakage largely metal filament lamps; their
carbon are exhausted or be found, which permit still more stable forms near to the boiling point of raising the filament temperature as carbon as the temperature of the wolfram filament is to its melt* an efficiency superior to that of the ing point and thereby reach does not appear entirely tungsten lamp, remains to be seen, but exists in a number of "allotropic" modifiCarbon impossible.
possibilities of of carbon will
and "metallic phos"yellow phosphorus," "red phosphorus" other than extent element, probably to a any greater phorus") due to the tendency of the carbon atom to join with other carbon atoms into chains and rings, which tendency is the case of the
infinite
number
of carbon
compounds.
and the groups: the chain carbon derivates (methane-derivates) are far latter The derivates derivates). (benzol ring carbon moleof the the since at breakage more stable high temperatures,
cule
by temperature vibration
:
is less
liable in
a ring structure
than a chain a single break splits the molecule in a chain formait still holds together until the tion, while with a ring formation break closes again. Chain hydrocarbons at higher temperatures It is, therefore, reasonable usually convert to ring hydrocarbons. left to assume that the carbon skeleton by the carbonization of of the two characterisin either the hydrocarbons also -may exist
tic
atomic groupings
as chain carbon
that the latter exhibits a much greater stability at high temperaCellulose ture than the former, that is, a lower vapor tension.
a chain hydrocarbon, and as in carbonization it never passes through a fluid state, the molecular structure of its carbon atom filaprobably remains essentially unchanged. Thus the base
is
* As carbon boils, at and the atmospheric pressure, below its melting point, to be solid, with limiting temperature is that at which the filament ceases carbon the limit is the boiling point temperature, while with tungsten it is
the melting point.
TEMPERATURE RADIATION.
ment would be a chain carbon, and
tension, that
is,
83
its
up
for.
of the molecules
by
benzol derivates, and thus give a carbon deposit consisting largely of molecules in which the carbon atoms are grouped in rings. These molecules, therefore, are more stable at high temperatures, and thus exhibit the lower vapor
is,
shown by the gasolene deposited coating of the base This deposited carbon, however, must be expected to have numerous side chains attached to the ring nuclei of the molecules, and the side chains are relatively easily split off at high temperatures, as is well known of the benzol derivates. As a
tension
filament.
result thereof, this form of carbon, which I may call "intermediate carbon," still shows a considerable vapor tension, due to the side chains of the ring structure. Exposure to extremely high temperatures splits off these side chains, which then re-
arrange into the only form of carbon stable at these very high " " temperatures; that is, ring structure and the metallic form of carbon produced from the gasolene deposited carbon by the electric furnace, thus would be largely ring structure of the carbon
molecule, that is, the condensation of numerous rings, similar to that found in anthracene, etc. It, therefore, would have a very high stability at high temperature; that is, be difficult to split up
characteristic of the
me-
In other words, the high vapor tension of most tallic carbon. forms of carbon would be the result of the dissociation of complex carbon molecules of chain structures, or of side chains of ring structures, and a carbon atom of complete ring structure 'thus would only show the vapor tension corresponding to the molecular weight, which is very high, due to the large number of atoms in the molecule. Thus two characteristic allotropic modifications of carbon may exist besides the transparent carbon or diamond (a). Chain carbon: high resistance, negative temperature co:
the
range
of
84
metallic
RADIATION, LIGHT,
resistivities),
AND ILLUMINATION.
temperature coefficient of relow vapor tension at high temperatures. The latter one, obviously, is best suited as an incandescent It may be possible to introduce into the ring structure radiator. of the carbon molecule other atoms of very refractory nature, as boron, titanium, silicon, and by their chemical affinity still further increase the stability of the molecule, so that it does not appear outside of the possibility to find a form of carbon which as radiator would be superior to any metal filament. If carbon could be
positive
sistance, metallic character,
operated as near to its limit of solidness as tungsten, it would give about 0.15 watts per candle. 39. Most bodies show similar characteristic in their temperature radiation ; that is, the total radiation varies in the same manner with the temperature as the fourth power of the absolute temperature. Thus the distribution of the frequencies in the radiation is the same for the same temperature, varies in the same manner with the temperature, so that the distribution of the
radiation
teristic
different frequencies
is
a charac-
body,
radiator.
normal temperature
bodies of normal temperature radiation give the same intensity, or power of radiation, at the same temperature, that is,
Many
have the same radiation constant k in equation (1) these bodies " are called "black bodies," and their radiation black body radia;
Their radiation is the maximum temperature radiation given by a body. Other bodies of normal radiation give a lower intensity or radiation, but so that their radiation is at any temtion."
of a black body.
7
perature and for any frequency the same fraction of the radiation Their radiation, then, is called "grey body
radiation/ and they also would follow the radiation law equation (1), but with a constant k, which is a fraction of the constant
Z>&
For temperature radiation the following law applies "The temperature radiation of a body is at any temperature and at any frequency the same percentage of black body radiation
:
TEMPERATURE RADIATION.
as the absorbed radiation of the
radiation." (KirchhofFs law.)
85
body
is
This law relates the behavior of a body towards radiation impinging upon it from other bodies, with its behavior as radiator.
A body which absorbs all the impinging radiation, that is, a black body, gives a maximum temperature radiation, and this An radiation, thus, has been called the black body radiation.
opaque grey body of albedo a, that is, a body which reflects the same fraction a of the impinging radiation and thus absorbs the
part (1 the part
a) of the
(1
is
a) of black
body
We,
radiation.
That
is, its
radiation
constant
(1
a)
any opaque body, thus, is the radiabody multiplied by 1 minus its albedo a.
of
For a perfectly white or perfectly transparent body, the radiation constant, thus, would be zero; that is, this body would give no temperature radiation, would not become incandescent at
high temperatures.
40. colored body was defined as a body which reflects or transmits different fractions of the impinging radiation for dif-
ferent frequencies. Such a colored body usually absorbs different of the parts impinging radiation for different frequencies and as
radiator, then, tions of black
would
body
for different frequencies give different fracradiation; that is, its radiation for some
frequencies would be a greater part of black " radiation of such a body is called colored
colored
the spectrum, that is, for different frequencies, thus differs from that of the black or grey body at the same temperature, that is,
colored radiation
is
follow the temperature law equation (1). For instance, if in Fig. 29, 1 is the curve of distribution of the
ntensity of radiation as function of the frequency, at a certain temperature, as the melting point of tungsten, for a black body; *rey body radiation would be represented by curve II or III, in vhich the ordinates are a constant fraction of those of curve I.
3urve
has the height 1 - a = 0.7 times ,hat of black body radiation I, that is, radiates 70 per cent as
II, for
albedo a
0.3,
86
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
= 0.6, or a radiation body. Curve III corresponds to albedo a constant 1 - a = 0.4 times that of the black body. Colored body radiation, then, would be represented by curves IV and V. Representing the octave of visible radiation by L, the area of the curve within the limits of L to the 'total area of the radiation curve, gives the ratio of power visible to total radiation, or the "radiation efficiency." As seen, this radiation efficiency is the same for black and grey bodies, I, II, III, and the only difference between the black and the grey body is that with the grey body the amount of light per unit radiating surface is less, but the
in
X
FIG. 29.
power required to maintain the temperature is correspondingly less, hence the efficiency is the same and merely a larger radiator surface required to produce the same amount of light; the larger the surface, the higher the albedo of the radiator. For colored radiators, however, the radiation efficiency may be different and In the colored body IV, in which the radiation in frequently is.
the visible range is a greater part of the black body radiation I than in the invisible range, the radiation efficiency is greater than that of colorless or normal radiation at the same temperature; that is, such a colored body gives a higher efficiency of light production than corresponds to normal radiation at the same temperature* Such, for instance, is the case with the material of
TEMPERATURE RADIATION.
87
the Welsbach mantle and to some extent probably also with the tungsten jfilament. Inversely, the colored body V, in which the radiation in the visible range is a lower percentage of black body radiation than in the invisible range, gives a lower efficiency of light production. Such, for instance, is the case with glass, which, therefore, would be an abnormally inefficient incandescent
light producer. To illustrate the difference in the radiation of black
and grey
a bodies, I show you here a piece of graphite rod, around which it is then and in an is foil open spiral wrapped strip of platinum enclosed in a transparent quartz tube. Heating it in the bunsen
you see the graphite becomes bright red, while the platinum surrounding it is far less luminous and the quartz tube is not luminous at all, though all three have practically the same temperflame,
foil
the ature, or if anything, the outer quartz tube is the hottest, interior graphite rod the coolest. Still, the graphite gives the
greatest
maximum radiation;
body
is a black body and thus'gives the platinum as a grey body gives less radiation at the same temperature and the quartz as a transparent which absorbs almost no radiation, thus, also, gives out
amount
of light: graphite
almost no radiation, that is, does not become luminous at a temperature at which the graphite is bright red. I now drop a small platinum spiral into a mixture of the nitrates of thoria and ceria (the rare earths of the Welsbach mantel), and then immerse it in the bunsen flame. The nitrates convert to
which oxides, which fluff out into a very light and porous mass, far brighter in a see light, greenish intense, slightly very glow you than the platinum wire immersed in the same flame. The distribution of intensity of this radiation differs from that correof visible sponding to any temperature, and the percentage visible spectrum radiation, especially from the center of the is a colored (greenish yellow) , is abnormally large. This, therefore, than the normal radiator, giving a higher radiation efficiency temperature radiation. radiation 'which does not follow the temperature law of
called
"selective radiation."
Colored body
reflect-
is
selective radiation.
more or less colored and ing or transmitting it, most bodies are colorless bodies: black, ecrev, white, transparent, the exception.
88
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
Regarding the temperature radiation produced by the body as radiator, most bodies are more nearly colorless, black or grey bodies, that is give normal radiation or nearly so, and colored or
;
selective radiation of considerable intensity is the exception. Obviously, no perfectly black, or even perfectly colorless radia-
tor exists, but even carbon shows a slight selectivity, a slightly greater intensity of radiation at the red end of the spectrum than
corresponds to the temperature. Perfectly black body radiation, however, is the radiation at the inside of a hollow body of uniform temperature, and the laws of black body radiation, thus, are studied on the radiation
in the interior of a closed shell with
temperature. In the interior of such a hollow body of uniform temperature every surface element radiates to every other element and receives
radiation from every other surface element, that is, the surface element A 1 receives as much radiation from element 2 as ele-
ment A 2
receives from
Ar
Of the radiation received by a surface element A l by the radiation law, that part which exists in the radiation produced by A is absorbed, that part which does not exist in the temperature radiation of A l} is reflected, and the total radiation issuing from
make up complete
is
low radiator
which it has the albedo a, only the part (1 a) is produced by it, but the part a of the impinging radiation of this frequency is reflected, and the total radiation of this frequency, thus, still is unity, that is, back body radiation. Obviously, the body cannot be perfectly closed, but must contain an opening, through which the interior radiation is observed, but if this opening is sufficiently small it introduces no
radiation, for
appreciable error.
The production of black body radiation from the interior of a hollow body obviously requires that the walls of the body be opaque; that is, that all the radiation produced inside of it is
either absorbed or reflected,
and
also
TEMPERATURE RADIATIOX.
89
that all the frequencies of black body radiation are present, since evidently, no frequency which is entirely absent in the radiation of the body could be produced by reflection. Furthermore, all
the radiation must be temperature radiation, that is, no luminescence exist in the interior of the body. These requirements are
easily fulfilled, except at extremely high temperatures. 41. The radiation laws offer a means of measuring temperature, and the only means for those very high temperatures where
the gas thermometer (that is, the measurement of temperature by the expansion of a gas) and the thermo-electric couple or the resistance p}Tometer cannot longer be used, as no material exists
which remains
furnaces, etc.
solid at
As the total intensity of the radiation varies with the temperature, and the ratio of the intensity of radiation of any definite
frequency to the total radiation, or the ratio of intensities at different frequencies of radiation, is a function of the temperature, either can be used for measuring the temperature. For instance, measuring the intensity of the total radiation which in vacuum enclosed radiators as incandescent lamp filaments is done by measuring the power input gives the temperature if the body is a black body and its radiating surface measured. If one temperature is known, as, for instance, by the melting point of some substance, by comparing the total radiation power with that at the known temperature, other temperatures can be measured. .Determining the ratio of the power of the visible radiation, that is, the radiation efficiency and that of the total radiation thus -gives the temperature for black bodies as well as grey " body radiators, and thus is frequently called the black body
two
temperature."
comparing the intensity of any two radiations we get the temperature. This could be done by using two wave lengths For instance, the ratio of the of radiation in the visible range. and blue radiation gives the temthe the of yellow intensity
By
in perature. Resolving, then, the radiation by a prism S a and shutter a out a into by cutting spectrum, t Fig. 30, definite width of yellow and of blue light, and combining these
which
we get a resultant green color and t 2 again by the mirror is intermediate between yellow and blue, and the nearer to the blue, the higher the temperature. Arranging, then, the mov-
90
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
S2 below Sl with a single opening, we can by it cut out a single green color, and by moving the shutter S2 bring this to coincidence in shade with the resultant color of shutter S19 and the position of the shutter S2 then measures the temperature. The scale of such a direct vision pyrometer may either be calculated from the radiation laws, or it may be calibrated by some known temperatures, as the melting points of gold, platinum,
able shutter
boiling point of carbon, etc. number of types of such visual pyrometers oped, and are very convenient.
is that they apply only when the normal temperature radiation, but give wrong results
is
present.
Thus the
FIG. 30.
radiation given by the interior of a closed body of uniform temperature ceases to be black body radiation if the interior is filled
is
For instance, using such a visual pyrometer for the interior of the carbon tube furnace used for metallizing carbon filaments gives, frequently, quite impossible results, temperatures above those of the sun, due to the error caused by the
luminescent silicon vapor
filling
the tube.
measurements by radiation are the the nearer the radiation frequencies are which greater together are used for the measurement, hence are greatest with the visual pyrometers, least in the methods based on the total radiation
errors of temperature
The
power.
42. of the intensity of the radiation to that of a black
TEMPERATURE RADIATION.
91
same temperature Is different for different frequencies of radiation, and the average wave length of radiation and the total
intensity of radiation of a colored body thus do not vary with the temperature in the same manner as is the case with the black and
the grey body, that is, the normal radiation. The intensity of colored body radiation at any frequency cannot exceed the intensity of radiation of a black body at the same temperature and
frequency, since the radiation of the black body is the maximum temperature radiation at any temperature and frequency.
body which gives at some frequency a greater intensity of radiation than a black body of the same temperature is called
luminescent, that
is,
Char-
acteristic of heat luminescence, thus, is an excess of the intensity of radiation over that of a black body of the same temperature for
of frequencies,
that of the radiation frequencies escent body exceeds the black body.
is
not certain whether such heat luminescence exists. efficiency of light production of the Welsbach manof the lime tel, light, the magnesium flame, the Nernst lamp, etc., are frequently attributed to heat luminescence.
The high
The rare oxides of the Weisbach mantel, immersed in the bunsen flame, give an intensity of visible radiation higher than that of a black body, as a graphite rod, immersed in the same flame, and if we assume that these oxides are at the same temperature as the flame in which they are immersed, their light must be
heat luminescence and not colored radiation, as the latter cannot exceed that of a black body. It is possible, however, that these oxides are at a higher temperature than the flame surrounding them, and as the radiation intensity of a black body rapidly rises with the temperature, the light radiation of the rare oxides, while greater than that of a black body of the flame temperature, may still be less than that of a black body of the same temperature which the oxides have, and their radiation, thus, colored temperature radiation and not luminescence. Very porous materials, as platinum sponge, absorb considerable quantities of
gases, and by bringing them in close contact with each other in their interior cause chemical reaction between them, where such
can occur, and thus heat and a temperature rise above surrounding space. Thus platinum sponge, or fine platinum wire, immersed
92
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
and alcohol vapor at ordinary temperature, becomes incandescent by absorbing alcohol vapor and air and The oxides of the Welsbach mantel, causing them to combine. as produced by the deflagration of their nitrates, are in a veryporous state, and thus it is quite likely that in the bunsen flame they absorb gas and air and cause them to combine at a far more rapid rate than in the flame, and thereby rise above the flame
in a mixture of air
temperature. An argument in favor of this hypothesis is, that these oxides, when immersed in the bunsen flame in close contact with a good heat conductor, as platinum, and thereby kept from rising above the flame temperature, do not show this high lumiI have here a small, fairly closely wound platinum spiral with these oxides. Immersing it in the bunsen flame you see the oxides and the platinum wire surrounding them glow with the same yellow light, but see none of the greenish luminosity exhibited by the oxide when free in the flame, except at a few points at which the oxide projects beyond and is not cooled by the platinum spiral. The absence of a high selective luminosity of these oxides, wheh heated electrically in a vacuum or in an
nosity.
filled
The gradual decay of the inactive gas, also points this way. radiators shown such may be clue to their becoming by luminosity
this would account for the very rapid by sintering of the lime of the decay light cylinder in the hydro-oxygen flame, and the very small decay of the more refractory oxides in the
less porous,
Welsbach mantel
of luminescence, as
but
it
also
may be
and phosphorescence.
In favor of heat luminescence as the cause of the very high efficiency of these radiators is, however, the similarity of the conditions under which it occurs, with those we find in fluorescence and phosphorescence. Just as neither calcium sulphide nor zinc silicate nor calcium carbonate arc fluorescent or phosphorescent,
when chemically
pure, but the fluorescence and phosphorescence are due to the presence of a very small quantity of impurities, as manganese, so the pure oxides, thoria,erbia, ceria donot give very
;
high luminosity in the bunsen flame, but the high luminosity is shown by thoria when containing a very small percentage of other
oxides.
is
While the existence of heat luminescence in these rare oxides not certain, no theoretical reason exists against it, as at ordi-
TEMPERATURE RADIATION.
93
nary temperature we have in phosphorescence the same phenomenon of the production of a radiation exceeding in intensity that of a black body of the same temperature the black body radiation at ordinary temperature contains no visible rays, while that of a phosphorescent body does. Heat-luminescence, thus, may be considered as fluorescence at high temperature. However, to some extent, the question of the existence of heat luminescence depends upon the definition of luminescence, and any colored radiation may be considered as heat luminescence of a grey body. For instance, the radiation represented by curves IV and V of Fig. 29, may be considered as colored temperature But radiation, as they are below black body radiation, curve I.
:
as they exceed at
of grey
body
we compare such curves of normal temperature radiation is, with a grey body radiation of the same power at the same temperature all such selective radiation can be considered as heat luminescence. While the term "luminescence" is usually applied only to
If,
may
then,
abnormally high radiation in the visible range, in its general physical meaning it applies to abnormal radiation of any frequency range, and curve V in Fig. 29, for instance, would be the curve of a grey body, which luminesces in the ultra-red, while curve IV would be that of a grey body, in which the heat luminescence
is
In general, however, it is preferable to consider as luminescence only such radiation as exceeds the black body radiation of the same temperature, and this will be done in the following, while radiations which differ in their frequency distribution from the black body, without exceeding it in intensity, are considered as
colored
body
radiations.
LECTURE
VI.
LUMINESCENCE.
All methods of producing radiation, and more particularly than the temperature radiation or incandescence, are other light, generally comprised by the name luminescence. Some special cases of luminescence have already been discussed in the phenomena of fluorescence and phosphorescence, represented by the
43.
conversion of the radiation absorbed by a body into radiation of a different wave length. Usually luminescence at ordinary temperature, or at moderate temperatures, that is, temperatures below incandescence, is called
fluorescence or phosphorescence.
Fluorescence is the production of radiation from the energy supplied to and absorbed by the fluorescent body, while phosphorescence is the production of radiation from the energy stored
in the phosphorescent body. This energy may be derived from internal changes in the body, as slow combustion, or may have
as by been received by the body at some previous time to a calcium screen absorbs the sulphide exposure energy light
of incident radiation, stores
it
in
radiates
it.
Fluorescence and phosphorescence usually occur simultaneously the energy supplied to such a luminescent body brings about certain changes in the body as vibrations of the atoms,
:
or whatever
tion.
it luminesce, the kinetic represent energy storage and when the energy energy of the luminescent vibration, etc. supply to the body ceases, the radiation issuing from the body does not instantly cease, but continues, with gradually decreasing intensity, until the stored energy is dissipated the body phos:
be which cause the body to send out radiaas this energy is supplied, the radiation of the continues, that is, it fluoresces. The changes iu the body
it
may
As long
94
LUMINESCENCE.
phoresces.
95
Inversely, fluorescent radiation probably does not appear instantly at full intensity, as energy has first to be stored. The persistence of the luminescence after the power supply has
stopped, as phosphorescence, is very short,' except with a few substances, where it lasts for clays. Where the energy of phosphorescent radiation is supplied by the energy of chemical
as with yellow phosphorus change in the body obviously the phosphorescence persists as long as these chemical changes can occur. The different forms of luminescence may be distinguished by the character of the energy which is converted into radiation. The conversion of radiation energy into radiation of different
wave
thus
It
may be caUed radio-fluorescence and radio-phosphorescence. was discussed in Lecture II. The same bodies, exposed to an electric discharge in a vacuum (Geissler tube or Crooke tube) show electro-luminescence, fluorescence as well as phosphorescence, and usually with the same
color as in radio-luminescence.
Thermo-luminescence is exhibited by some materials, as the violet colored crystals of fluorite (CaFL,), which, when slightly it is this which gave the name "fluoreswarmed, luminesce
Some
solutions,
when
crystallizing,
show
may
Chemical phosphorescence is exhibited by yellow phosphorus its solutions, which in the air glow by slow combustion, at ordinary atmospheric temperature. As the ignition point of phosphorus, that is, the temperature where it spontaneously ignites, is little above atmospheric temperature, the chemical phosphorescence of phosphorus occurs at temperatures a few degrees below ignition; it ceases, however, at very low temperature. The chemical luminescence, as shown by phosphorus, is not an exceptional phenomenon, but many substances exhibit chemi-
and
cal phosphorescence at temperatures a few degrees below their With ignition temperature, as the result of slow combustion.
those substances which have an ignition point above incandescence, this cannot be observed, but it is observed, for instance, in carbon bisulphide, CS 2 which ignites spontaneously at about
,
96
180
RADIATION, LIGHT,
cleg, cent.,
AND ILLUMINATION.
this
phoresces in air,
by slow combustion.
shown by many forms
is biological phosphorescence
some bacilli of putrefaction phosphoresce, and are the cause of the faint glow occasionally observed in decaying food, espefishes. Amongst insects and numerous sea animals of difdaily
ferent classes, especially deep-sea animals, phosphorescence is but its origin, that is, the mechanism of light
unknown.
of mica, or shaking a well-exhausted splitting a sheet tube containing mercury, flashes of light are seen in the darkness. but due to electrostatic This, however, is not real phosphorescence
When
by fluorescence and phosphorescence of solids a continuous or liquids, gives spectrum, that is, is a mixture of all is the case with temperature radiation; it as frequencies, just from temperature radiation by the distribudiffers, however, or less characthe of tion energy in the spectrum, which is more to some and also, of the luminescent extent, the of teristic body, calcium Thus luminescence. the of crystalline method exciting with blue the in white fluoresces light X-ray, 4Ca, tungstate, in alcoholic 6 rhodamine the aniline G, ultra-violet light; dye, solution fluoresces green in daylight, crimson in the light of the a maximum mercury lamp; willemite (calcium silicate) shows
The
light given
W0
some
So far, fluorescence and phosphorescence nave not yet found any extended industrial application.
44.
Some
As pyro4uminescenceorheatJuminescence,mu$t be considered all at some wave length radiation, produced by heat, which exceeds same temperature. the at radiation the intensity of the black body is Whether real pyro-luminescence exists, uncertain, but by an extension of the definition any colored temperature radiation may be considered as heat luminescence of a grey body of an same
albedo which as normal temperature radiation would give the total radiation at the same temperature as the colored Heat luminescence has been discussed already under radiator.
colored radiation.
LUMINESCENCE.
Chemical Luminescence.
97
intense chemical changes take place at higher temluminescence I have here an ordifrequently occurs. perature, non-luminous bunsen flame. I a dip nary, platinum wire into a solution of lithium chloride, LiCl, and then hold it into the lower edge of the flame: the flame colors a bright red, and through the
Whenever
spectroscope you see a bright deep red line and a less bright orange line, the spectrum of Li. After a little while, the color-
ing disappears by the LiCl evaporating from the wire, and the flame again becomes non-luminous. I repeat the same experiment, but dip the platinum wire into sodium chloride, NaCl,
and you see the flame colored brightly yellow, and the spectroscope shows one yellow line, the sodium line D. Dipping
solution,
the platinum wire into thallium chloride, T1C1, I color the flame a bright deep green, the characteristic Tl spectrum, which has one
bright green line. As you see, the green coloring disappears more rapidly than the yellow did, and the flame turns yellow; the Tl salt is more volatile than the sodium salt, evaporates more rapidly, and as it contains some Na as impurity, the latter be-
comes
orated.
Tl has evap-
their elements
salts are evaporated, split up into flame the gases, and recombine, and by these by chemical changes the atoms of Li, Na or Tl are set in vibration, and as vapors, being free to vibrate without mutual interference,
definite frequency
they vibrate with their characteristic frequency, that is, give a and thus color of the light, independent of the if we introduce the same salts into the carbon arc temperature;
get the same color and the same spectrum lines, only much brighter, as at the much higher temperature of the arc flame the vibration is far more intense; but it is of the same frequency, and in this respect essentially differs from temperature radiation
we
which varies in frequency with the temperature. In the same manner by introducing Sr, Ba or Ca salts in the bunsen flame, the flame is colored with other characterThe spectroscope shows istic colors; bright red, green, orange of definite lines a number iii every case a spectrum having in the for Sr, in the red numerous most which are brightest and for Ca. In general, in the orange yellow green for Ba, and
98
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
many
lines in
the visible range. As Sr, Ba, Ca, are much less volatile than Li, Na, Tl, to get of the chlorides, the good effects in the bunsen flame, instead or chlorates the or perchlorates are used, nitrates, preferably
which are more unstable, and thus easier split up and carried into the flame. At the much higher temperature of the carbon arc, the chlorides, or even the still more refractory oxides are used. Chemical luminescence is used industrially in fireworks and colored signal lights; salts of these metals with acids which contain a large amount of easily split off oxygen, as nitrates, or more commonly chlorates and perchlorates, are mixed with some combustible material, as charcoal, sugar, sulphur,
etc.
antimony sulphide,
burns with the oxygec and in the focus of this given off by of the metal is luminescence intense intense chemical action, a Ba a Sr Thus green, Ca an orange bright red, gives produced. a blue coloring. yellow, copper ammon
ignited, the combustible the nitrates or chlorates,
When
Electro-luminescence of Gases
45.
and Vapors.
Industrially this is the most important form of luminesSolids and liquids can be made to luminesce only indicence. rectly by exposure to electric discharges, as electrical fluorescence,
and under gases here and in the following we Gases, however include vapors as, for instance, the carbon vapor, which is the become electro-luminescent by conductor in the carbon arc
being used as conductors of the electric current. It is a characteristic of electric conduction of the gases that this conduction is accompanied by the production of radiation, and in the electric
conduction of gases we thus find the means of a more direct conversion of electric energy into radiation, and thus into light. It is, therefore, in this direction that a radical advance in the efficiency of light production would be possible, and the subject
of electric conduction of gases (including vapors) thus is of the
highest importance.
electric conduction in gases exist: disruptive as conduction, represented by the Geissler discharge or the electrostatic spark, and continuous conduction, as 'represented by the
Two
forms of
electric arc.
99
Disruptive Conduction.
In disruptive conduction the conductor is the gas which fills the space between the terminals, and in carrying the current is
made luminous.
of the gas
color of the light and its spectrum is that the space, and the electrode material has no effect on the phenomenon, is immaterial (in the Geissler tube, or the spark gap, any material may be used as terminal, if it
The
which
fills
otherwise
is
not destroyed by whatever heat by the chemical action of the gas in the space, etc.) usually, however, the electrodes gradually disintegrate in disruptive conduction. Disruptive conduction is discontinuous; that is, no current exists below a certain definite voltage, while above this voltage
is
suitable, that
is, is
there
is
current.
The voltage
It
:
is
supply voltage rises above this value current; drops below the disruptive voltage the current ceases, but begins again spontaneously as soon as the voltage rises above the disruptive value. Disruptive conduction thus occurs equally well with unidirectional, with alternating, or with oscillating currents. It is best studied with alternating or oscillating voltage supply, as with a steady unidirectional voltage, the disruptive conduction, that is, conduction by the gas filling the space between the electrodes, tends to change to continuous conduction, by vapors forming at the negative electrode and gradually bridging the space between the electrodes, and thereby replacing the gas which fills the space, by the electrode vapor as conductor. This is usually expressed by saying: the electrostatic spark between two terminals starts, or tends to
there
is
if
the
start,
an
arc.
Disruptive conduction, thus, does not follow Ohm's law; it is zero below the disruptive voltage, while with a supply voltage
exceeding the disruptive voltage of the gas between the terminals, current exists, but the terminal voltage is apparently indepen-
dent of the current, that is, if the other conditions as temperature, gas pressure, etc., remain the same, the terminal voltage of the Geissler tube or the spark gap remains the same and independent of the current, and the current is determined by the impedance between the Geissler tube or spark gap and the source of
100
e.m.f.,
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
Geissler or by the available power of the supply source. constant on a be cannot potential operated directly tube, thus, a current limiting imsupply of unlimited power, but requires in series with it, or a source of limited power, that
pedance
is,
a source in which the voltage drops with increase of curtransformer or an electrostatic rent, as a constant current
machine,
etc.
on the gas pressure disruptive voltage essentially depends on the chemical also and the between electrodes, in the space is over a wide It the of the on and gas. temperature nature, the to gas pressure. Thus, at n range, directly proportional the voltage required to jump a spark atmospheres pressure as great as at one atmosphere. n times is terminals between two the from hold to This law seems highest pressures which have to down been investigated pressures of a few mm. mercury, that When coming to still lower is, down to about T tf atmosphere. the disruptive voltage decreases less, ultihowever,
The
usually somewhere between 1 mm. mately reaches a minimum and then increases again and and 0.1 mm. mercury pressure much higher than at atmosbecomes at extremely high vacua it is infinite in a perfect that seems pheric pressure, so that it conduction through a start can vacuum, that is, no voltage the the space is the conductor gas filling perfect vacuum. As that in a perunderstood is it in easily conduction,
disruptive
fectly
pressures,
empty
visible
space, or
exist.
duction would
phenomena of disruptive conduction very greatly the with change of gas pressure; from the electrostatic change Geissler tube glow in the spark at atmospheric pressures to the thus is the showing the identity gradual, change vacuum; but At of the two phenomena. atmospheric pressure, disruptive conduction occurs by a sharply defined, relatively thin and noisy the space between spark of very high brilliancy, which traverses in appearance unlike not in an erratic the electrodes zigzag path, of a solid fracture material; and, indeed, the to the mechanical If the electrostatic of the gas. spark is an electrostatic rupture
The
uniform, as between parallel plates, or between their distance, with spheres of a diameter 1.5 or more times the disruptive when occurs gradual rising voltage, the spark lower at voltage, by voltage is reached, without being preceded,
field is fairly
LUMINESCENCE.
any other phenomenon.
not uniform,
If,
101
field
is
spheres or wires, with increasing voltage the disruptive strength of the gas is exceeded at those places where the field intensity is highest, as at the needle points, before the disruptive voltage of the spark gap is reached, and then a partial break down occurs
at the points of maximum field intensity, as at the needle points, or at the surface of high potential conductors, etc. blue glow,
then, appears at the needle points, followed by violet streamers (in air, the color being the nitrogen spectrum; in other gases
other colors appear), and gradually increases in extent with increasing voltage, the so-called "brush discharge/ or "corona." Between needle points the brush discharges increase in extent,
7
and approach each other until they bridge nearly 60 per cent of the gap, and then the static spark occurs. At higher gas pressures the spark increases in brilliancy, in noisiness, but gets thinner. If, however, we gradually decrease the gas pressure, the spark gets thicker, less brilliant, and less
is, get more diffused, and ultimately it passes between the terminals as a moderately bright, thick and noiseless stream, gradually fading at its outside, and at still higher vacua it fills the entire space of the vacuum tube. At the same time the required voltage is decreased with
decreasing gas pressure, as discussed above. 46. I show you here (Fig. 31) the gradual change from the static spark to the Geissler tube glow in a closed glass tube G y I have two needle-shaped terminals, 5 cm. distant from each other,
:
You
By now exhausting the tube, while the voltage is maintained at the terminals, you can watch the gradual change from the static spark to the Geissler tube glow. In this experiment, a small condenser, a Leyden jar, is shunted across the highpotential terminals of the transformer, to guard against the disruptive conduction changing to continuous conduction, that is, to an arc, and a reactance inserted into the low-tension primary of the step-up transformer, to limit the discharge as shown diagrammatically in Fig. 31.
If the Geissler
current,
tube has a considerable diameter, 3 to 5 cm., the Geissler discharge with alternating current is striated; that
102
is,
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
less
alternate with disk-shaped bright spots with diffused outlines luminous spaces, about as shown in Fig. 32. The distance
between the luminous disks increases with decrease of the gas Two sets of such disks exist, one issuing from the
pressure.
They
are stationary
FIG. 31.
only if the gas pressure is perfectly constant, but separate and contract with the slightest change of pressure, hence are almost never at rest, but constantly moving through each other. The
two sets of disks, by passing through each other during their motion, give rise to a number of different appearances. Some of the successive shapes are shown in Fig. 32. The voltage distribution in the space between the terminals,
in disruptive
conduction,
also
LUMINESCENCE.
103
atmospheric pressure, practically all the voltage is consumed in the space between the terminals, and between needle points for dis-
and over very closely 4000 volts effective alternatcm. volts per inch) are required (corresponding to a (10,000 ing per breakdown gradient of 30,000 volts per cm. in a uniformfield) With
tances of 10 cm.
.
J_
FIG. 32.
decreasing gas pressure the voltage consumed in the space between the terminals decreases,but the voltage consumed at the
terminals increases, and in a good Geissler tube vacuum \\ith nitrogen gas filling the space between the terminals, from 10CO to
3000 volts
be consumed at the terminals, while the voltage consumed in the space between the terminals may drop as low as 2 volts per cm. or less. The voltage consumed at the terminals seems to decrease with The voltage consumed in the space beincrease of their size.
may
104
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
tween the terminals, that is, in the luminous stream of the Ge ler tube, seems to be practically independent, not only of
current, but also of the size of the tube, as should be expec with a disruptive discharge. It varies, however, with the t<
and is different with different gases, that is, differ gases have different disruptive strength. The light given by the Geissler tube shows the spectrum of gas, and thus is very bright and fairty efficient with a gas as ni gen, and especially neon, which gives a large number of specti lines in the visible range, and less efficient with a gas as car dioxide or hydrogen, in which the lines in the visible range repres
perature,
only a small part of the radiated energy. The industrial use of the electro-luminescence of disrupt conduction, that is, Geissler tube lighting, i? still limited (Mo tube) . So far only nitrogen gives a fairly good efficiency it reac apparently values between the tungsten lamp and the tax
;
a specific consumption of two watts per spherical candle power. The color of the nitrogen spectrun a reddish yellow. As the range of gas pressure in which voltage is near the minimum is very narrow, and the gas p
lum lamp,
or,
by absorption
at the electroc
by
to maintain constant gas press automatically feeding gas into the tube whenever the p
minimum
voltage or
maximum
efficie
The
is
greatest
light'
the high voltage required at the terminals. To fair efficiency the tube must be so long that the voltage c sumed in the stream which represents the power convei into light is much larger than the voltage consumed at terminals which represents wasted power. With a term' drop of 2000 volts, and two volts per cm. in the conducting stream, to use half of the supply voltage for light production, t requires a tube length of 2000/2 = 1000 cm. = 10 m. or 33 f and to use 80 per cent of the supply voltage for light product that is, waste only 20 per cent of the supplied power in heating terminals, requires a tube length of 8000/2 = 40 m. or 133 f Thus the Geissler tube as an illuminant is essentially a large i
however,
may be
produ
by a transformer
gives, however,
at the tube)
intrinsic
low
LUMIXESCEXCE.
the light.
light,
105
Neon
gives a
still
is
higher efficiency, though a red only very slowly absorbed, but is a very
much
rare gas.
Continuous Conduction.
47. In continuous conduction or arc conduction, the conductor a stream of electrode vapor, which bridges the gap between the
is
electrodes or terminals.
While in the spark, or the Geissler discharge, the conductor is the gas which fills the space between the terminals, in the electric arc the current makes its own conductor, by evaporation of the
electrode material, and maintains this conductor by maintaining a supply of conducting vapor. The color and the spectrum
of the arc, thus, are those of the electrode material, and not of the gas which fills the space in which the arc is produced, and
the nature of the gas in the space thus has no direct effect on the arc. Its pressure obviously has an effect, as the vapor pressure of the conducting arc stream is that of surrounding space, thus increases with increasing gas pressure, and the arc vapor then contracts, the arc gets thinner, while with decrease of the gas pressure in the space surrounding the arc the vapor pressure
stream also decreases, thus the vapor expands, and the arc stream becomes larger in section and correspondingly
of the arc
less
luminous.
As the arc conductor is a vapor stream of electrode material, this vapor stream must first be produced, that is, energy must
first
that
be expended before arc conduction can take place. An arc, is, continuous conduction, therefore, does not start spon-
taneously between the arc terminals if sufficient voltage is supplied at the terminals to maintain the arc, but the arc has first
to be started, that is, the conducting vapor bridge produced by the expenditure of energy. If, therefore, in the arc the current ceases even momentarily,
the conduction ceases by the disappearance of the vapor stream and does not start again spontaneously, but the arc has to be
by producing a vapor stream. With alternating voltage the arc, thus, would go out at the zero of current and have supply to be started again at every half wave. In general, the arc, thus, is a direct current phenomenon.
started
106
RADIATION, LIGHT,
of the
AND ILLUMINATION.
:
Some
means
(1.) By bringing the terminals into contact- with each other and thereby closing the circuit, that is, establishing the current,
and then slowly separating them. In the moment of separation the contact point is heated, vapor produced at it, and during the separation of the terminals, a vapor stream is left behind as conducting bridge. Obviously, if the terminals are separated
very rapidly, and the voltage is not much higher than required to maintain the arc, not enough vapor may be produced to conduct the current, and the arc does not start. (2.) By raising the voltage between the terminals so high that a static spark passes between them, that is, disruptive conduction
occurs.
is, if
The energy of this static spark, if sufficiently large, that the high voltage is maintained sufficiently long, then produces the vapor stream and starts the arc, that is, the arc follows the spark. If the duration of the high voltage is very short, the
energy of the spark may not be sufficient to start the arc. Thus high frequency discharges between live terminals frequently are not followed by an arc, and the lower the voltage between the terminals is, the more powerful a static spark is required to start
an
arc.
supplying the conducting vapor stream from another If the vapor stream of this is, by an auxiliary arc. arc from issues same terminal as the vapor stream the auxiliary of the main arc which is to be started, only the normal operating voltage is required in starting the latter arc, while a higher voltage is required, if the vapor is supplied by an entirely separate
'(3.)
By
arc, that
arc.
raising the space between the terminals to a very high temperature, as by bridging the terminals by a carbon filament,
(4.)
By
very high
The sharp
distinction
between the
arc, in
rent makes its own conductor by a vapor stream issuing from the terminals, and the Geissler discharge, in which the current
uses the gas which fills the space as conductor, is best illustrated by using in either case the same material, mercury, as conductor. I have here a vacuum tube, shown to scale in Fig, 33, about 2.5
cm. diameter, with three mercury terminals. The tube has four mercury terminals, of which, however, I use only three. The
L UMINESCEXCE.
107
gas which fills the space between the terminals is mercury vapor.* 1 now connect, as shown diagrammatically in Fig. 34, terminals
the
low potential circuit contains a reactance to limit the current and you see the striated Geissler discharge through mercury
FIG. 33.
vapor appear between terminals 2 and 3, giving the green light of the mercury spectrum. The terminals are quiet, as they do
not participate in the conduction. I now connect terminals 1 and 2 through a resistance, to a direct current supply, and tilt the tube momentarily to let some mercury run over from 2 to 1, and by thus momentarily connecting these terminals, establish the current and so start the arc, and you see the mercury arc the pass between terminals 1 and 2, and see at one terminal a rapidly moving bright spot, which marks the negative one point from which the vapor stream issues which carries the current. We have here in one and the same vacuum tube, and with the same material thus, the same color and spectrum of of the continuous high current and both conduction light, types low voltage conduction of the mercury arc, and the striated high voltage low current disruptive conduction of the Geissler discharge through mercury vapor.
arcs
108
RADIATIOX, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
from the negative terminal or cathode, and is in rapid motion from the negative towards the positive. The character of the
determined by the material of the negative the terminal, temperature of the arc stream in general probably is the temperature of the boiling point of the negative terminal,
arc, therefore, is
FIG. 34.
spectrum of the negative teroccurs only in those cases in exception herefrom, which boils below material terminal contains which the positive stream the of arc the temperature (flame carbons) and the posi-
minal.
An
is made so small that its tip is raised to the of the arc stream, and at this temperature heat temperature evaporation of the material of the positive occurs. These vapors
tive
terminal
become luminous, possibly by chemical luminescence, and add their spectrum to that of the arc In this case the arc conductor, that is, the negative -material. spectrum shows the negative as well as the positive material, or
enter the arc stream, and there
at least the
more
volatile
components
L UMIXESCEXCE.
positive terminal, the material of the positive terminal doe participate in the phenomena occurring in the arc. TIu
positive can be made of any conducting and refractory mai and if made sufficiently large not to get too hot, does not sume; only the negative terminal of the arc consumes in fe the arc flame, that is, supplying the vapor conductor, bu positive is inherently non-consuming, and may be made a p< nent part of the arc-lamp mechanism. On the contrary,
positive
is made so large that its temperature remains very below the arc temperature, condensation of the arc vapor c
it,
at
and
it
is,
increases in size.
Consum
of the positive terminal is thus due merely to the heat proc at it by combustion or heat evaporation.
While the arc conductor issues from the negative termin general more heat is produced at the positive terminal, with both terminals of the same size and material, as usi the carbon arc, the positive gets hotter, and therefore in air burns off faster, which has led to the erroneous assum
that the positive feeds the arc. While carbon was the material most commonly used as t nals, the carbon arc is not a typical arc, but is an exceptiona (1) Because carbon is one of the very few substances ^ change directly from the solid to the vapor state, that is, d melt at atmospheric pressure, but boil below the melting p (2) Carbon is the most refractory substance and the tern ture of the carbon arc higher than the boiling point of any substance. Any material existing in the terminals of a c* arc thus evaporates, and by entering the arc stream sho-v spectrum, so that luminescent material can be fed into the c* arc from either terminal. (3) At the temperature of the carbon arc all gases and v; have become good conductors, and a carbon arc thus can op equally well on alternating current as on direct current; th the voltage required to maintain the carbon arc is suffi< after the reversal of current, to restart it through the hot C
vapor. typical arc is shown in Fig. 35 as the magnetite with a lower negative terminal consisting of magn the non-consuming upper terminal C of copper, and of
110
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
hot as to oxidize or evaporate,
but sufficiently hot to avoid condensation of magnetite vapor on it. The arc flame consists of an inner cylindrical core A of bluish white color and high brilliancy, slightly tapering at both ends, which is surrounded by a less luminous shell B, of more yellowish and increasing color, narrowest at the negative end,
}
in diameter towards
latter.
the arc conductor, or conis the outer shell while ducting vapor stream, luminous containing vapor, possibly non-conducting of solid material floating in it as incan-
The inner
core
particles
A issues from a depression S in on the surface of the terminal P formed melted a pool M. This depression S is in a rapid and erratic motion, and thereby causes a constant and rapid It is this flickering, inherent to flickering of the arc.
aft arcs in
FIG. 35.
is
fusible (which
which has
retarded the industrial development of the more efficient metal Its cause is the reaction exerted by arcs until late years.
the velocity of the vapor blast from the negative, which presses the surface of the liquid pool down at the point from which the current issues. The starting point of the current conin shortening tinuously climbs up the side of this depression,
the arc, but, in doing so, depresses its new starting point, that is, the depression S, and thereby the negative end of the arc stream moves over the surface the faster the more fluid the surface is. In the mercury arc, this phenomenon of the
running spot at the negative terminal thus is very marked, but not so objectionable, as the arc stream is so long that the flicker This at the negative terminal has no effect on the total light. if we destroy the arc in the magnetite flickering disappears
melted magnetite by mixing with it some much more refractory material, as chromite. The chromite remains The reaction solid and holds the melted magnetite like a sponge.
fluidity of the
of the
vapor blast, then, cannot depress its starting point, and no arc becomes tendency exists of shifting the starting point, and the
LUMINESCENCE.
steady.
49.
Ill
In
this
manner such
arcs
Since the arc conductor issues as a rapidly moving vapor stream from the negative terminal or cathode, it must be con-
tinuous at the cathode; if interrupted even for a very short time at the cathode, a break exists in the continuity of the conductor
and conduction
ceases, that
is,
At any
other point of the arc stream, however, a break in the continuity of the stream may exist, provided that current continues from the negative, since such a break in the continuity of the con-
ducting vapor stream is bridged again, and conduction re-estabThus the lished by the vapor stream coming from the negative.
FIG. 36.
by merely starting a conducting vapor stream from the negative, as by an auxiliary arc. As soon as this eonducting vapor reaches the positive terminal, it closes the circuit and establishes conduction. An arc can be shifted or jumped from one positive terminal to another one, but cannot be shifted from negative to negative; the negative terminal, as the source
of the conducting vapor stream,
must be continuous.
To illustrate this, I have here (Fig. 36) in a hand lamp two of about 5 mm. diameter, as arc terminals, and copper rods connected into a 220-volt direct-curseparated by 2.5 cm., and in series to limit the current resistances rent circuit, with sufficient third copper rod of the same size, C, to about 4 amperes. a flexible lead to the upper terminal B. I close is connected
by
so as to
make
negative,
and
and
112
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
to A. and C by touching positive, and start an arc between I draw this arc to about -t cm. length, and without touching C with B, as soon as the conducting vapor stream of the arc
AC
(the inner core A of Fig. 35) touches B, as shown in Fig. 36, the arc leaves C and goes to 5, that is, by the arc AC I have started are AB. If I had separate resistances in series with the terminals
B and C, the arc AC would also continue to exist after it started are AB otherwise, as two arcs cannot run in parallel, the longer arc, ACj goes out as soon as the shorter arc AB starts. I now reverse the circuit by throwing switch S, and make A positive, and B and C negative, again start AC by contact, and
;
draw
it
itself all
around terminal
FIG. 37.
B, but the arc does not transfer. I even insert 10 ohms resistance r t in series with C (Fig. 37), so that the voltage AB is about 40 volts higher than AC, that is, B by 40 volts more negative than C, and still the arc does not transfer. I now touch C with B and separate it again; if during contact the negative spot during its motion happens to run over to terminal 5, the arc continues between
and A;
remained on
(7,
when
however, the negative spot has separating again, the arc remains at C as
if,
is more negative by 40 volts. negative, although An arc therefore can be started at its normal starting voltage by an auxiliary arc having the same negative, but not by an auxiliary arc with the same positive, and an arc can be shifted
L UMIXESCEXCE.
another.
113
is, as explained above, the necessity of the the at continuity negative terminal as the source of the conduct-
The cause
more
resistance r t
as negative,
startling is the following demonstration: I shift the from to 5, and start the arc from to B, with
by bringing these terminals into contact with each and then other, separating them. The auxiliary terminal C now is (Fig. 38) by 40 volts more negative than the negative terminal of the arc. I now cut slowly through the arc stream
by moving
the arc
AB
between A and B, as shown in Fig. 38: no current goes to (7, although more but remains,
across
it
FIG. 38.
negative, that is, at a higher potential difference and a shorter I even hold C for some time in is. than distance against the conducting core of the arc AB, and still the current does not
from the negative B to the still more negative terminal C. This experiment is interesting in demonstrating that a conductor immersed into the arc flame does not assume the potential of the arc flame, but may differ therefrom "by considerable voltage, and
shift
that
it
therefore
is
tribution in
an arc by means
frequently been attempted. Obviously, if I now reverse the circuit, and make positive, negative, the current leaves B and goes to
and
C as
soon
as
touches the conducting core of the arc AB. 50. The electric arc, therefore, is a unidirectional conductor, that is, the vapor stream is conducting between its negative
114
terminal
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
the starting point of the arc
is,
stream, and any point reached by it which is positive to A, but is non-conducting for any point which is negative with respect to A. If, now, in Fig. 38, with the terminal C immersed in the arc stream, I connect A and C to a source of alternating voltage, as shown in Fig. 39, while a direct-current arc flows from A to B,
with.
as negative, then during that half-wave of the alternating voltage, for which C is positive to A, there is current between
and C, while for the reverse half-wave, in which C is negative to A, there is no current. The arc thus rectifies the alternating voltage, and the rectification is complete, that is, there is
FIG. 39.
all
dur-
ing the other. I show you this experimentally, using 110 volts alternating between A and C. With this arrangement, to maintain the rectification continuously, obviously the ter-
minal
C would
have to be cooled.
:
Alternating voltage thus can be rectified by means of the unidirectional character of the arc if a continuous vapor stream
is
by overlapping several waves of alternating curis in that direction only in which this exciter current rent, terminal is negative, but not in the opposite direction. of which the mercury arc rectifier is the Such arc rectifiers
citation or
most commonly used have been developed and extensively introduced in the industry, of late years, for operating low-volt-
LUMINESCENCE.
115
age constant direct potential and high-voltage constant directcurrent circuits from a source of alternating voltage. Regarding
the electrical
u
phenomena occurring in arc rectification, see and of Transient Electric Phenomena and Calculation Theory
Oscillations/' Section II, Chapter IV. The inability of an alternating voltage to maintain
I
an arc, show you here on the same apparatus by connecting the two terminals (Fig. 40) A and B to the 1000-volt terminals of a
transformer
current.
While 220 volts direct current easily maintained a steady 2-cm. arc between these terminals, with 1000 volts alternating between the terminals, if I try to produce an alternating arc
by gradually separating the terminals, the circuit opens before the terminals have separated 1 mm.; that is, 1000 volts alternating cannot maintain an arc of 1 mm. between these copper
Ffi
r=io OHMS
c-AAA
110
f
VJOLTS eo CIRCLES
10W
FIG. 40.
obvious to maintain an alternating arc is required sufficiently high to restart the arc at every half-wave by jumping an electrostatic spark between the terminals through the hot residual vapor of the preceding half-wave. The voltage required by an electrostatic spark, that is, by disruptive conduction, decreases with
terminals.
The
cause
is
increase of temperature: for a 13-mm. (0.5-in.) gap, it is about 10,000 volts at atmospheric temperature, 7000 volts at the
boiling point of mercury (360 deg. cent.), 2500 volts at the boiling point of zinc (1000 deg. cent.), 500 volts at the boiling point of magnetite (2000 deg. cent.), 100 volts at the boiling point of titanium carbide (3000 deg. cent.), 40 volts at the
boiling point of carbon (3700 deg. cent.). quired to maintain a 13-mm. alternating arc
The voltage
re-
must therefore be
116
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
at least as high as given by a curve somewhat like curve I in * the scale of the (to bring the values of voltage within Fig. 41 is as of the ordinate, plotted against voltage, logarithm figure,
the temperature as abscissa). The voltage required to maintain an arc, that is, the directcurrent arc voltage, increases with increasing arc temperature, and thereby increasing radiation, etc. For a 13-mm. (0.5-in.)
5(0
10PO
15
K)
2000
2500
3000
FIG. 41.
approximately shown as Curve II in Fig. 41 20 volts for the mercury arc, 40 volts for the zinc arc, 60 volts for the
arc
it is
:
* As the disruptive voltage also depends on the chemical nature of the vapor, that is, some gases and vapors have a higher disruptive strength than others, as discussed above, the arrangement of the different materials regardpoints, but modified
ing their alternating arc voltages is not entirely determined by their boiling by individual characteristics. It further depends on the
current: at higher currents and thus larger amounts of residual vapor, the voltage is lower. It further depends on the frequency: the lower the fre-
LUMINESCENCE.
117
magnetite arc, 75 volts for the titanium carbide arc, 80 volts carbon arc.* As seen from Fig. 41, the curves I and II intersect at some very high temperature, near the boiling point of carbon, and materials which have a boiling point above the temperature of intersection of these curves require a lower voltage for restarting the arc than for maintaining it, and a voltage sufficient to maintain the arc restarts it at every half-wave of alternating current, that is, such materials can maintain a steady alternating arc at the same voltage as a direct-current arc. Even materials like titanium carbide, in which the starting voltage is
for the
not much above the running voltage, maintain a steady alternating arc, as in starting, the voltage consumed during running in the steadying resistance or reactance is available. Alternating arcs thus can be maintained at moderate volt-
by a few materials of extremely high boiling points, as carbon and carbides, but by far the largest number of materials cannot be used as terminals of an alternating-current arc. In Fig. 41 the range between the curves I and II is the " rectifying range/' as in this range unidirectional current is produced from an alternating source of voltage through the arc, if the arc conductor is maintained by excitation of its negative
ages only
The voltage range of rectification thus is highest in the mercury arc, which has the lowest temperature, and vanishes in very high-temperature arcs. The carbon arc thus cannot
terminal. give complete rectification, while the mercury arc, or zinc arc,
The mercury arc, having the greatest rectietc., can do so. fication range, thus is practically always used for this purpose. Below curve II of Fig. 41 no conduction occurs, between
I and II, unidirectional conduction takes place, and above curve I disruptive conduction by alternating current can exist. 51. The light, and in general the radiation given by the arc proper, that is, by the vapor conductor which carries the current between the terminals, is due to luminescence, that is, to
curves
a more or
less
* This voltage also is not merely a function of the arc temperature, but modified somewhat by the chemical individtiality of the material. It is a function of the current and decreases with increase of current, so that above
values are approximate only, corresponding to about 4 amperes.
118
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
radiation, without heat as intermediary form of energy. The quality or color of the light, or its spectrum, that is, the fre-
quency or frequencies of radiation given by the arc stream, thus are not a function of the temperature, as in the radiation produced by heat energy, but the frequencies are those at which the luminescent body is capable of vibrating, that is, are determined by the chemical nature of the luminescent body
or vapor conductor. The efficiency of light production thus does not directly depend upon the temperature, does not increase with increase of temperature, as in temperature radiaWe have the same tion, but to some extent rather the reverse. relation as in other energy transformations: when converting
heat into other forms of energy, the more intense the heat, that is, the higher the temperature, the higher efficiency we
transforming, however, some form of from heat, into another form of energy, as energy differing electrical into mechanical energy, the heat produced repreof and waste the lower the temperature, the sents a energy, in other things being equal, would be the effigeneral, higher
may
expect.
When
The efficiency of light production by the arc thus is of the temperature, but the lowest temperature a function not arc, the mercury arc, is one of the most efficient. The light given by the arc contains only a finite number of definite wave lengths, that is, gives a line spectrum: very few lines in the ordinary mercury arc, many thousands in the titanium arc. The color of the light is essentially characteristic of the nature of the luminescent body. For instance, it is white in the titanium arc, as the lines of the titanium spectrum are The fairly uniformly distributed over the entire visible range. light of the calcium arc is orange yellow, as the spectrum lines of calcium are more frequent and more intense in the orangeciency.
yellow range of radiation, etc. Frequently a change of the color of the luminescent light of the arc occurs with the temperature, but it does not follow
a definite law, as in temperature radiation, but is a characteristic peculiarity of the luminescent body: some of the spectrum lines increase more rapidly in intensity, with increasing temperature, than others, and the resultant color of the For instance, the ordinary iron arc, as light changes thereby. produced by 4 amperes direct current across a gap of 2 cm.
LUMINESCENCE.
119
between iron or magnetite terminals, and requiring about 75 volts, is white and very brilliant, that is, has a spectrum with many lines about uniformly distributed over the visible range. "We can greatly increase the temperature of the arc by using a
high-frequency condenser discharge: in this case very large currents of very short duration exist as oscillations between the terminals, with periods of rest between the oscillations, verylong compared with the duration of the current. In this case the duration of the current is too short to feed a large volume of electrode vapor into the arc stream, and as the current is
of the discharge, the very greatly overheated. Oscilcondenser thus offer a means of increasing the discharges lating
is
moment
temperature of the arc stream very greatly beyond the boiling point of the material. When using a condenser discharge between iron terminals, we thus get an iron arc of very much
higher temperature, and this arc gives very
little visible light,
but a very large amount of ultra-violet radiation. It is this arrangement which we have used in the preceding to produce
ultra-violet light
by the so-called "ultra-violet iron arc." In wave length of the radiation thus shifts with increasing temperature to shorter wave lengths, or higher
the iron arc the average
frequencies, similar as in temperature radiation. The reverse is the case with the mercury arc:
the ordinary
mercury arc in an evacuated glass tube, with ample condensing chamber, gives practically no red light; only a very powerful spectroscope can discover some very faint red lines. If now
by obstructing
the condensation of the mercury vapor is made insufficient, ventilation, or greatly raising the current, or
omitting the condensing chamber in the construction of the lamp, and the mercury vapor pressure and thereby the temperature increased, at least three red lines located about as shown in Fig. 42 become visible in the mercury spectrum even
in a low-power luvY-puwcjL opcuuiUDUUpc, spectroscope, and increase in intensity with
jLJLi
11
IT
m To
vs
III
II
YELLOW
I use a U-shaped
^I0
S ^^T
s-
42>
I donsize in Fig. 43. into a 220-volt direct-current circuit, with an inductive resistance in series thereto, to limit the current, and
lamp
120
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
by pouring some mercury over from one side to the other. Immediately after starting the lamp you see no red As with lines in the low-power spectroscope which I have here.
the mercury vapor 3 amperes the large current which I use the mercury vapor pressure rises and cannot freely condense,
FIG. 43.
in the center tubes, up in presses the mercury level down the outside tubes, as indicated at b in Fig. 43, and thereby Gradually you enables us to measure the mercury pressure. see the three red lines appear, and increase in intensity, and
the three pressure has risen to about 5 cm., and red other numerous orange red lines are fairly bright, and At this pressure we are so close lines have appeared.
to the softening point of the glass that we cannot go further, the mercury arc in a quartz tube, vapor presbut
by operating
sures of several atmospheres can be produced, and then the red lines are very much more intense, many more lines have be-
mercury spectrum, and the light is far less more nearly greenish than the low-temperature mercury arc,
come
visible in the
white.
higher temperatures can be reached in the mercury arc in an ordinary glass tube by using the condenser
Still
much
discharge.
I.
have
here,
in
Fig.
44,
L LUMINESCENCE.
terminals
121
simultaneously the mercury arc and the Geissler discharge. I connect terminals 3 and 4 to the high potential terminals of a step-up transformer, but shunt a small condenser C across 3 and 4; you see, in the moment where I connect the condenser, the
previously existing green and striated Geissler discharge changes
FIG. 44.
to a bright pinkish-red arc, and the spectroscope shows that the spectrum lines in the red and orange have greatly increased in
number, and have increased in intensity beyond that of the lines in the green and blue, and the color of the light therefore has changed from green to pinkish red* We have here in the same mercury tube shown diagrammatically in Fig. 44 all three forms of luminescence of mercury
vapor:
low-temperature arc of
122
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
uniform green
color, from 1 to 2; the green high-voltage lowcurrent striated Geissler discharge, from 2 to 3, and the red highvoltage mercury arc, from 3 to 4.
In the mercury
arc, as result of
intensity of the red lines, the color of the light thus changes with increase of temperature from bluish green at low tempera-
ture to white to red at very high temperature, that is, the average frequency decreases with increase of temperature, just the
reverse from
what
is
The change
in the distribution of
if the ture, may increase the efficiency of light production lines in the visible range increase faster than in the ultra-red
and
ultra-violet
or or
crease slower
if the visible lines inmay decrease in some increase may temperature range,
decrease in
some other temperature range, but all these changes are characteristic of the luminescent material, and do not obey a general law. Thus in the mercury arc the efficiency of light
production, with increase of temperature, rises to a maximum at about 150 deg. cent., then decreases to a minimum, and at still
higher temperature increases to a second maximum, higher than the first one, possibly between 600 and 800 deg. cent., and then decreases again.
52.
by
Essentially, however, the efficiency of light production the arc is a characteristic of the material of the arc stream,
and thus substances which give a large part of their radiation as calcium as spectrum lines in the visible range give a while which those substances radiate most of very efficient arc,
their energy as lines in the invisible, ultra-violet or ultra-red as carbon give a very inefficient arc. The problem of efficient
by the arc therefore consists in selecting such materials which give most of their radiation in the visible range. Carbon, which was most generally used for arc terminals, is one of the most inefficient materials: the carbon arc gives very little light, and that of a disagreeable violet color; it is practilight production
and the light given by the carbon arc lamp incandescent essentially light, temperature radiation of the incandescent tip of the positive carbon. The fairly high efficiency of the carbon arc lamp is due to the very high temperacally non-luminous,
is
LUMINESCENCE.
123
The materials which give the highest efficiencies of light production by their spectrum in the arc stream are mercury, calcium and titanium.
As mercury vapor
be enclosed
enclosed
air-tight,
is
very poisonous, the mercury arc has to and has been developed as a vacuum arc,
by a glass or quartz tube. Its color is bluish green. Calcium gives an orange-yellow light of very high efficiency, and is used in most of the so-called "flame-carbon arcs/' or "flame arcs." Titanium gives a white light of extremely high efficiency. It is used in the so-called "luminous arc," as the magnetite arc
current circuits.
53.
Two methods
By
electro-condiLction,
that
is,
vapor conductor which carries the current. In this case, it must be used as negative, as the vapor conductor is supplied from the negative; such arcs are called "luminous arcs-"
(2)
By
is the hottest, the material is mixed with the carof the positive terminal, and as negative terminal either a plain carbon, or also an impregnated carbon used; such arcs
heat evaporation; in this case, a very hot arc must be arc is employed. As the posi-
bon
The method
of heat evaporation
is
since no stable conducting calcium compound is known which may be used as negative arc terminal. With titanium, usually
electro-conduction
netite mixture,
is
employed, that
is,
a titanium oxide-mag-
and any
minal.
or titanium metal, used as negative terminal, other terminal, as copper or carbon, as positive ter-
Titanium can also be introduced by heat evaporation by using a titanium-carbon mixture as positive terminal or as both terminals of the flame-carbon are. Both methods of feeding electro-conduction and heat evaporation ha'vse advantages and disadvantages. Electro-conduction has the great advantage that the temperature of the terminals is immaterial, as heat plays no part in
feeding the luminescent material into the arc flame.
tive terminal of the arc
The
can be made
sufficiently large
and
posiof
124
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
such material as not to consume at all, and the trimming of the the lamp thus reduced to the replacing of one electrode only as made so be can also electrode The large negative negativethe at consumes therefore and veryonly remain to fairly cold, slow rate required to supply the arc vapor, but does not con-
sume by combustion
or heat evaporation.
Thus
its
rate of con-
hour (while the sumption can be reduced to 1 mm. or less per of electrodes per cm. 5 about consumes old of arc open carbon of electrode a life size moderate a with even and thereby hour), This of electrodes of 100 to 300 hr. or even much more secured.
'
itself very well to long-burning arcs, almost as they are exclusively used for American street lighting. By electro-conduction higher efficiencies can be reached than by heat evaporation, as the arc vapor stream when produced by electro-conduction can be made to consist entirely of the vapor
when using
metallic titanium as
negative terminal. A disadvantage of the method of feeding the arc by electroconduction is the much greater limitation in the choice of materials the material must be an electric conductor, which is In the method stable in the air, and reasonably incombustible.
:
of feeding
it is
by heat evaporation any material can be used, as mixed with carbon, and the conductivity is given by the
Thus, in the titanium arc, either metallic titanium or titanium carbide or sub oxide must be used, but the most common titanium compound, Ti02 or rutile, is not directly suitable, In the direct-current titanium arc, since it is a non-conductor.
carbon.
,
the so-called magnetite arc, a solution of Ti0 2 or rutile, in maga mixture of netite, Fe3 4 , which is conducting, is used, that is, of rutile with a considerable weight magnetite. While magwhite iron spectrum, the netite also gives a luminous arc, that of the titanium than lower the efficiency of the iron arc is
,
arc,
and the
efficiency of the
by electro-conduction: the calcium only more common conducting calcium compound is arc of an As negative terminal calcium carbide gives carbide.
all
magnetite arc thus lower than that though much higher than that of the
an
efficiency far superior to that of the flame-carbon arc, but, as calcium carbide disintegrates in the air, it cannot be used.
LUMINESCENCE.
Still
125
greater is the limitation for alternating current; in this the case material, in addition to its other qualifications, must a high boiling point as to maintain a steady alternatsuch have
ing arc, as discussed above. Of the titanium compounds only titanium carbide seems to fulfill this requirement; of the iron compounds, apparently none.
54.
The most
conduction for feeding the arc, however, has been the inherently carbon greater unsteadiness of metal arcs compared with the
arc.
It is this feature
of true luminous arcs until recent years, that is, until means were found to produce steadiness by eliminating the flickering of the negative spot by the admixture of a more refractory
and eliminating chromite in the magnetite arc, occasional to the due momentary fading out the unsteadiness admixture of a very arc the of the core of the luminous inner by
material,
small
amount of some more volatile material. The great advantage of the method of feeding the luminescent material into the arc flame by heat evaporation, mainly from the
gives
of using carbon as arc conductor, positive, is the possibility the inherent steadiness of the carbon arc, and thus which
has led to the development of this type of high efficiency arc, the flame arc, before the development of true luminous arcs. further advantage is the possibility of using alternating current equally well and with the same electrodes as used with direct current, as the arc is a carbon arc and thus operative on
alternating current.
Another advantage is the great choice of materials available, since practically any stable compound, whether conducting or
not, can be used in the flame carbon.
Thus
in the yellow-flame
oxide and borates are used; in the titaarc, calcium fluoride, nium arc, the oxide (rutile) or the carbide may be used. The most serious disadvantage of the method of feeding by which has so far excluded the flame arc from heat
evaporation, street illumination, general use for American
is
Since the luminescent material is be so small that their ends are raised oration, the electrodes must the combusto arc temperature, and thus rapidly consume by
tion of the carbon,
their consequent short life. fed into the arc by heat evap-
126
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
with an almost air-tight excluding the air by enclosing the arc since the luminescent carbon enclosed in the arc, as globe, the material leaves the arc as smoke, and by depositing on The rate of consumption of globe rapidly obstructs the light. the electrodes thus is the same as in the open carbon arc, 3 to 5 cm. (1 to 2 in.) per hour, and the flame-carbon arc even with lasts only one night, that is, very great length of carbon thus To some extent this difficulty may requires daily trimming. be reduced by using the same air again, after passing it through a smoke-depositing chamber in a so-called "circulating" or the efficiency is lowered, and the "regenerative" flame lamp, but
lamp made more complicated. The mercury arc, being enclosed in a glass tube, necessarily must always be fed by electro-conduction from the negative. The calcium arc is always fed by heat evaporation from the carbon positive, with a carbon negative, or from positive and The for both electrodes. negative, by using flame carbons titanium arc is usually fed by electro-conduction from the negfrom the positive by using ative, but also by heat evapqration
a titanium-flame carbon.
electro-luminescence, electric energy is converted more directly into radiation, without heat as intermediary form of energy, no theoretical limit can be seen to the possible effiin the mercury, calciency of light production by the arc, and reached far beyond have been efficiencies cium and titanium arcs,
55.
As,
by
those possible with temperature radiation. Thus, specific consumptions of 0.25 watt per mean spherical candle power are quite common with powerful titanium, calcium or mercury arcs, and
even
much
duction appears vantage, of light production by the arc is the necessity of an operating mechanism, an arc lamp, which requires some attention, and thereby makes the arc a less convenient illummant than, for instance, the incandescent lamp, and especially the
limitation in the unit of light: the efficiency of the arc decreases with decrease of power consumption, and, while the arc is very
efficient in units of
It is therefore in better values have been observed. advance in the efficiency of light promost probable. At present, the main disad-
efficiency
hundreds or thousands of candle power, its lower in smaller units, and very small units cannot be produced at all. Thus, for instance, while a 500watt flame arc may give 10 times as much light as a 500-watt
is
much
LUMINESCENCE.
127
carbon arc, to produce by a flame arc the same amount of light as given by a 500-watt carbon arc requires very much more than one-tenth the power. So far no way can be seen of maintaining the efficiency of the arc down to such small units of light as represented by the 16- or 20-candle power incandescent lamp.
LECTURE
VII,
FLAMES AS ILLUMINAKTS.
56.
Two main
classes of
radiation by the conversion of the chemical energy of comand those deriving the energy of radiathe flames bustion the incandescent lamp and the arc tion from electric energy
less
Flames.
To produce
light
of combustion,
almost exclusively hydrocarbon flames are used, as the gas flame, the candle, the oil lamp, the gasolene and kerosene lamp, etc.; of hydrogen and carbon or of hydrogen, that
is,
compounds
carbon and some oxygen are burned. The hydrogen, H, comand the 20, bines with the oxygen, 0, of the air to water vapor, C0 2 carbon to of the dioxide, air, carbon, C, with the oxygen a carbon to CO, monoxide, or, if the air supply is insufficient,
carbons very rich in hydrogen: methane, CH4 and in free carbon. The carbon particles formed by this dissociation of hydrocarbon gas float in the burning gases, that is, in the flame, and are raised to a high temperature by the heat of combustion of the
,
very poisonous, combustible, odorless gas (coal gas), thus appears in all incomplete combustions and is present, also, as intermediary stage, in complete combustion. The mechanism of the light production by the hydrocarbon flame I illustrate here on the luminous gas flame where the gas at the surface of the issues, from the burner into the air, it burns the of combustion heat gas is raised to a high gas jet. By the Most hydrocarbons, however, cannot stand high temperature. into simpler hydrobut split up, dissociate temperatures,
:
which
incandescent, and radiate light by temuntil ultimately, at the outer edge of the perature radiation; are burned by the oxygen of the air, and thus flame,
gases, thereby
made
they
destroyed.
We
FLAMES AS ILLUMINANTS.
in the flame in
129
if
an incandescent
by passing
a cold porcelain or glass plate through the luminous flame, we suddenly chill it and thereby preserve the carbon particles from combustion; they appear then on the plate as a carbon The light given by the luminous deposit, soot or lampblack. flame thus is to black-body radiation, and the due hydrocarbon flame makes its own radiator, and afterwards destroys it by
combustion. To give a luminous flame, the hydrocarbon must be sufficiently rich in carbon to split off carbon at high temperatures. Thus methane, CH4 does not give a luminous flame, since it contains the smallest amount of carbon which can combine with hydrogen, and therefore does not deposit carbon at high temperatures. Ethylene, however, C2 4 which is the foremost light giving constituent of illuminating gas, dissociates in the flame into CH4 and C, and thus gives a luminous flame, as half of its carbon is set free and gives the incandescent radiator. If, however, the hydrocarbon is very rich in carbon, the amount of deposited carbon becomes so large that the energy of combustion of the remaining hydrocarbon is not sufficient to raise the carbon to very high temperatures, the luminosity therefore again decreases, the flame becomes reddish yellow, and a large amount of carbon escapes from the flame unconsumed, as smoke or soot, that is, the flame becomes smoky. To show you this, I pour some gasolene and some benzol in small glass dishes. The gasolene, having 2J hydrogen atoms per carbon atom, burns with a luminous flame and very little smoke. The benzol, having only one hydrogen atom per carbon atom, burns with a reddish-yellow flame, pouring out masses of black smoke. The proportion between the hydrogen and carbon required to give a luminous non-smoky flame, therefore can be varied only within narrow limits: too little carbon gives a less luminous or non-luminous flame, too much carbon a smoky reddish
,
flame.
Hydrocarbons exist having almost any proportion between hydrogen and carbon, from a maximum of four hydrogen atoms to one carbon in methane, CH4 to practically pure carbon in
,
anthracite coal.
table,
with the
Some of them are shown in the following number of hydrogen atoms per carbon atom
130
RADIATION, LIGHT,
a,
AND ILLUMINATION.
and the percentage of carbon which is deposited by dissociation, in column &;* & thus may be called the
added in column
luminosity index of the hydrocarbon.
HYDROCARBONS.
57.
give
The proportion between carbon and hydrogen required to a luminous non-smoky flame somewhat depends on the
with a larger size, a higher proportion of hydrogen is required to avoid smoke than with a smaller flame, as in the latter, due to the larger surface compared with the volume, the combustion is more rapid. I show you this on the gas flame: admitting a little gas, I get a small flame, which does
if
and
smoky flame. With a moderate-sized flame without artificial ventilation, from 30 to 40 per cent of the carbon must be deposited to give
good luminosity without smoke.
*
Every four hydrogen atoms retain one carbon atom, while the
is
carbon
set free.
FLAMES AS ILLU1IINANTS.
131
the gasolene flame, a = 2.33, is slightly in very small flames in which the surface
side,
between 2.4 and somewhat less than three hydrogen atoms per carbon atom. Ethane, C2 6 with a = 3, stUl gives a luminous flame, but of somewhat lower luminosity, and, on the other
smoky.
is
larger
However, compared
with the volume, and the combustion thus very rapid, higher percentages of carbon can be used without smoke. Thus the flame of the paraffine candle a = 2.08 is still smokeless but
begins to smoke if it gets large, and in extremely small flames, in. or less diameter, even acetylene, a = 1, gives smokeless
combustion.
Increase of the rapidity of combustion by increasing the surby using a flat or hollow cylindrical burner, and increasing the air supply by artificial draft, as by a chimney, gives smokeless flames even up to b = 0.50, or one carbon atom to two hydrocarbon atoms, a = 2.
face of the flame
Thus kerosene, which, due to its high carbon content a = 2.14, smokes badly, except in very small flames, is burned smokelessly in lamps with chimneys and flat or hollow round burners, and then gives a high light intensity: with the rapid air supply and the large surface of the thin flame, the combustion is very rapid, a part of the free carbon is immediately consumed, the temperature is high, and thus the free carbon heated sufficiently to give considerable light, and to consume completely when leaving the flame. With a hydrocarbon still richer in carbon, as acetylene or benzol a = 1, artificial draft and large flame surface are no longer sufficient to give smokelessness, and the total range of hydrocarbons which can be burned with luminous flames and without smoke thus is between from three to two hydrogen atoms per carbon atom. Hydrocarbons which are too rich in carbon to be burned smokelessly, as acetylene or benzol, obviously can be burned with a smokeless luminous flame by mixing them in the proper proportions with hydrocarbons deficient in carbon, which latter by themselves would give a non-luminous or nearly non-lumiaous flame. Thus a mixture of one volume of acetylene, C2 2 with three volumes of methane, 3 CH4 (the number of molecules of gases are proportional to their volumes), gives a non2,8. smoky luminous flame: 5 C to 14 H, or a Such hydrocarbons as acetylene, benzol, etc., which are rich
132
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
in carbon, are used for enriching poor gas, that is, making it which gives little free carbon, as water-gas more luminous:
both giving non-luminous flames), would therefore and which give a non-luminous or only slightly is thus improved in its light-giving quality luminous flame, of acetylene, etc. by admixture contains oxygen, as alcohol, C2 6 0, 58. If the
(which
is
rich in
H and CO
gas
hydrocarbon of oxygen atoms reduces the luminosity or etc., the presence to smoke, by taking care of a corresponding numthe tendency the most stable compound is CO, and atoms: ber of carbon as carbon dioxide, C02 are reduced as well water vapor, 2 0, with the formation of carbon by carbon at high temperature of the hydrocarbon in dissociation the monoxide, CO. During carbon atom, formone takes atom up the flame, each oxygen In approxiflame. non-luminous a with ing CO, which burns to smoke of a the or the tendency luminosity mately estimating one caratom each for oxygen hydrocarbon containing oxygen, I this illustrate To subtracted. pour some bon atom is to be in small C glass aldehyde, C2 4 0, and some amyl acetate, 7 14 2 , to cardishes and ignite them. In both the ratio of hydrogen bon atom is a = 2, corresponding to a luminous but smoky flame. You see, however, that the aldehyde burns with a perflame: we have to put out the light to see fectly non-luminous acetate burns with a luminous, non-smoky it; while the amyl flame. Applying above reasoning, the oxygen accounts for one - CO + CH4 and in CH4 carbon atom in the aldehyde: C2 4 non-luminous = a flame, as observed. In a 4, corresponding to take atoms up two carbon atoms: amyl acetate, the two oxygen of ratio = and the 2 CO + C5 14 hydrogen to carbon C7 14 2 atoms is a 30, corresponding to a luminous non2.8, or b
smoky flame, as observed. The same effect as given by oxygen contained in the hydrocarbon molecule obviously is obtained by mixing oxygen or
air
flame: closing the air supply, I have an ordinary luminous somewhat smoky gas flame. I now gradually admit air, and
see first the
and
and
first
you smoke disappear, and then the luminosity decreases, the lower part, and then the entire flame, becomes
non-luminous.
amount
the luminosity has just disappeared, the of air mixed with the gas is just sufficient to take up
When
FLAMES AS ILLUMINANTS.
all
133
the carbon as CO, which would deposit otherwise and give the incandescent radiator, but it is far below the amount required for complete combustion, and, by still further increasing the air supply, you see the rapidity of combustion still further increase, as shown by the decreasing size of the flame. With increasing
air supply, the size of the flame the same total heat is produced
is
very greatly decreases, and, as by the combustion, this means concentrated in a smaller volume, that is, the
is increased, in other words, the nonluminous bunsen flame is of higher temperature than the luminous gas flame. Hydrocarbons which are too rich in carbon to burn without smoke, as acetylene, can be burned with a smokeless flame by mixing them with oxygen or with air. Acetylene is always burned in this manner, and all acetylene-gas burners are constructed so as to take in air with the acetylene gas before combustion, that is, are small bunsen burners or similar thereto. Since the temperature of the bunsen flame, due to the more rapid combustion resulting from the mixture with air, is higher than that of the ordinary gas flame, and in the acetylene flame in the acetylene air mixture a large part of the carbon is also
immediately burned, the temperature of the acetylene flame is very high, and the deposited carbon therefore raised to a very high temperature, much higher 'than in the ordinary gas flame, and, as the result of the higher temperature, the black-body radiation of the free carbon in the acetylene flame is far more efficient, and of much whiter color than in the ordinary gas flame. Thus the hydrocarbons which are very rich in carbon, as acetylene, benzol, naphthalene, etc., if burned smokelessly by mixture with air, give whiter and more efficient flames, due to their higher temperature. Especially is this the case with acetylene, as the energy of combustion of acetylene is higher than that of other hydrocarbons of the same relative proportions of hydrogen and carbon: acetylene being endothermic, that is, requiring energy for its formation from the elements. 59. Since, as discussed in Lecture VI, chemical luminescence usually occurs where intense chemical reactions take place at high chemical and this is the case in the flame, temperatures, luminescence of the flame gases must be expected in the hydrocarbon flame. It does occur, but does not contribute anything
134
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
to the light production, since the spectra of hydrogen and ui are practically non-luminous. The carbon (or CO and 4) luminescence of the hydrocarbon flame therefore can be observed
CH
only with those hydrocarbons which are sufficiently poor in carbon as not to deposit free carbon, as methane, alcohol, etc., or in which, by the admixture of air, the deposition of free carbon and thereby the formation of an incandescent radiator, is avoided, as in the bunsen flame. In this case, the blue color of
the chemical luminescence of carbon-flame gases is seen: all non-luminous hydrocarbon flames are blue. 60. "While light, and radiation in general, can also be produced by the combustion of other materials besides hydrocarbon?,
industrially other materials are very little used.
Burning magnesium gives a luminous flame of extremely high brilliancy and whiteness. Its light is largely due to temperature radiation, and the flame makes its own incandescent radiator; but unlike the hydrocarbon flame, in which the radiator
is
again destroyed by combustion, the incandescent radiator of the magnesium flame is the product of combustion, magnesia, MgO, and escapes from the flame as white smoke. While, however, in the hydrocarbon flame the incandescent radiator is a black body, carbon, giving the normal temperature radiation,
the radiator of the magnesium flame, magnesia, is a colored radiator, and its radiation is deficient in intensity in the ultrain the visible range, and thereby of a much than higher efficiency given by black-body radiation. The is far more efficient than the hydroflame therefore magnesium carbon flame, and its light whiter. So also burning aluminum, zinc, phosphorus, etc., give luminous flames containing incandescent radiators produced by the combustion: alumina, zinc oxide, etc. Superimposed upon the temperature radiation of the incandescent radiator of those flames is the radiation of chemical
red,
luminescence.
Since,
however,
magnesium,
zinc,
aluminum,
give fairly luminous spectra, in these flames the chemical luminescence contributes a considerable part of the light, and where
color
also
the luminescent light, that is, the metal spectrum, is of a marked as green with zinc ^~ the flame of the burning metal
is
colored.
FLAMES AS ILLUMINANTS.
135
Obviously, where during the combustion no solid body is formed, the light given by the flame is entirely chemical luminescence. Thus burning sulphur gives a blue flame, and, if
the temperature of combustion is increased by burning the sulphur in oxygen it gives a fairly intense light, of violet color,
;
is
Thus
before development of the ultra-violet electric arcs, as the iron arc, for the production of ultra-violet radiation lamps were used,
burning carbon bisulphide, CS 2 in oxygen. Carbon bisulphide, has the advantage over sulphur that, as liquid, it can easier be handled in a lamp, and especially the combustion of carbon
,
(without adding much to the light, due to the non-luminous character of the carbon spectrum) greatly increases the flame temperature, and thereby the intensity of the radiation.
and its efficiency of light production therefore very low, especially at the relatively low temperature of the luminous hydrocarbon flame, and such flames are, therefore, low in
efficiency of light production, with the exception of the acetylene flame and other similar flames.
Separating the conversion into light from the heat production; that is, using the hydrocarbon flame merely for producing heat, and using a separate radiator for converting the heat into light,
offers
(1)
the great advantage That a colored body can be used as radiator, and thereby a higher efficiency of light production, at the same temperature, secured, by selecting a body deficient in invisible and thereby
useless radiation.
That the rapidity of combustion can be greatly increased by mixing the hydrocarbon with air in a bunsen burner, and thereby the temperature of the flame increased, which results
(2)
in a further increase of the efficiency of light production. Thus, by the use of suitable external radiators, in a non-
luminous hydrocarbon flame, far higher efficiencies of light production are reached than by the use of the luminous hydrocarbon flame.
136
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
The first use of external radiators probably was the use of a lime cylinder in a hydro-oxygen flame, in the so-called "lime light/ for producing very krge units of light in the days before the electric arc was generally available. In the last quarter of a century the external radiator has come into extended use in the Welsbach mantle; the hydrocarbon is burned in a bunsen burner, that is, mixed with air, so as to get a non-luminous flame of the highest temperature, and in this flame is immersed a cone-shaped web of a highly efficient colored radiator: thoria with a small percentage of ceria,
7
etc.,
mantle." The higher temperature, combined with the deficiency of radiation in the invisible range, exthe so-called
"
an efficiency of light of that as the luminous gas times as several high production flame. The distribution of intensity in the spectrum of the Welsbach mantle obviously is not that of black-body radiation,
hibited
by
but differs therefrom slightly, and the radiation is somewhat more intense in the greenish yellow, that is, the light has a
slightly greenish-yellow hue.
is very interesting as representing the extensive industrial only very application of colored radiation.
LECTUEE VUL
ARC LAMPS AND ARC LIGHTING.
Volt-Ampere Characteristics of the Arc.
62. The voltage consumed by an arc, at constant current, increases with increase of arc length, and very closely proportional thereto. Plotting the arc voltage, e, as function of the
FIG. 45.
arc length,
L}
we
straight line, as
shown
get for every value of current, i, a practically for the magnetite are in Fig, 45, for values
of current of 1, 2,
4 and 8 amperes.
These
138
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
consume a higher is, low-current arcs same length than high-current arcs, the in-
crease being greater the longer the arc. These lines in Fig. 45 0.125 cm. 0.05 in. intersect in a point which lies at I consumed the arc the that 30 e by voltage and is, volts;
consists of
a part,
is
con-
FIG. 46.
stant, that is, independent of the arc length and of the current in the arc, but different for different materials, and a or rather to part, e v which is proportional to the arc length, Z,
tite arc): \(l + 0.125), being the larger the smaller the current. Plotting the arc voltage, e, as function of the current, i, we get curves which increase with decrease of current, the increase being greater the longer the are, as shown in Fig. 46, for the
139
= 0.3, 1.25, 2.5, 3.75 cm. = 0.125, 0.5, 1 and magnetite arc, for I 1.5 in. Subtracting from the voltage, e in Fig. 46, the constant part, e = 30 volts, which apparently represents the
t
terminal drop of voltage, that is, the voltage which supplies the energy used in producing the conducting vapor stream at the negative, and the heat at the positive terminal, leaves eQ , as the voltage consumed in the arc e the voltage, e1
stream. The curves of arc-stream voltage, e^ as function of the current, i 9 in Fig. 46, can with good approximation be expressed by
cubic hyperbolas: e*i
kf\
or, e^
=*
Vi
and since we
find for
constant value of current: e = kt (1+ 0.12), as function of arc length and current, i, the voltage of the arc stream is expressed by: k
n
fl
and the
where
eo;
(&,
how-
ever, varies -with the gas pressure in the space in which the arc
exists).
This equation (2) represents the arc characteristics with good approximation, except for long low-current arcs, which usually require a higher voltage than calculated, as might be expected from the unsteady nature of such long thin arcs. The equation (2) can be derived from theoretical reasoning as follows: Assuming the amount of arc vapor, that is, the volume of the conducting vapor stream, as proportional to the current, and the heat produced at the positive terminal also as proportional to the current, the power pQ required to produce the vapor stream and the heating of the positive terminal is = e i, it proportional to the current, i; and, as the power is p the at arc terminals is follows that the voltage, eQ consumed
,
constant.
The power consumed in the arc stream: p l = eti, is given off, by heat conduction, convection, and by radiation, from the sur-
140
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
stream
face of the arc stream, and thus, as the temperature of the arc is constant, and is that of the boiling point of the arc
vapor, the power p 1 consumed in the arc stream is proportional to its surface, that is, to the product of arc diameter ld and arc length Z, or rather the arc length I increased by a small quantity
v which allows for the heat carried away to the electrodes. As the diameter ld is proportional to the square root of the section of the arc stream, and the section of the arc stream, or the
l
of the arc vapor, was assumed as proportional to the current, i, the arc diameter is proportional to the square root of the current, and the power pl consumed in the arc stream thus
volume
i,
and to
(I
+y
and since
pt =
e
e^,
+ -V^
k(l
-=
Z,)
>
which
is
equation
(1),
ev follows
equation (2). 63. Since e represents the power consumed in producing the vapor stream and the heating of the positive terminal, and k the power dissipated from the arc stream, e and k are different
and in general higher for materials of thus higher arc temperatures. It is, and higher boiling point
for different materials,
= 16 volts for zinc and cadmium, = 30 volts for magnetite, = 36 volts for carbon, = 48.5 for magnetite (123 in inch measure) = 51 for carbon (130 in inch measure).
are
Figs.
The magnetite arc, of which the characteristics 45 and 46, thus can be represented by
e
shown
in
3Q
48.5
(Z
+ 0.125). vi
The least agreement with the theoretical curve (2) is shown by the carbon arc. This may be expected from the exceptional character of the carbon arc, as discussed in Lecture VI. Plot-
141
arc, at
consumed by a carbon
i, as function of the arc length I, as done for the magnetite arc in Fig. 45, when using only the observations for arc length of 0.25 in. and over, we get fairly
which intersect at the point, giving 0.8 cm. = - 0.33 in.; that is, a t value much greater than for any other arc. For short arc
36
volts, but
= -
VOLT 450-
iso-
-130-
^
-30-
LENGT
-1.25
-0.5
-I
3rS
1[5 IN.
2.0
FIG. 47.
lengths, however, the observed values of voltage drop below the straight line, as shown in Fig. 47, and converge towards a
28 volts. This looks as if, of point, at zero arc length, or e the potential drop of eQ = 36 volts of the carbon arc, only a ' 28 volts, occurs at the surface of the terminals, and part, e
'
" 8 volts, occurs in the space within the remaining part, e a short distance from the terminal surface. If then the are length is decreased to less than the distance within which the
terminal drop e occurs, the arc meets only a part of this terminal drop e ", and, for very short arc length, only the terminal ' = 28 is consumed at drop c/ occurs. Possibly the voltage eQ the negative terminal in producing the conducting vapor stream,
142
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
while the voltage eQ" = 8 is consumed by the moving vapor stream in penetrating a layer of dead carbon vapor formed by heat evaporation from the positive terminal, and surrounding
this terminal.
Stability Curves of the Arc.
the volt-ampere characteristic of the arc, as repby equation (2) and reproduced in Fig. 48 as Curve I, for a magnetite arc of 1.8 cm, (about 0.75 in.) length, it follows that the arc is unstable on constant potential supply, as the voltage consumed by the arc decreases with increase of current and, inversely, a momentary increase of current decreases the consumed voltage, and, on constant voltage supply, thereby increases the current, still further decreases the arc voltage and increases the current, and the arc thus short circuits; or a momentary decrease of current increases the required voltage and, at constant supply voltage, continues to decrease the current and thus increase still further the required voltage, that is,
64.
From
resented
the arc goes out* On constant voltage supply only such apparatus can operate under stable conditions in which an increase of current requires
of current
a decrease of voltage,
Inserting in series with the arc, curve I, in Fig. 48, a constant resistance of 10 ohms, the voltage consumed by this resistance, e = ir is proportional to the current, and given by the straight
}
line II.
Adding
curve
I,
gives
of current, for values of current below iQ = 2.9 amperes, and the arc thus is unstable for these low currents, while for values of
the total voltage consumed by the arc and its series resistance, In curve III, the voltage decreases with increase as curve III.
\ =
2.9 amperes, the voltage increases with 2.9 amperes thus separates The point iQ
the unstable lower part of the curve III from the stable upper With a series resistance of r 10 ohms, a 1.8-cm. magpart. 117 volts supply voltage, netite arc thus requires at least e
and
series resistance, as r
amperes for steady operation. With a larger = 20 ohms, represented by curve IP and IIP, a larger supply voltage is required, but smaller currents can be operated; with a lower series resistance, r = 5 ohms, curves
iQ
2.9
143
II" and III", larger currents are required for stable operation, but a lower supply voltage is sufficient.
i
operate an arc close to the stability limit, of voltage causes a large variation of of the the arc is unsatisfactory, that is, the current, operation
,
When attempting to
FIG,
current drifts;
stream, and thereby of the voltage consumed by the arc, cause excessive fluctuations of the current. These pulsations of current can be essentially reduced by using a large inductance
in series with the arc, and an arc can be operated very much closer to its stability limit if its series resistance is constructed
is,
wound on an
iron core.
Obviously,
144
RADIATION, LIGHT,
series
AND ILLUMINATION.
no
stability point
At the
Fig.
48
r
resultant characteristic III in stability limit iQ , the the slope of the resistance curve is horizontal, that is,
f',
is
acteristic I,
~; d^
that
is,
+ r-0;
(fa
(4)
(2) in (4),
gives
or '
_
and the
length
I
(I
+Z
t?
2 i
total voltage
of current
and
is
and such a
reach stability
E=e+
.
ir,
feg
Z.)
*fl+*.).
that
is,
(6)
This curve
as
I,
is
IV
in Fig. 48.
It is shown called the stability curve of the arc. It is of the same form as the arc characteristic
and derived therefrom by adding 50 per cent of the voltage consumed in the arc stream. = 30 volts are Thus, in an arc requiring 80 volts, of which consumed at the terminals, e^ = 50 volts in the arc stream,
<?
/>
more than
80
-f
25
105 volts
is
required.
145
potential, thus lies at an exarc voltage by 50 per cent of the over cess of the supply voltage stream. In general, to get arc in the the voltage, e1} consumed reasonable steadiness of the current, and absence of drifting, a from supply voltage is used which exceeds the arc voltage by of the arc e of more the or 75 per cent to 100 per cent voltage, lf stream. 65. The preceding consideration applies only to those arcs in which the gas pressure in the space surrounding the arc, and are constant thereby the arc vapor pressure and temperature, arcs in air with case is the as of the and independent current, " " be cannot enclosure the as absolutely air(even enclosed arcs, section of the the that on the assumption tight), as it is based With arcs in current. the to vapor stream is proportional the current, with and which the vapor pressure temperature vary the the as as with vacuum arcs, reasoning has to be mercury arc,
on constant
pated by
length
I
arc in a glass correspondingly modified. Thus in the mercury fill the to entire is if tube, and the current sufficiently large tube, the of condensation that not so large mercury vapor cannot in the condensing chamber, the power p dissifreely occur radiation, etc., may be assumed as proportional to the
of the tube,
Pi
i:
this gives
el
e
= = =
V
kl,
kli,
ffl
eo e
+ +
and
(8)
that is, the voltage consumed by a mercury arc, within a certain range of current, is constant and independent of the cure and rent, and consists of a constant part, the terminal drop w diameter the to a part which is proportional to the length and of the tube. Approximately it is for the mercury arc in a vacuum:
e
13 volts ; k
-i
1.4
I'd
hence,
13
of vapor pressure and Calculating approximately the increase at resistance high currents, and the thereby of arc-stream
146
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
increase of resistance at low current, due to the arc stream not completely filling the vapor tube, gives for the vacuum arc the
approximate equation:
e
+
7
d*> ^"d
^
ald
bi
where
ld
= = =
a
Z>
= -
13 volts,
1.68,
anode,
Efficiency.
66.
The
employed
for illumination is
In this the arc flame or the vapor stream no useful the light is given by the black-body but light, gives radiation of the incandescent carbon terminal, mainly the positive terminal, which is hottest, and is given at high efficiency due to the very high temperature of the radiator. The light of the carbon arc thus is incandescent light, and not luminesIn the alternating carbon arc, alternately, the two tercence. minals are positive and negative, and, as relatively little heat is
the plain carbon arc.
produced at the negative terminal, the average temperature of the carbon terminals of an alternating arc is lower, and the
efficiency of light production therefore less.
current carbon arcs reach efficiencies corresponding to specific consumptions -of from 1 to 1.5 watts per mean spherical candle
power, alternating carbon arcs show only from 2.5 to 3 watts per candle power, or even still higher specific consumption. Thus, the only excuse for the use of the alternating carbon arc is the much greater simplicity and convenience of the electric generating apparatus, the stationary transformer, compared to the arc machine with the direct-current arc, and with the development of the constant-current mercury-arc rectifier; this
147
largely disappeared. In the direct-current carbon arc, the light comes mainly from the positive terminal; in the alternating carbon arc equally
light
Since in the carbon arc no useful light comes from the arc flame, the voltage and therefore the power consumed in the
wasted, and in general, therefore, the efficiency of light production of the carbon arc is the higher the shorter the arc. Thus comparing in Fig. 49 a 1-in. carbon arc A with a
arc flame
is
FIG. 49.
0.5-in.
and 560 watts, the latter only 84 volts and 420 watts, but radiates the same amount of light from the incandescent
volts
tip of the positive carbon.
cent
As the 1-in. arc requires 33 per more power, and only produces the same amount of light,
than the
latter.
it is less efficient
we make
the arc and the less power we therefore consume in it the more efficient seems the light production, as we produce the same
from the positive terminal in either to short arc lengths, however, while the same amount of light is produced at the positive terminal, we do not get the same amount of light from the lamp, as an
of light radiation
case.
amount
When we come
increasing part of the light is intercepted by the negative terminal. Thus with the 1-in. arc, A, in Fig, 49, the light escapes
148
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
freely from the incandescent positive only in the space above the shadow of the negative terminal the lines m, while at
begins to obstruct the light more and more, and does so comIn the 0.5-in. arc the area pletely vertically below the arc.
covered by the shadow of the negative terminals is somewhat increased, but in both arcs A and B the obstruction of the light by the shadow of the negative is still so small that the saving in power far more than makes up for it. In the 0.125-in.
however, C in Fig. 49, the shadow of the negative terhas crept up greatly, and thus, when decreasing the minal arc length, a point is reached where the increasing shadow of the negative terminal reduces the light more than the dearc,
creasing
arc
length
reduces
the
power supply.
Maximum
efficiency of light production thus is reached in the carbon arc at a certain definite arc length (which depends on the size of
the electrodes and on the current), at which" the change of power consumption just balances the change of radiated light,
which
results
shadow With
at about |-in, arc length, giving a efficiency point of 45 to 50 volts. Such arcs require about voltage consumption are no longer used in American and therefore daily trimming,
mum
except in a few places. or short-burning arc has been practically entirely superseded by the enclosed or long-burning arc lamp, in which the arc is enclosed by an almost air-tight globe, the combustion
cities,
The open
and the
life of
In the open arc of large current, the carbon terminals burn off into a rounded shape, but in the enclosed arc, the current being less and combustion greatly reduced, the carbon terminals burn off to more flat shape, and thus obstruct the light more;
and, furthermore, since at the lower current the size of the incandescent spot of the positive terminal is less, the maximum efficiency of light production in the enclosed arc lamp is reached at a much greater arc length, about f in. As the result
thereof, the enclosed arc lamp, with 5, 6.5 or 7.5 the arc, consumes from 70 to 75 volts.
67.
amperes in
149
magnetite arc. In this, the light is given by the vapor stream, and not by the terminals, and the voltage e and power consumed by the terminal drop thus is wasted, and the voltage el and power p 1 consumed by the arc stream is useful for light production. The greater, therefore, the voltage el of the arc stream is, compared with the terminal drop e , or in other words the longer the arc, the higher is the efficiency of light production. Thus a 4-amp. magnetite arc of 0.125-in. length requires 41 volts, while a 0.5-in. 4-amp. arc requires 64 volts; that is, only 56 per cent more voltage and thus power, but gives about four times the light. A 1-in. arc requires 95 volts or 48 per cent more power than the 0.5-in. arc, and gives twice the light. The greater, thus, the arc length of the luminous Howarc, with the same current, the higher is the efficiency. the the at same the the the is ever, current, arc, longer greater In the the arc of the lamp power consumption. design power consumption is given, and the problem is to select the most efficient arc length for a given and constant power consumption. As an increase of arc length increases the arc voltage for the same power consumption, the current has to be decreased, and the efficiency of the arc conductor decreases with decrease of current. Thus, with increasing arc length at constant power consumption in the luminous arc, a point is reached where the decrease of current required by the increase of arc length and thus arc voltage decreases the efficiency more than the increase Thus with the luminous arc, for of arc length increases it. a given power consumption, a definite are length exists, which
gives
maximum
efficiency.
Assuming the light given by the arc to be proportional to the arc length and the current in the arc,
L=
if
k'K,
arc, it is
(9)
the power
shall
be consumed in the
ei
p;
(10)
however, by
(2),
e=e
+^ V^
(11)
(neglecting the small quantity l v as the calculation can obviously be approximate only).
150
RADIATION, LIGHT,
(10)
AND ILLUMINATION.
From
and
(11)
Mows:
~*
/
I
*
.-
__
C?Q -\/
/^\ I
9 '
f~\
f)\ v*-^/
(9), gives;
L = -7 (pV7 A
and the maximum amount
given by:
of
tf
e^Vi),
light
(13)
produced by power
is
dL = TF & a
^
This gives
p
9 K/ * t/r
;
hence,
by
(13)
(11),
Assuming p
arc
:
eQ
30, k
= 48.5,
i
e
I
= = -
0.885
in.
efficiency,
where the
efficiency curve is
horizontal, the efficiency does not vary much for moderate changes of current and of arc length. Thus, in above instance, practically the same efficiency is reached for currents from 3
amperes to 4 amperes. Larger currents and shorter arc lengths, however, are preferable in an arc lamp. (1) Because the shorter and thicker arc is less affected by minor air currents, etc., than the thin long arc, hence, is steadier. (2) The shorter arc gives lower voltage, and this, in constantcurrent arc lighting, permits with the same total circuit voltage
the use of more arc lamps in series. Thus in the magnetite arc lamp a current of 4 amp. has been chosen*
i
75
volts,
and
0.73
in.,
length.
151
In general, obviously the maximum efficiency points of luminous arcs occur at much greater arc lengths than in the plain carbon arc. Since the lower efficiency of the alternating carbon arc is due to the lower temperature of the terminals, which are heated during one half-wave only, and in the luminous arc the temperature of the terminals does not determine the light production, but the light is produced by the vapor stream, no essential difference exists in the efficiency of a luminous arc, and practically no difference in the efficiency of the flamecarbon arc, whether operated on alternating or on direct current; that is, the alternating luminous or flame-carbon arc, with the same luminescent material, has the same efficiency as the directcurrent luminous or flame-carbon arc, but the alternating plain carbon arc is much less efficient than the direct-current carbon
arc.
Arc Lamps.
68.
The apparatus
by
light
four elements:
(1)
(2) (3)
(4)
(1)
The current-limiting or steadying device. The starting device. The feeding device. The shunt protective device. From the volt-ampere characteristic of the
it
by equation (2) and curves, Fig. 46, not be operated directly on constant voltage supply, but in series thereto a steadying device must be inserted; that is, a device in which the voltage increases with the current so that the total voltage consumed by the arc and the steadying device increases with increase of current, and pulsations of current thus limit themselves. All arc lamps for use on constant voltage supply thus contain a sufficiently high steadying resistance, or, in alternating-current
follows that
circuits,
a steadying reactance. Arc lamps for use on constant-current circuits, that is, circuits in which the current is kept constant by the source of
as the constant-current transformer or the arc
power supply,
152
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
tial
are operated in series on constant potentwo flame-carbon arcs in series in a 110-volt cirin a 550-volt railway circuit, cuit, or five enclosed arc lamps either each lamp may have its own steadying resistance, or a
reactance of sufficient size may single steadying resistance or be used for all lamps which are in series on the constant potential
mains.
Since the arc does not start itself, but has to be started forming the conducting vapor bridge between the terminals,
(2)
by
lamps must have a starting device. This consists of a mechanism which brings the terminals into contact with each other and then separates them, and hereby forms the vapor
all arc
conductor, that is, starts the arc. in some arcs, (3) As the arc terminals consume very rapidly as the open carbon arc, and very slowly in others, as the
enclosed carbon arcs or the luminous arcs, some mechanism must be provided which moves the terminals towards each
other at the rate at which they are consumed, and thereby maintains constant arc length and thus constant voltage and power
consumption.
With
arcs in
the magnetite arc, the feeding may occur only at long intervals, every quarter or half hour, or even less frequently, while in arcs with rapidly consuming electrodes, as the flame arcs, practically
continuous feeding
is
required.
(4) The circuit between the arc electrodes may accidentally open, as by a breakage of one electrode, or by the consumption
if the lamp-trimmer has forgotten to replace the of electrodes may stick and fail to feed, and them, or one the arc thus indefinitely lengthen. In such cases, either the entire circuit would open, and thus all the lamps in series in
of the electrodes
if
as in a
constant-current series
circuit
the circuit voltage is sufficiently high, system, the arc lamp would be
damaged by a
destructive arc.
Thus
a device is necessary which closes a shunt circuit between the lamp terminals in case the lamp voltage becomes excessive by
proper operation of the lamp. is operated on constant potential lowvoltage supply, no such protective device is needed. If with two or more lamps in series on constant potential supply, no
failure of
153
objection exists, in case of the failure of one lamp, to have the others go out also, the shunt protective device may also be omitted, except if the circuit voltage is so high that it may
damage the inoperative lamp, as is the case with 550 volts. When operating a number of lamps in series on constant potential supply, as two flame lamps on 110 volts, the shunt
which is closed in case of the failure of one lamp to operate, must have such a resistance, or reactance with altercircuit,
nating currents, that the remaining lamp still receives its proper voltage, even if the other lamp fails and its shunt circuit closes. With alternating-current lamps, this does not require a reactance of such size that the potential difference across the reactance equals that across the lamp, which it replaces, but
the reactance must be larger; that difference at its terminals, than the
is,
leave the normal operating voltage for the remaining lamp, since the voltage consumed by the reactance is out of phase
with the voltage consumed by the lamp. 69. For illustration, the operating mechanism of a constant direct-current arc lamp is shown diagrammatically in Fig. 50: The lower electrode A is held in fixed position. The upper
electrode
slides loose in
a holder
(7,
and thus,
if
there
is
no
current through the lamp, drops down into contact with the lower carbon, as shown in Fig. 50. When there is a current
through the arc circuit, its path is from terminal 1 through electromagnet S holder C, upper electrode B, lower electrode A to terminal 2. The electromagnet S is designed so as to give a long stroke. When energized by the current, it pulls up its armature, the lever DD', which is pivoted at E. Through the rod F, the lever D pulls up the clutch G. This clutch and its operation are shown in larger scale in Fig. 51, a and 6; it consists of a metal piece G which has a hole somewhat larger than the upper electrode B. This electrode slides freely through the
}
}
hole,
if
the clutch
When
the rod
G is in horizontal position, as shown in Fig. 51a. F pulls the clutch G up, and thereby inclines the
piece G, as
shown
the piece
in Fig. 516, the edges p and q of the hole in catch the electrode B, and, in the further upward
motion of D and F, raise the other electrode, B, from contact with the lower carbon, A, and thereby start the arc. An electromagnet of many turns of fine wire, and of high resistance, P,
154
RADIATION, LIGHT,
1
AND ILLUMINATION.
2
FIG. 50.
PIG.
51k
connected in shunt between the lamp terminals 1 and 2, acts upon the side Z)' of the lever DD', opposite from the side D, on which the series magnet S acts. With the carbons in contact with each other, and practically no voltage between the lamp
terminals 1 and
2,
the
coil
P receives
,of the series magnet S the lever D pull. the arc and lengthens, its voltage increases, and starts pulls up,
When by
the action
155
a branch current is established through the shunt magnet P, and this shunt magnet thus opposes the series magnet S. With increasing arc length and thus arc voltage, a point is reached, where the shunt magnet P counterbalances the pull of the series magnet S, and the lever D and thereby the electrode B come to rest; the arc has reached its full length, that is, the starting operation is over. As soon as, by the combustion of the electrodes, the arc length and thereby the arc voltage begins to rise, the current in the shunt magnet P, and thus its
while that of the series magnet being enerthe constant main remains gized by current, constant; the lever If thus pulls up, and lowers >, and thereby, through rod F and clutch (?, the upper electrode B, and thus maintains constant arc length. During the combustion of the electrodes, by the operation of the shunt magnet P, the clutch G and thereby
pull, increases,
,
the upper electrode B are gradually lowered, and the arc length thus maintained constant. Ultimately, however, the clutch G hereby approaches the horizontal position, shown in Fig. 51a,
so far, that the edges of the hole, the electrode is free and drops
p and
q,
cease to engage,
and
down on
While dropping, however, the arc shortens, the arc voltage, and thereby the current in the shunt magnet P, decreases, the pull of this magnet decreases correspondingly, and the series magnet
again, thereby catches the electrode B has dropped quite down into contact with A and again increases the arc to its proper the and same cycle of operation repeats: a gradual length, of down the upper electrode B by the shunt magnet feeding until it slips, and is pulled up again by the series magnet S. From the same lever D is supported, by rod L, a contactmaker K. If then the upper electrode B should stick, and thus does not slip, when by the shunt magnet P the clutch G has been has been entirely conbrought into horizontal position, or, if to the arc continues lengthen and the pull of the sumed, etc.,
G up
it
shunt magnet
to rise,
and
until contact-maker
MN, and thereby closes a shunt circuit from terminal 1 over resistance R, conto terminal 2. In the same manner, if, by the tacts of one electrode or any other cause, the arc should be breaking for moment the full current passes through shunt a interrupted,
closes the contacts
thereby goes
still
further
down
MKN
156
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
and
it pulls up its armature D' to its full extent, the shunt circuit around the lamp. closes thereby
magnet P,
When
the current
is
taken
off
drops
closes the
shunt
circuit,
and clutch
and
it
drops
down
carbon A. In starting the lamp, two paths thus are available: over series magnet S, and electrodes B and A, or over resistance R and contacts MN. While the resistance of the former path Therefore a sufficient is veiy low, it is not entirely negligible. resistance R must be inserted in the by-path MN, so that in over S and the elecstarting practically all the current passes not start. would the otherwise as During the lamp trodes, series D the armature the of S, in startmagnet by pulling up G has clutch the before the contact caught the opens,
ing,
are still in contact is, while the electrodes B] therefore breaks of contact the and each with opening other, hence is or no appreciable voltage current, sparkless. In this lamp, no steadying resistance is used, as it is intended If used on confor operation on a constant-current circuit. in series on a number for instance, circuit, as,
electrode
that
stant-potential
would be inserted, as
indi-
The
is
MKN.
is
Such an
magnet.
arc
lamp
called
differential
lamp,
'as it is
con-
a shunt and a
that
is,
series
the upper
electrode suspended by the balance of two forces, exerted by the shunt magnet; that is, by the current and and the series the the voltage; upper carbon therefore is almost continuously in following the pulsation of the arc resistance slightly
moving
which occurs during operation. arc, the arc flame gives no light,
is
Since, with the plain carbon this pulsation of the are length
not objectionable; and, since the lamp regulates very closely and rapidly for constant terminal voltage, it is very easy on the of current and circuit, that is, does not tend to produce surging
voltage in the circuit. The floating system of control fore, used in all carbon arc lamps.
is,
there-
1ST
single lamp Is operated on a constant-potential the mechanism can be simplified by omitting the procircuit, shunt circuit tective RMN, and omitting the shunt magnet P, of arc length, the main current and thereby as, with a change the pull of the series magnet S varies, and the control thus can be done by the series magnet. Such a lamp then is called a
series
lamp.
An
is
alternating-current
series
lamp
shown diagrammatically
series
in Fig. 52.
In starting, the
magnet S pulls
the clutch G,
50.
up the
in the
electrode
B by
same manner
as in Fig.
With
in the series
magnet S
decreases,
thereby the pull of this magnet, until just counterbalances the weight of the armature, and the motion stop. With the consumption of the carbons, the armature D, clutch G and elecit
gradually move down, until the clutch lets the carbon slip, the arc shortens, the current rises, and the magnet S pulls up again, the same
trode
as in Fig. 50.
A reactance x
in series
with the lamp, as steadying device, FIG. 52. limits the current. This reactance usually is arranged with different terminals, so that more or less reactance can be connected into circuit, and the lamp thereby operated, with the same arc voltage, on supply circuits of different voltage, usually from 110 to 125 volts. Obviously, such a series lamp can be used only as single lamp on constant potential supply, as it regulates by the variation of current, and, with several lamps in series, the current
One lamp would in all lamps. of destructive draw an arc then take all the voltage, length, while the other lamps would drop their electrodes together and
would vary in the same manner
go out.
70.
arc, in
is
proportional
158
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
to the arc length, pulsations of the arc length, if appreciable, give pulsations of the light, and the floating system of control, which maintains constant voltage by varying the arc length in
correspondence with the pulsation of arc resistance, thus is undesirable, and a mechanism maintaining fixed arc length Such a mechanism, that of the magnetite arc lamp, is required. is diagrammatically illustrated
in Fig, 53.
a As, during operation, melted pool forms on the surface of the electrode, the elec-
trodes are left separated from each other when taking the
power
off
the
circuit,
since
to-
when
power
letting
them drop
off
the
they may weld together and the lamp thus fail to start
again.
movable, J5, the nonconsuming upper positive electrode, consisting of a piece of copper, with heat-radiating wings, W, which is a station-
which
is
FIG. 53.
When
through a powerful electromagnet or solenoid and resistance J?, to terminal 2. The solenoid pulls up its core D, and by the clutch G raises the lower electrode A into contact with the upper electrode, B, and thereby closes the circuit from 1 over series coil S, electrodes B and A, to terminal 2. The series coil >S pulls up the core, and thereby opens the contact MN, thus cuts out the shunt circuit OR. The solenoid thus loses its excitation, and drops the clutch G, and the lower terminal A drops away from the upper terminal B by a
9
contacts MN
ary and fixed part of the lamp. is the chimney required to carry off the smoke. beginning at terminal 1, passes
159
distance which is fixed by an adjustable clutch, Q, and thus starts an arc of definite length. the arc When during the consumption of this electrode
length and thereby the arc voltage rises, the shunt magnet P increases in strength, and ultimately pulls the core away of the shunt from the series magnet S, closes the contact
MN
circuit
This again
raises, by the clutch G, the lower electrode the upper electrode B, and so repeats the cycle of operation. and B opens, the solenoid S loses its If the arc between of the excitation, the coil drops and closes the contact
MN
were perfectly constant, such a mechanism would not operate satisfactorily, as the arc would have to lengthen considerably to have the shunt coil P overpower the
If the arc resistance
series coil
tact
MN,
down,
The
resistance of
pulsates,
an
its voltage,
x>5-90
\7
ME
PIG. 54.
ous height follow each other. Thus with an average arc voltwill probably be reached age of 75, momentary peaks of 85 volts volts of 100 every few minutes, of 110 every few seconds, peaks shunt magnet P so as to the volts every half hour. Adjusting above a 105, which causes voltage peak operate at 105 volts, reached about be would every 20 minutes. the lamp to feed, arc the length does not appreDuring 20 minutes, however,
160
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
Due to of the electrode. ciably increase by the consumption a consuch a as arc the resistance, of character the pulsating thus maintains constant arc length by a
trolling
mechanise
for a voltage considerably above the averpotential magnet set arc voltage. age Such a mechanism, controlling for constant arc length, does not operate for constant voltage at the lamp terminals, but allows the pulsation of the arc resistance to appear as pulsation In a constant-current circuit, with of the terminal voltage.
many lamps
arcs overlap and have no effect on the circuit. When operating, however, a lamp of such a mechanism on a low-voltage constant
inductive steadying resistance is depotential circuit, a highly the of care take pulsations of arc voltage. sirable, to or 71. The open short-burning carbon arcs of former times
cities
and
6.6
enclosed or long-burning carbon arcs are operated on constant-current circuits of 5 amp. and 6.6 amp. direct current, or of 6.5 and 7.5 amp. alternating current, with about 72 volts at the lamp terminals. They are operated as
The present
5 to 9 amp. on direct- or alternating-current constant potential circuits of 110 to 125 volts, or two lamps in series on circuits of 220 to 250 volts.
single lamps, of
The flame-carbon
arcs, as
operated two in series on constant-potential circuits of 110 to 125 volts, or four in series on circuits of 220 to 250 volts, with
10 to 15 amp. in the arc. The luminous arcs are operated on 4- and 6.6-amp. constant direct-current circuits (magnetite lamp), with 75 volts per lamp, and on 3- and 4.5-amp. constant alternating-current circuits (titanium-carbide arc), with 80 volts per lamp.
Arc
72.
Circuits.
Arc lamps are built for, and operated on, constant-potensupply, and on constant-current supply. In general, the constant-potential arc lamp is less efficient, as voltage and thereby power is consumed in the steadying resistance which is
tial
is,
to give
an approximate
161
constant-current effect, as discussed above. In alternatingcurrent circuits, reactance may* and usually is, employed instead of the steadying resistance, and the waste of power thereby greatly decreased. Voltage, however, is still consumed and the
An
two lamps in
series.
arc lamp, with about 70 volts at the arc, a supply voltage of 95 to 100 volts would be sufficiently high above the stability
curve of the arc (Fig. 46) to give steady operation. Distribution voltages, however, vary between 110 to 130 volts, and the difference thus must be consumed in resistance, giving an
additional waste.
ing resistance
cuit,
some useful devices, as incandescent lamps, can be employed.) With an enclosed arc lamp on a 125-volt cir-
only 36 volts, or 29 per cent, are usefully employed in heating the carbon terminals and thereby producing the light, while the remaining 71 per cent is wasted in the resistance
and in the non-luminous arc flame. Somewhat better are the when operating two high-current open arcs, as two flame lamps, in series on such a circuit. However, at the lower distribution voltage, as 110 volts, the supply voltage may be
conditions
already so close to the stability limit of the arc that the arcs
are not as steady as desirable.
The low-current, long luminous arcs of electro-conduction, as the magnetite arc, can in general be operated only with difficulty on circuits of 110 to 125 volts, and therefore are, for
constant-potential service, frequently designed for operation as single lamps on 220 to 250 volts supply, with extra great arc
length.
For indoor illumination, constant-potential arc lamps must obviously be used, as safety does not permit the introduction For outof the high-voltage series arc circuits into houses.
door illumination, as street lighting, in the United States the constant-current arc lamp is, with the exception of the interior of a few very large cities, as New York, used exclusively, due to its greater efficiency, and the greater distance to which the cur-
162
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
rent can be sent at the high voltage of the constant-current In American towns and cities, where are lamps are circuit.
used for street lighting, practically always the entire city up to the farthest suburbs is lighted by arc lamps, and frequently arc lamps installed even beyond the reach of the high-potential primary alternating-current supply. To reach such distances with low-voltage constant-potential supply, is impossible, and thus the constant-current series system becomes necessary. In European cities, where a prejudice exists against high-voltage
constant-current circuits, and people are satisfied to have arc lamps only in the interior of the city, and leave the lighting of
the suburbs to gas lamps, constant-potential street lighting is within the generally employed, and is eminently satisfactory are cities which with limitations satisfied, but would European American the in be impossible city. average Where plain carbon arcs are used in American cities the
enclosed arc lamp is exclusively installed, and open arc lamps have survived only in a few exceptional cases, mainly where
political reasons
their replacement
by
modern lamps. The lesser attention required by the enclosed arc lamp weekly trimming instead of daily with the open arc has been found to make it more economical than the lamp
cheaper, and the daily attention not considered objectionable, the open or short-burning arc lamp has maintained its hold, and the en-
of old.
is
closed are
to
With
the development of the flame carbon, the flame arc, therefore, has found a rapid introduction in Europe, while in the United States it was excluded from use in street lighting, due to its shortburning feature, which requires daily trimming, and is used only for decorative purposes, for advertising, etc., until an enclosed or
long burning flame arc lamp had been developed. In spite of the lower efficiency of the alternating carbon arc, the constant-current circuits used for arc lighting are generally
due to the greater convenience of generation of and constant direct-current arc circuits used only where the city or the electric light company lays stress on the efficiency of light production. While the development of the constant-current mercury arc
alternating,
alternating
current,
rectifier
163
this
almost as simple and convenient as that of alternating current, has very little increased the use of the direct-current enclosed arc lamp, but when changing to direct current supply, usually the arc lamp is also changed to the luminous arc,
the magnetite lamp, which gives more light and consumes less
circuits, usually from 50 to 100 in series on one circuit, with circuit voltare operated lamps 8000 volts. to of 4000 Seventy-five-lamp circuits, of 6000 ages
probably are the most common. Constant direct current was produced by so-called "arc machines" or "constant-current generators." Of these only the Brush machine has survived, and is now also beginning to disappear before the mercury arc rectifier, which changes the alternating current of the constant-current transformer to direct current without requiring moving machinery. The Brush machine in its principle essentially is a quarterphase constant-current alternator with rectifying commutator. An alternator of low armature reaction and strong magnetic field regulates for constant potential: the change of armature reaction, resulting from a change of load, has little effect on the field and thereby on the terminal voltage, if the armature reaction is low. An alternator of very high armature reaction and weak field, however, regulates for constant current: if the m.m.f., that is, the ampere-turns required in the field coil to produce the magnetic flux, are small compared with the field ampere-turns required to take care of the armature reaction,
volts,
73.
and the resultant or magnetism-producing field ampere-turns thus the small difference between total field excitation and armsfture reaction, a moderate increase of armature current and thereby of armature reaction makes it equal to the field excitation, and leaves no ampere-turns for producing the magnetism; that is, the magnetic flux and thereby the machine voltage disappear. Thus, in such a machine, the current output at constant field excitation rises very little, from full voltage down to short circuit, or, in other words, the machine
Perfect constantregulates for approximately constant current. current regulation is produced by a resistance shunted across the in the machine circuit, field, which is varied by an electromagnet
and lowered
that
is,
it,
and
164
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
if the machine curthereby the field excitation decreased rent tends to rise by a decrease of the required circuit voltage,
and
inversely.
7
not produced by
constant-current regulation of the arc machine thus is u its so-called regulator/ but approximate constant-current regulation is inherent in the machine design,
The
and the regulator merely makes the regulation perfect. A more explicit discussion of the phenomena in the arc machine, and especially its rectification, is given in Chapter III of Section II of "Theory and Calculation of Transient Electric Phenomena and Oscillations."
In alternating-current circuits, approximate constant-current regulation is produced by a large reactance, that is, by selfinduction, in the circuit. In transformers, the self-induction is the stray field, or the leakage flux between primary coil and secondary coil. In the constant-current transformer, which is most generally used for constant alternating-current supply from constant alternating voltage, the primary turns and the secondary turns are massed together so as to give a high magSuch a transformer of high netic stray flux between the coils.
internal self-induction, or high stray flux, regulates approximately for constant current. Perfect constant-current regula-
produced by arranging the secondary and the primarymovable with regard to each other, so that, when low circuit voltage is required, the coils move apart, and the stray The flux, that is, the reactance, increases, and inversely. motion of the coils is made automatic by balancing the magnetic repulsion between the coils by a counter-weight. A discussion of the constant-current transformer and its mode of operation is given in "Theory and Calculation of Electric Circuits," Chap. XIV. In the so-called "constant-current reactance," the two coils
tion
is
coils
wound
for the
same
current, and connected in opposition with each other, and in series to the arc circuit into the constant-potential mains.
With the
and
it
coils close to
is
maximum
each other, the reactance is a minimum, with the coils their maximum distance
of greater
it
apart.
connects
165
the arc circuits electrically with the constant-potential alternating-current system, and any ground in an arc circuit is a ground on the constant-potential supply system. As grounds
are
more
is therefore very little used, and generally the constant-current transformer preferred, as safer. In the constant direct-current mercury-arc rectifier system,
reactance
the constant-potential alternating-current supply is changed to constant alternating current by a constant-current transformer,
to constant the An rectifier. by mercury-arc explicit discussion of the phenomena of the constant-current mercury arc
rectifier is
given in Chapter IV of Section II of "Theory and Calculation of Transient Electric Phenomena and Oscillations."
If the constant-current arc circuit accidentally opens,
with a
Brush machine as source of supply, the voltage practically vanishes, as the machine has series field excitation, and thus The constant-current transloses its field on open circuit. former, however, maintains its voltage, and gives maximum voltage on open circuit. The mercury arc rectifier, when separately excited
its
by a
voltage on open
is
small exciting transformer, also maintains circuit. If, however, after starting, the
excitation
is
taken off, that is, the exciting circuit opened, as permissible in a steady arc circuit, the voltage in the arc circuit disappears if the arc circuit is opened. Inversely, when a Brush to arc an arc circuit machine, an appreconnecting of machine builds the the ciable time elapses while voltage up, while with the constant-current transformer and thus also
with the constant-current mercury arc
age exists even before
ther* circuit is
rectifier
system,
full volt-
closed.
LECTURE
IX.
Since radiation
is
eter in the circuit of this thermo-couple thus measures the voltage produced by the difference of temperature of the two contacts of the thermo-couple, and in this manner the temper-
ature rise produced by the energy of the incident beam of radiais observed. Probably the most sensitive method of measuring even very small amounts of radiation is the bolometer. The beam of the radiation (or after dissolving the beam into a spectrum, the wave length of which the power is to be measured) impinges upon a narrow and thin strip of metal, as platinum, and thereby raises its temperature by conversion of the radiation energy
tion
into heat.
rise of
electric resistance,
and the
platinum strip in a sensitive Wheatstone bridge. The rise of temperature of the platinum strip by the small power of radiation obviously is so small that it could not be observed by any thermometer. Electric resistance measurements, however, can be made with extreme accuracy, and especially extremely small changes of resistance can be measured. Thus a change of resistance of 1 in a million and, with very sensitive measurements, even many times smaller changes can be observed. As 1 deg. cent, produces a resistance change of about 0.4 per cent, a change of one millionth corresponds to a temperature rise of sinnr deg. cent. Thus, by the bolometer, extremely small amounts of radiation can be measured, as, for instance, the power of the moon's radiation, etc.
iea
167
measured by absorbing
as, for instance,
a body for a given time can be and measuring the heat produced by
the amount of ice melted in a calorimeter. Any particular range of the total radiation, as, for instance, the total visible radiation, can be measured in the same manner by passing the radiation first through a body which absorbs that part which is not desired, for instance, a body transparent
to visible, but
opaque to
invisible radiation.
As no body
is
to another radiperfectly transparent to one, perfectly opaque radiation of the by absorption is necation, the separation therefore be made must correction essarily incomplete, and inconvenient rather this method makes This in the result.
and inaccurate.
total radiation
by
practically impossible to absorption in a calorimeter, either losing some, or without collect the total radiation is not radiation, but heat conducincluding energy, which
tion or convection.
Obviously, by enclosing the radiator in the calorimeter, the latter would measure not only the radiconvecation, but also the power lost by heat conduction,
tion, etc.
Sometimes the power of radiation can be measured by measthe uring input and losses. Thus, in an incandescent lamp, heat lost the and by power electric-power input is measured, conduction and convection estimated if not entirely negligible. In those cases in which all or most of the energy supplied is
converted into radiation, as in an incandescent lamp, this method is the most exact. However, it can directly measure the different parts only the total radiation power. To measure of the radiation so as to determine separately the power in the the method of visible, the ultra-red, and the ultra-violet range, radiation total the power, input and losses can be used to give of the and, by bolometer or other means, the relative powers the From of a beam in radiations measured light.
component
total radiation
and the
ratio of its
the values of radiation power 75. Light) however, cannot be measured by any of the prein which it is conceding methods, since light, in the sense is the physiological but not sidered photometrically, is power, of radiation, and therefore caneffect of certain wave lengths
of the components.
168
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
same
The power of visible radiation obviously can be measured, and thus we can express the power of the visible radiation of a mercury lamp or an incandescent lamp in watts. But the power of visible radiation is not proportional to the physiologiOne watt of green cal effect, and thus not a measure thereof.
many times as great a physiological effect, that does one watt of red or violet radiation, and, as is, more light, kind of physiological effect: a differdifferent a besides, gives color. ent The unit in which illuminating value of light, or its intensity,
radiation gives
is
light
candle-power/ is, therefore, a physiological it has no direct or connot a and physical quantity, and hence watt. The unit of or the of unit the to relation stant power, as the physioconvention: chosen been has by intensity
expressed as the
logical effect exerted
"
sq.
mm.
of melting
platinum, or by a flame burning a definite chemical compound at a definite rate and under as amyl acetate or pentane
definite conditions, etc.
Broadly, therefore, the conception of a chemical equivalent of candle power and watt, is light, that is, a relation between between time and distance a relation irrational, just as, broadly,
is
be expressed by irrational; that is, just as distance cannot be cannot candle so of the unit expressed by a power time,
relation between two such unit of power, as the watt. be established only by an can different quantities inherently conventional additional assumption, and varies with a change extraneous of this assumption. Thus stellar distances are
measured in "light years," that is, by the distance traveled by the light in one year, as unit. So also the physiological effect of one definite color of light, as that of the green mercury line, or the yellow sodium line, or the red lithium line, can be related to the unit of power, or the watt, and we may speak of a mechanical equivalent of green light, or of yellow light, or of red When doing so, however, we give to the term "mechanlight. ical equivalent" a different meaning from what it has in physics,
The latter for instance, as "mechanical equivalent of heat." of the forms different is the constant relation between two
same physical
quantity, while, for instance, the "mechanical
169
equivalent of green light' is the relation between a physiological effect and the physical quantity required to produce the effect, and thus is not necessarily constant, but may, and does,
vary with the intensity of the effect, the individuality of the observer, etc. It appears, however, that at higher intensities the relation is very nearly constant and the same with different observers, so that
effect of
it is
a definite wave length of radiation, within the accuracy of physiological measurements, by the power consumed in producing this wave length of radiation; but it becomes entirely impossible to compare physiological effects of widely different wave lengths by comparing the power required to produce them. When speaking of mechanical equivalent of light, it thus must be understood in the extended meaning of the word, as
discussed above.
ing, it is
In photometry, and in general in illuminating engineerof essential importance to keep in mind this difference in the character of light as physiological effect, and radiation
76.
as physical quantity of power. This is the reason why all attempts to reduce photometry to a strictly physical measure-
ment, and thereby bring photometric determinations up to the high grade of exactness feasible in physical observations, have failed and must necessarily fail; we cannot physically compare an effect as light, which is not a physical quantity, but somewhere in all photometric methods the physiological feature, that is, the judgment of the human eye, must always
enter.
Photometric tests therefore can never have the accuracy of All attempts to eliminate strictly physical determinations. from human of the the judgment eye photometry, by replacing it by the selenium cell, or the photographic plate, or
Crookes' radiometer, etc., necessarily are wrong in principle and in results: some of those instruments, as the bolometer, the radiometer, etc., compare the power of the radiation, others, as the selenium cell or the photographic plate, the power of
certain changes of radiation, but their results are comparisons of power, and not of physiological effects, and thus they cannot be of value in measurement of illuminating power.
Measurements of light thus are made by comparison with an arbitrarily chosen conventional unit, a primary standard
1TO
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
of light, as "standard candle/' or a duplicate or multiplicate of light, usually not the thereof. Obviously^ in measurements a more conveniently but of is standard used, light primary
arranged secondary standard of light, that is, a standard which has been calibrated by comparison, directly or indirectly, with a
primary standard. 77. The most accurate method of comparing lights is the zero method, as represented by the different types of photomThe illumination produced by the two different sources of eters. are made equal the one to be tested and the standard light
by changing the
At equal
illu-
mination their intensities are proportional to the square of their distances. Thus, for instance, in the bunsen type of photometer,
as
shown diagrammatically
two white screens A. and B are illuminated, the one, A, by the light, L, which is to be tested, the other, B, by the standard S, as a calibrated or standardized 16-cp. incandescent lamp, and then either L or S or both are moved until, seen from C, the two sides A and B of the screen become equal, that is, the dividing line C between them disappears. When this is the case, L -s- S x 2 -5- y2 where x and y are the two distances of the sources from the screen. Different modifications of the bunsen photometer are most
,
of the eye to differences of illumination is not very great, usually a number of readings are taken on the
photometer, and then averaged. For testing incandescent lamps, L, as standard S, a calibrated incandescent lamp is used, operated on the same voltage supply,
so that fluctuations of light caused by minor fluctuations of supply voltage eliminate by appearing in both sources L and S.
171
For similar reasons, when testing gas lamps or other flames, L, as /S, a flame standard; as the pentane lamp, is used, so that the effect of barometric pressure, humidity of the air, etc., appears in both lamps and thereby does not appreciably affect the comparison of their light. A quick and approximate method of comparison of sources of light is given by the shadow photometer by moving an object between the two lamps until the two shadows of the
object give the same darkness. When this is the case, the illumination at the object is the same, and the intensities of the two sources are then proportional to the square of their dis-
rapidly compared, with fair accuracy, by pacing the distance from the one to
the other, and noting when the two shadows of the observer are equal in darkness.
If
then at x steps
from the one lamp, Lv the shadows are equal, and y further steps are required
to reach the second lamp,
L2
it is:
y*.
A very
convenient form
FIG. 56.
paraffine photometer. block of paraffine is cast, as shown in Kg. 56, divided by a sheet of tinfoil in the center C, and covered with tinfoil except
and B. It is advantageous to at the top and on the sides C tinfoil of sheet have the center perforated by a hole D. so that the side A is illuheld then is The block of paraffine
minated by the one lamp, L, the side B by the other lamp,
as
translucent, the entire block shown in Fig. 57. paraffine of light is seen traversing beam a then appears luminous, and
As
is
172
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
the block from the hole D, on the side which receives less light. By moving the paraffine block between the lamps L and S, until both sides of it are of the same luminosity, that is, the disappear, equality dividing line C and the beam cast by hole
of the
accuracy.
FIG. 57.
78. When comparing lamps giving light of the same color, as incandescent lamps of the same filament temperature, that is, within the same efficiency, exact comparisons can be made the limits of sensitivity of the eye for intensity differences
by the photometer by making the two sides A and B of the Bunsen photometer screen, or the two halves of the paraffine block, identical, that is, making the dividing line C disappear.
however, the color of the two lights is not the same, as, for instance, when comparing a tungsten lamp and an ordinary incandescent lamp, no position of the photometer can be found where the dividing line C between A and B (Figs. 55, 57) disappears, but a color difference always remains. To make a
If,
comparison,
it
is
therefore
sides
and
necessary for the eye to judge are of the same intensity while of
If the color difference is small, as between two different types of incandescent lamps, this can be done with fair accuracy, though obviously not as accurately as the com-
different colors.
parison of lights of identical colors. If, however, the color difference is great, as between the mercury arc and the orangeyellow carbon filament lamp, the uncertainty of equality of
the intensity of illumination becomes very great, and constant errors appear, due to the difference of the physiological effect
of different colors,
and differences
also
appear between
differ-
ent observers, so that the photometric comparison of light sources of greatly different colors is quite unreliable, and that
In such cases, frequently lights of intermediary color are used to reduce the differences in each observation. Thus the carbon filament lamp is compared with the tungsten lamp, the
173
tungsten lamp with the carbon arc lamp, and the latter with the mercury arc lamp. Hereby the uncertainty of each observation is reduced by the reduced color difference. In the final result, however, the comparison of the carbon incandescent-
lamp standard and the mercury arc lamp no advantage is gained, because the errors of the successive measurements add.
Especially
errors
is
errors,
that
is,
specific color effect, and in consequence thereof the inaccuracy of the final result is not much better than it would be by single and direct comparison.
due to the
photometer which is sometimes used for comparing lights of different color, and is based on a different principle from either of the above discussed instruments, is the flicker phoIn its simplest form it consists of a stationary disk, tometer.
illuminated
in front of
by the one lamp, and a rotating half disk or sector At slow it, which is illuminated by the other lamp.
rotation a flicker shows, which disappears if the speed becomes sufficiently high. It is obvious that the more nearly
that of the equal the effect on the eye of the two illuminations of the sector the lower is revolving stationary disk and that the speed at which the flicker disappears, and, by adjusting the distances of the two lamps so as to cause the flicker to dis-
appear at the
This
is
minimum speed,
of the effect of
the two successive illuminations on the eye. frequently considered as representing equality of the
illumination, and the instrument in this pare illuminations. There is, however,
manner used
no reason
to
comthis
why
should be the case, but, on the contrary, it is improbable. As the persistence of vision, and in general the physiological effects of different colors, are different, the flicker photometer must be expected to have a constant error which increases with color difference; that is, it does not compare lights of different color by their illuminating values, but by some other feature not
directly related thereto. 79. The photometer thus cannot satisfactorily compare lights of different colors. After all, this is obvious: the photometer compares by identity, but lights of different colors cannot be identical, and thus two such lights cannot be more broadly compared than any other two quantities of different character; that is, a green light can no more be equal to a red
174
light
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
than a piece of stone can be equal to a piece of ice. A comparison of quantities of different nature is possible only which they have regarding particular features of the quantities in common. Thus a piece of stone and a piece of ice can be In the compared regarding their weight, or their density, etc* in two or of colors different two general same manner, light, can be of different frequencies compared by any radiation, in common. have Thus, for instance, the feature which they
chemical activity, photographic plate compares them in their their the bolometer by physical energy. Light is used for seeing things by, that is, distinguishing
Regarding this feature, objects and differences between objects. the distinction of objects given by them, different colored lights can be compared, and a green light can be made equal to a red
light in illuminating value. It thus means that any
two
same distance from them, have the same intensity if, with the same distinctiveness, as, for inobjects can be seen The only method, therefore, stance, print read with equal ease. which permits comparing and measuring lights of widely different color is the method of "reading distances/ as used in the
at the
7
the theoretically correct method of comparison, as compares the lights by that propCuriously enough, the lumierty for which they are used. nometer, although it has the reputation of being crude and unscientific, thus is the only correct light-measuring instrument, and the photometer correct only in so far as it agrees with the
so-called luminometer.
It after all
it
is
luminometer, but, where luminometer and photometer disagree, the photometer is wrong, as it gives a comparison which is different from the one shown by the lights in actual use for
illumination.
The
uring light intensity, therefore, is in a way similar to the relation between spark gap and voltmeter when testing the disruptive strength of electrical apparatus: while the voltmeter is fre-
quently used, the exact measure of the disruptive strength is the spark gap and not the voltmeter, and, where the spark gap and voltmeter disagree, the voltmeter must be corrected by the spark gap. In the same manner the luminometer measures the illuminating value of the light the quality desired but
175
may
be used as far as
it
nometer.
80.
but
all
it is
The luminometer can hardly be called an instrument, merely a black box, as shown in Fig. 58, to screen off
light,
extraneous
and
The
on the print. print obviously must be black on white, that is, complete absorption and
fall
No great accuracy could be reached by merely comFIG. 58. paring the ease of reading the same kind of print with different sources of light. A high accuracy, however, is reached by using a print which does not in which letters which are not clearly jive definite words ,een cannot be guessed from the sense of the word or sentence but a jumble of letters, capitals and small letters, arranged in neaningless words. Such a luminometer chart is given below
:
Amhof
dirito amritu, Lisno ladse pemrane odo Ulay Foresca 1598720 woleb noitaidar. Ybod ergy may Pewos ex Idetnera, bsor poge Morf Tenscerophop War-
dog;
Omsk whykow efforau tespo ygnew col Brispo Monas albo darmosphor? Cottef vol Demno myo 36802 Erbtomy, quot Hiaworu pio Nio cuguab Qaphlaqua H 530 K b n q; 267 Lloysir baraka nunc, cinq x 4 zoliaq kama nambosi erianoscum. Viamara Zaraz didym fore ik yiquia Fumne.
With such a printed chart in the luminometer, the observer noves towards the light or away from it or the light is until a point is found noved, with the observer stationary it which the large letters, as the capitals, can be clearly disinguished, but the small letters are indistinguishable. This x>int can be found with great sharpness, and the accuracy of
176
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
in this
observation
manner
is
unlike nearly as great as that of the ordinary photometer, but, reliable and consistent luminometer the the photometer, gives even with widely different colors of light,
readings
The comparisons made by the luminometer of widely different colored lights by different observers agree remarkably
well,
tically the
same
in different
human
eyes.
Only occasionally a
low sensitivity for some parperson is found with abnormally a fault of the instrument, not is this ticular color obviously measured of the nature object, which is a physiologibut in the in different peisons. different be such as cal effect, and may further still can be The luminometer improved by illuminatthe one, the other half from chart of the printed ing one half then and of source moving the two sources from the other, light, on both sides of the chart letters small the that to such distances
become indistinguishable, while the capitals are distinguishable. As well known, the luminometer is largely used for measuring street illumination, as it is very simple and requires no special technical training. Such observations, where the distances are
measured by pacing, are crude, and, to get exact
results
by the
luminometer, the same care is required as when using the photometer. The limitation of the luminometer, as generally used, is that
ife
low intensity of lights at constant and relatively of differsources of The relative illumination. light intensity
compares
ent colors changes however over a wide range with the intenare compared, as discussed sity of illumination at which they III, in Lecture complete comparison of different colored
therefore requires measurements at different intensities of illumination. With a photometer, the intensity of illumination can usually
lights
be varied over a wide range by bringing the light sources nearer to the screen or removing them farther. In the luminometer, only a moderate change of the intensity of illumination, at which the comparison is made, can be produced by using different sizes of print, and the interpretation of such
tests is difficult.
wide and definite range of intensities of illumination, at which comparison of the light sources is made by the lumi-
ITT
nometer, can be secured by using gray print on white background, and lights of different colors thereby compared over a wide range of illuminations. With a luminometer chart of gray letters, of albedo a, on white background, the illumination or light flux density, at which the luminometer readings are made as described above,
is:
where i
is the illumination or light flux density when using black print on white background. 81. Since light is a physiological effect, the measurement of
which is more or less arbiSuch a unit may be a unit of light, that is, of
a flame, or
is,
it
may
be a unit
of-
area.
Thus, a fairly rational unit of light-flux density or illumination would be the illumination required at the limits of distinguishability of black print of a specified type, on white background, that is, the light flux per unit area by which, with such black print on white background, the capitals and large letters can still be distinguished, while the small letters are indistinguishable.
proximately 20 cp.) This unit has never been introduced, partly due to the difficulty of producing it, partly due to the unsuitability of platinum for this purpose: platinum gives
gray-body radiation, therefore any impurity, as a trace of carbonized dust, may increase the light. Candles have been largely used for standards, as the name of the unit implies, made and burned under definite specifications. As individual candles vary widely in their light, the use of the
candle as standard necessarily is very crude and inaccurate, and thus unsatisfactory. The only primary standard which has found extensive and international use is the amyl-acetate lamp of Hefner. This is
a definite
178
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
height of flame and definite conditions regarding air pressure and humidity. This Hefner lamp, or German candle, equals about 90 per cent of the British candle and equals 90 per cent of
the international candle.
Amyl
it
can easily be produced in chemical purity, and gives a good luminous flame. The flame, however, is somewhat reddish, thus markedly different from the color of the carbon incandescent lamp, and departs still much more from that of the tungsten lamp. Instead of amyl acetate, pentane has been used and is It gives a somewhat whiter flame, but the pentane still used. not as constant. is lamp However, the Hefner lamp, while universally used as primary standard, is altogether too inconvenient for general photometric use, and, for this purpose, usually incandescent lamps are employed which have been compared with, and standardIn reality, from these standard ized by, the Hefner lamp. incandescent lamps, by comparison, other incandescent lamps have been standardized, and so on, until of late years the Hefner lamp has been finally abandoned as primary standard of light, and we have no primary standard; but the standard of light is maintained by comparison with incandescent lamps kept for this purpose; that is, it is maintained by duplication of
samples, and by international agreement an incandescent lamp " unit has been adopted as the standard or international candle." 82. number of primary standards have lately been pro-
much
oxygen. It has a very suitable white color, but its intensity is very sensitive to slight impurities of the acetylene, and such impurities, as hydrogen, are difficult to avoid. A suitable unit appears to be the normal temperature radiation at specified temperature, and the temperature could be defined by the ratio of the radiation power of definite wave lengths. Thus, such a unit would be an incandescent lamp, radiating x watts at such temperature that the power radiated between wave
and 55 bears to the power radiated between wave 60 to 70 the ratio y. The radiated power x could problengths be determined from electric power input and losses. Such ably a unit would probably be replaceable with considerable exactness, but would still be arbitrary.
lengths 45
179
temperature
of radiation
be the light given by one watt normal by temperature radiation at a definite the latter specified and measured by the ratio
Such
fied
power of two different ranges of wave length. would base the physiological effect, under speciconditions of temperature, on the unit of power, or the
definition
watt, as unit of light. Its disadvantage is the difficulty of measuring the power of the total visible radiation, since at the ends of the visible spectrum the power is high and the physiological effect low,
and a small error in the limits of the spectrum would make a considerable error in the result. More satisfactory, therefore, appeals the derivation of a
primary standard of light by combining three primary colors of light in definite power proportions. Thus, choosing three lines in the mercury arc in a vacuum, of the mercury spectrum steadiness and perfect high intensity can easily be produced in the red, green and blue, about equidistant from each other, these three radiations would be combined in definite proportions chosen so as to give the desired color of the light, and in such quantities as to probably a yellowish white one total watt radiation, or, if as unit the illumination give is used, to give one microwatt per sq. cm.; that is, the standard of illumination would be the illumination produced by one microwatt of radiation power, composed of the three wave lengths of the three chosen mercury lines, in definite
proportions.
Such a standard, derived by combination of definite wave lengths, which are easily reproducible, appears the most satisfactory in regard to permanence. It would incidentally give a numerical expression to color values, as any color then would
be represented by the numerical ratio of the power of the three standard spectrum radiations, which, mixed together, give the
color.*
83.
Light
is
The
the flux of light issuing from the illuminant. The important characteristic of the illuminant, by which it is judged, thus is the total flux of light
issuing
"
from
it,
and
its
photometry.
* Proc. A.
E.
K,
(1908).
180
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
or luminometer, however, gives the light in one direction only. Thus, to measure the total intensity flux of light, the light intensity in all directions in space
The photometer
to
get the
spherical
"mean
all directions,
one
single photometric observation would give it, and therefrom, by multiplying with 4 *, the total flux of light would be obtained.
This, probably,
is
Many illuminants, however, give a symmetrical distribution of light around an axis, so that the distribution curve is the same in all meridians. This is practically the case with the ordinary incandescent lamp with oval filament, and also with the tantalum and the tungsten lamp. Thus if the curve, shown in Fig. 59, is the distribution curve in one meridian, it is the same
FIG. 59.
in every other meridian, and for photometric test of the illuminant it is sufficient to measure the light intensities in one merid-
ian only, for instance, from 10 to 10 degrees. To get herefrom the mean or average intensity, it would obviously be wrong tp merely average all the intensities under equal angles, since the a zone of 10 deequatorial intensity covers a far greater area
and 2 n circumference than the intensity of latitude from the horizontal: the latter that is, under angle covers a zone of 10 degrees width and 2 n cos circumference, and the polar intensity covers only a point. To get the total flux of light, the intensity under each angle
grees width
<f>,
<j>
<f>
<f>
181
to be multiplied with the area of the zone which it xd cos $, where d is the angular width of the zone 2 covers, for instance), and then added. The average or mean (10 deg., spherical intensity then is derived herefrom by dividing with the surface of the sphere, or by 4 ?r. Thus, to get the mean spherical intensity from the distribution curve, the instantaneous values of intensity, taken under equal angles S are multiplied each by cos $, then added, and
}
the
sum
d,
is
is,
= rr^*
This usually
done graphically.
Occasionally, as in incandescent lamps with single-loop filament, the light intensity is not the same in all meridians, but a maximum in two opposite meridians at right angles to the plane of the filament; and a Tnmimmri in the two meridians at right
:
FIG. 60.
of light intensity about as shown in Fig. 60. In this case the horizontal distribution curve may also be determined photometrically, averaged so as to give the
mean
horizontal intensity
182
and the
RADIATION, LIGHT,
ratio of the
AND ILLUMINATION.
horizontal intensity to the maximum horizontal intensity (or any other definite horizontal intensity); and the mean spherical intensity, as derived from the
mean
(or any other definite this ratio to get the with horizontal intensity), is multiplied in this case measurereal mean spherical intensity. Usually but in one ments are taken only meridian, during the test the sufficient speed, so axis with vertical lamp rotated around its under in the that each observation meridian, angle <j>, in reality in the direction is the mean intensity Thus, in incandes<f>.
meridian of
cent lamp tests, usually the lamp between the different meridians.
is
revolved, so as to average
is
As the
the same,
within the error of photometric test, for all incandescent lamps of the same type of filament, usually the distribution curve of one meridian is measured once for all, therefrom the ratio of
mean spherical candle power, the so-called spherical reduction factor, determined, and then in further photometric tests of lamps of this type only the horizontal intensity meashorizontal to
ured, and from this, dividing
factor,
the mean spherical intensity is derived. Thus, while with the incandescent lamp the intensity varies in each meridian, and is different in the different meridians, the mean spherical intensity nevertheless is derived by a single photometric observation of the horizontal intensity with rotating lamp: the rotation averages between the different meridians, and the spherical reduction factor translates from horizontal to mean spherical intensity. Reduction factors of incandescent lamps usually are between 0.75
and
Far more difficult is the matter with arc lamps in the ordicarbon arc lamp, the intensity also varies in the meridian, nary and is different in the different meridians, but not with the
84.
same regularity as in the incandescent lamp, and, furthermore, the intensity distribution between the different meridians, as well as, to a lesser extent, the total light flux of the lamp, varies with the time. The arc is not steady and constant in position, as the incandescent filament, but wanders, and the light intensities on the side of the lamp, where the arc happens to be, thus are greater than on the side away from the arc. The meridians of maximum and of minimum intensity,
183
however, do not remain constant in position, but continuously change with the wandering of the arc. Therefore, by measurements in a single meridian, the distribution curve of maximum and that of minimum intensity can be determined by waiting during the observation for the arc to come around to the side of the observer maximum and go to the opposite side minimum intensity. Such curves are shown in Fig. 61.
FIG. 61.
This, however, carried out for every angle in the meridian, makes arc-light photometry rather laborious, especially as
the total intensity pulsates with the time, and therefore a considerable number of readings have to be taken in every
position.
Therefore, for are light photometry, integrating photometers are especially desirable, that is, photometers which, by a single observation, determine spherical intensity; that
less accurately the mean the average intensity, in all directions. With such an integrating photometer, by taking a number of successive readings and averaging, so as to eliminate the variation of total intensity with the time, the mean spherical intensity, and thus the total flux of light, can be derived more
more or
is,
rapidly.
is
It consists of a circle of inclined mirrors, which surround the or, rather, a certain number lamp and reflect the light in all
of different angles into the photometer, and there the different reflected beams are by absorption reduced in the proportion
184
of cos
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
combined on the photometer screen. Obviously, <f> and the Matthews photometer does not average the intensity in all directions, but only in two meridians opposite to each other;
however, by averaging a number of successive readings, very accurate results can be derived. A method of averaging in all directions is based on a similar from the interior of a principle as that by which the radiation found to be blackwas constant of closed sphere temperature in the is if located center of a closed the lamp body radiation:
sphere (perforated only at the place where the photometer enters) of perfectly white reflecting surface, then the light intensity throughout the entire inner surface of the sphere is
uniform, and is the mean spherical intensity of illumination at the distance of the radius of the sphere. The reason is every element of the interior of the sphere receives light directly from
:
the lamp, and also light reflected from all the other elements of the sphere, so that the total light received at every element of the sphere is the same, hence is the average illumination.
By
lamp
in the center of
such a photometric
sphere of sufficient size, its mean spherical intensity thus can be determined by a single reading. Such an arrangement has the further advantage that it allows a direct measurement of mean
of such illuminants as the or light flux spherical intensity mercury lamp, in which the radiator is of such extent that it
going to excessive
the
mean
Photometrically, and in illuminating engineering, only which represents the total flux spherical intensity
which represents the of light and the distribution curve are of importance. The distribution of this light in space
" "horizontal intensity has been used as a conventional rating of incandescent lamps, but is merely fictitious, as it does not
actual average horizontal intensity, but the horizontal intensity which the light flux of the lamp would give with the standard mean spherical reduction factor, if the filament had
mean an
the standard shape. Downward candle power and maximum candle power obviously have no meaning regarding the light flux of the lamp, but merely represent a particular feature of the distribution
curve.
185
Hemispherical candle power is used to some extent, especially abroad. It is a mixture between light flux and distribution
curve,
on
it
gives no information on the total light flux, nor the actual distribution curve, and may mislead to attribute
it
and as
to the
flux
than
it
possesses
it
with mean spherical candle power ence, and should not be used.
LECTURE
.
X.
86.
The
an iUuminant
is
its
total radiation
is
power, in physiological measure. It therefore output of the illuminant, and the efficiency of
thus
is
the useful
an illuminant
input.
In general, the distribution of the light flux throughout space not uniform, but the light-flux density is different in different directions from an illuminant. Unit light-flux density is the light-flux density which gives the physiological effect of one candle at unit distance. The
is
unit of light flux, or the lumen, is the light flux passing through unit surface at unit light-flux density. The unit of light intensity, or one candle, thus gives, if the light-flux distribution is uniform in all directions, unit flux density at unit distance from
the radiator, and thus gives a total flux of light of 4 TT units, or TT lumens (since the area at unit distance from a point is the surface of a sphere, or 4 TT).
The unit of light intensity, or one candle power, thus gives, with a radiator of uniform light-flux distribution, 4 TT lumens of light flux, and inversely, a radiator which gives 4 n lumens of light flux, gives an intensity of one candle, if the intensity is uniform in all directions, and, if the distribution of the intensity is not uniform, the average or mean spherical intensity of the radiator is one candle. Thus one mean spherical candle represents 4 TT lumens of light flux, and very frequently the mean spherical candle is used as representing the light flux: the light flux is 4 n times the mean spherical intensity, and the mean spherical intensity is the total light flux divided by 4 TT, regardless whether the light flux is uniformly distributed or not. The total light flux of an illuminant is derived by the summation or integration of the intensities, that is, the flux densities at unit distance, in all directions from the radiator.
186
187
distribution of light flux or of intensity is never uniform, of intensity distribution of the light flux
distribution of the light intensity of an illuminant depends upon the shape of the radiator and upon the objects surrounding it; that is, the distribution of the light flux issuing
is
The
from the radiator depends on the shape of the radiator, but more or less modified by shadows cast by surrounding
objects,
by
refraction,
diffraction,
diffusion in
surrounding
objects, etc.
is, the cylinder, the circular line or circular and thereof. combinations cylinder 87. Very frequently the intensity distribution of an illumi-'
symmetrical, or approximately symmetrical, around an This, for instance, is the case with the arc lamp, the incandescent lamp, most flames, etc. If the distribution is perfectly symmetrical around an axis, the distribution in space is characterized by that in one meridian, that is, one plane pass-
nant
axis.
is
ing through the axis. If the distribution is not symmetrical around the axis, usually the space distribution is characterized by the distribution curves in two meridians at right angles to
each other, the meridian of maximum and that of minimum intensity, and the distribution in the equatorial plane, that is, the plane at right angles to the axis.
Distribution curves are best represented in polar coordinates, and the angle <f> counted from the axis towards the equator
(that
is,
" complementary to the latitude" in geography). As most illuminants are used with their symmetry axis in vertical direction, and the downward light is usually of greater
importance, it is convenient in plotting distribution curves to choose the symmetry axis as vertical, and count the angle <j> from the downward vertical towards the horizontal; that is, the downward beam would be given by <j> = 0, the horizontal beam by ^ = 90 deg., and the upward beam by <f> = 180 deg.
representation of the light-flux distribution in polar coordinates does not give a fair representation of the total light flux, or the mean spherical intensity of the light source,
The usual
is
very misleading.
When comit
is
188
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
however,
that
is,
the area of the curve as impossible to avoid the impression of area of the polar curve, The flux. the of light representative has no direct relation whatever to the total light flux,
to the output of the illuminant, since the area depends flux directly upon upon the square of the radii, and the light of twice the intenilluminant an Thus curve. the radii of the
sity,
but the same flux distribution, times the area, and the latter gives of light far more than twice as great The meridian curves of intensity
misleading: the
different angles
distribution are
still
more
to
horizontal intensity very different amounts of light flux: the 2 of zone a circumference, while the 90 deg.) covers (< sin $ a zone of 2 covers direction other <f> intensity in any
the smaller, the nearer circumference; that is, terminal the intensity, upward or down^ is to or 180 deg.; that is, gives no light flux. ward, finally covers a point only, illuminant As the result hereof, an giving maximum intensity low and in the downward direction, intensity in the horizontal, the of area a much polar curve than an illuminant
an area which
is
greater total light flux which has its horizontal. the in maximum intensity Comparing, therefore, distribution curves, it is practically illuminants of different the area of the polar curve, and impossible not to be misled by illuminant thus to overestimate the having maximum downward illuminant the having maximum intensity, and underestimate
gives of the
larger
same or even a
horizontal intensity.
light flux;
of the polar curves of intensity distribution in the meridian is illustrated by the curves in Figs. 64 and 99: the three curves of Fig. 64 give the same total that is, the same useful output; but 2 looks vastly
looks very small. Curves greater than 1 or 3, and 3 especially total light flux, and curve same the I, II, III, IV in Fig. 99 give To the eye, however, the flux. the light gives only one tenth more far a of powerful illuminant curve I gives the impression than the curve IV, and curve appears practically equal to, if not than IV, while in reality it represents only one tenth the
larger
light
88.
is
output of IV. In an illuminant in which the distribution of intensity symmetrical around an axis, and thus can be represented
189
calculated thus :
/
<
intensity at angle
<j>
dA
and the
is:
2 ^ sin
ef>d(j>,
2x
hence, the total light flux:
(1)
(2)
to the angle
is
The light flux in the space from the downward direction = = ^ against the vertical or symmetry axis, then
<j>
<
(3)
and the
light flux in
^ and
<f>2
is
(4)
I.
(1)
Point, or Sphere, of
In this
and thus,
if
(5)
or, inversely:
(6)
The brilliancy
face.
of a radiator is the light-flux density at its surThus, with a luminous point of intensity 7, the brilliancy
190
would be
RADIATION, LIGHT,
infinite;
AND ILLUMINATION.
with a luminous sphere of uniform intensity distribution, and of radius r, the brilliancy is
V
.
I*
(7)
the luminous spot in the lime cylinder of the lime light (hydro-oxygen flame),
etc.
horizontal
is
direction,
the
intensity
symmetrical around the vertical, the vertical direction thus can be chosen as axis, and the angle <f> counted from the vertical upward. The intensity is a maximum 7 , verdistribution
FlG 63
-
tically
downward,
for
<f>
0.
In any other direction, under angle $ against the vertical (Kg. 63), the intensity is
/
J cos <,
(8)
and
is
zero for
The
(3):
<
is,
by
* * = 2* i
*/o
Ism<f>d<f>;
hence,
by
(8)
TT/O /
sin
<
cos
t/O
(9)
191
is
:
from
=
<j>
to
<j>
90 deg. = ^, thus Jj
*=
or,
*/
(10)
$ '.-The brilliancy of the source of light divided by the luminous area; or,
is
(ii)
B
and,
if
"T
^r
2
,
A=
and
B- * -^ ^~""
or,
/.
= HB;
(1).
(13)
that
is,
the
same
as in class
Comparing (10) with (5), it thus follows that the total light flux of such a radiator, for the same maximum intensity, is only one quarter that of a radiator giving uniform intensity distribution
throughout space, or inversely, with such a downward distribution of light, the maximum intensity is four times as great as it would be with the same total light flux uniformly distributed through
space.
The
flux distribution
is
circle
having
its
source of light downward. It is shown as 2 in Fig. 64, and the concentric circle giving uniform intensity distribution of the same total light flux is shown as 1.
(3)
for instance, is approximately the crater of the of the arc lamp. carbon positive As with such a radiator, as shown in section in Pig. 65, the is the same projection of the luminous area in any direction
Such a radiator,
<
192
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
FIG. 64.
FIG. 05.
FIG. 66.
193
same equations
apply.
(4)
Such, for instance, is approximately the incandescent carbon tip of the arc-lamp electrodes, when using carbons of sufficiently small size, so that the entire tip becomes heated. Assuming, in Fig. 66, the radiator as a segment of a sphere, and the angle subtending this segment, r the radius of this let 2 a)
sphere.
For
all
directions <,
up
to the angle
a>
o<
<j>
<-*>;
the projection of the spherical segment in Fig. 66 is the same as that of a plane circle, and thus the intensity is given in class (1),
as:
=
co
IQ cos
<f>.
In
the
direction,
2i
<
<f>
< -,
2t
is
greater, by the amount of light radiated by the projection Dyx, and, in the horizontal direction, the intensity does not vanish,
but corresponds to the horizontal projection of the luminous segment. Above the horizontal, light still issues in the direction,
7T
+ &<
<f>
is
is
fj (1
cos cos
sin
(o
ra (1
194
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION,
is
Aj
2 rjw
2 r<?x
(1
cos
2
fc>
**)
sin
2r22
.
/r
X
, cu
2 sin 2
2
sin-
cos
w -
= '&COS
2
^
2
(14)
Thus,
if
is
class (2), it
must be:
or,
and,
if
the brilliancy
B is
maximum
intensity for
A = Ois
2
cos
5; ^
(16)
that
is,
the rounding
off of
liancy
intensity I
-,
2i
& below
to
^ above
In Fig. 67 are plotted the distribution curves, for the same brilliancy and the same area of the radiator, for a plane circular radiator, as 1; a rounded circular radiator of angle a) = 30 deg. 'as 2, and a rounded circular radiator of angle w 60 deg.,
195
more
seen, with increasing rounding, gradually more and into the horizontal light flux is shifted from the vertical
As
direction.
FIG. 67.
Such radiators are represented approximately by the luminous arcs with vertical electrodes, by the mercury-arc tube,
90.
The
tion
is
intensity distribu-
symmetrical with
imum
to
7 at right angles
radiator,
FIQ
the
or
<
in
the intensity
is,
Fig. 68,
(17)
vertical.
J-/ sm&
and
is
zero for
<
and
<f>
196
RADIATION, LIGHT,
light flux within angle
<
AND ILLUMINATION.
from the vertical
is,
The
by
(4),
7r7
f
*^o
sin
(18)
and the
?r
is
* =
or, inversely:
*V.;
(19)
*
is
A where
Z
*toZ,
(21)
is
the length;
The
bril-
liancy, therefore, is
-'
/
(22)
=
7T
(23)
may be
Most
called the
Zmear
maximum
intensity } or,
maximum inten-
of the light of a linear vertical radiator issues near the Puthorizontal, very little in downward and upward direction.
ting
$* =
it
= 66 deg.; that is, half the and herefrom, by approximation, light flux issues within the narrow zone from 24 deg. below to
<f>
197
a' in
Fig. 68.
It
is
on the
interesting to compare the three radiators, (1), (2), and (5), basis of equal maximum intensity, and on the basis of
Uniform.
Circle.
maximun
4 xIQ 4
<E>
...............
at equal
TT/O
2
?r
TT= 3.14
Maximum
light
intensity 7
$
~n
$
H?
flux* ...............
T^
1
-=
7T
1.27
As
is,
nearly as
same maximum intensity, the cylinder gives light flux as given by uniform distribution, that its deficiency in intensity in the polar regions represents very
seen, at the
much
flux. The circular plane, however, gives only one quarter as much light flux as uniform distribution. With the same horizontal intensity of a cylindrical radiator, as the vertical intensity of a circular plane, the former gives
little light
TT
In Kg. 64 the three distribution curves are shown for the same total flux of light: curve 1 for uniform intensity, 2 for a plane circle, and 3 for a straight cylinder as radiator. (6) Circular Line or Cylinder. In the spirals, loops or ovals of incandescent-lamp filaments, circular radiators, or sections.thereof , are met. Let r = radius of the circular radiator,
w =
in section in Fig. 69. intensity is a maximum in the direction at right angle to the plane of the circle/
cylinder,
shown
The
FlG 69
-
The
intensity,
projection of the radiator in this direction of = 0, has the length: 2 TTT; and if, by (24) <f>
maximum
:
maximum
linear intensity,
198
where
it is,
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
'= 2rwB.
B =
brilliancy,
(25)
This is in the direction in which the projection of the radiator is a circle of radius r, and thus circumference 2 TV. In any other direction <, the projection of the radiator is an as half axes, as seen from Fig. 69. ellipse, with r and r cos If Z = the circumference of this ellipse, the intensity in the direction $ bears to the maximum intensity 7 the same ratio as
<
is,
=
an
^r=a
(26)
The circumference
I
of
(1
ellipse
is
(a
c)
j),
<
27)
c/
The
maximum
Fig. 70,
diameter,
y=,
2i
is
given in Table
I,
and plotted in
with the ratio of the half axes, that as abscissas. Fig. 71, with angle
<f>
is,
TABLE
I.
CIRCUMFERENCE OF ELLIPSE.
199
FIG. 70.
FIG. 71.
In Fig. 72 is plotted the intensity distribution in the meridian of such a circular radiator. This shows a maximum J in the
vertical,
and a minimum 1^
2
IQ
7t
in the horizontal.
Theoretically,
horizontal,
$ =
of
the
half.
lamp
filaments,
is
so small
com-
pared with r, that it is practically impossible to have the radiator perfectly in one plane, as would be
required for one half to shade the other half.
(7)
FIG. 72.
Single-Loop Filament.
200
92.
RADIATION, LIGHT,
As an
AND ILLUMINATION.
of different typical forms of radiators, the distribution curves of a single-loop incandescent-lamp filament may be calculated.
sides, joined
by a
half
The
distribution of in-
Z in
Fig. 73.
The meridian
of maxi-
where
r,
impossible to produce and maintain such a filament we assume, as average deviation of the two of Fig. 73 from the vertical, an angle of and sides straight 10 deg.
it is
As
The intensity distribution of the straight sides A and B in any meridian plane thus is that of a straight radiator, (5), at an angle of 10 deg. against the vertical. ' Let 7 = maximum intensity per unit length. Then the
N
-4,
+B is
sin
4 r/
{sin
(<f>
+ 10) +
(<f>
10) }
(28)
the light
201
(6);
by a
r,
that
is,
U 4 - f>
where
Figs.
I is
(29)
circle of radius r,
the circumference of the ellipse which projects the under angle <, and is given by Table I and
70 and 71*
FIG. 74.
intensity, the light intensity 7a the of half circle in its own plane, the projection produced by under angle <f>, is added to the intensity 7r This projection is,
In the meridian of
minimum
by
Fig. 73,
c
=
-
r (1
cos 0),
(30)
and thus
c7/ r/; (1
cos 0).
(31)
In the equatorial plane, the intensity, due to the straight sides A + B, is constant, and is that of a straight radiator under angle 10 deg. from the direction of maximum intensity; hence is
7
(32)
circle of
To
7
this is
r,
radius
that
7X
4-
72
72 hence, in the meridian of maximum intensity, Curve 1 of Fig. 74; in the meridian of minimum
202
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
and
in the equator,
intensity, /
7t
+ ! Curve 3 of Fig. 74. In Table II are recorded the intensity distribution of the (8) discussed in the preceding paragraphs. radiators different
/
TABLE
II.
II.
SHADOWS.
radiator of an illuminant can rarely be arranged so that no opaque bodies exist in its field of light flux and obstruct some light, that is, cast shadows. As the result of shadows, the
93.
The
distribution of intensity of the illuminant differs more or less from that of its radiator, and the total light flux is less.
the round shadow symmetrical with the axis of the radiator, that is, the shadow of a circular plane concentric with and at right angles to the symmetry axis of the illuminant. Such for instance are, approximately, the shadows cast by the base of the incandescent lamp,
of
shadow
is
by the top
Such
shadows
.of
203
the electrodes in the arc lamp in that most common case where the electrodes are in line with each other. As an example may be considered the effect of a symmetrical
circular
circular plane
(1)
with a
Shadow
Circular Plane Opposite to Circular Plane of Radiator. of negative carbon in front of the positive carbon
let
In Fig. 75,
2r
the
plane,
which casts a
shadow (negative carbon of the arc lamp); and I the distance between the two.
Assume
as
the
maximum
the light
AOB
FIG. 75.
in
downward
direction,
hence com-
pletely or partly intercepted by the circle AflJS^). Then, the intensity of the light flux from the radiator, in any direction $, is, according to reasoning under heading I, class (2),
7 cos
<f>.
(1)
In this direction <, the circle A l B l projects on the plane AB AJ3 2 with radius r1? and the center 2 of this circle has from the center of the radiator the distance
as a circle
,
a
If
= 002 =
2
tan
<f>.
(2)
now
flux in the direction <f> thus reduced from that of the complete radiator surface, Trr 2 , to that of the radiator surface minus the shaded part'/S, that is, 2 Trr S, or in the proportion
the area
of overlap,
overlaps with the radiator circle Fig. 76, is cut out from
2
7r
-S
3
=1
,
8
i 2
(3)
204
RADIATION, LIGHT,
'
AND ILLUMINATION.
ctio light flux, in the direction
<f>,
/
a,
cos <.
circles
(4 (4)
the distance,
between the
and
is
greater than
2
the
r v the circles of radii, I tan <j> > r is cast. no shadow in direction that and overlap,
sum
and
do not
The
is
reduced by the shadow of the lower which are smaller than the angle <f>
.
&
<
is
-p,
and the shadow 2 thus covers the entire radiator 0, no light but the radiator is completely shaded. This can occur only if r^>r, and if this is the case, a circular area below the radiator receives no light. If rx = r, the intensity becomes zero only in the direction = 0; and if r t < r, the light in the downward direction is merely reduced, but nowhere completely extinguished. The shaded area of the radiator consists of two segments, of the respective radii r and rl S = D + D r = angle Let 2 a) = angle subtending segment D and 2 D and the width of the subtending segment v denoting segments
issues,
<f>
:
thus
w
w^
AC,
R,
is
p = AB2
w + wr
(7)
From
Fig. 76,
= 00 2 = OA + J~02 - AB2 - r + r, - p;
p =
r
or,
rl
rx
a;
hence, by
(2),
tan
<j>.
(8)
205
In
A 0^0,
sin MI __ r
sin
^
x
TJ
?"
.
sin
w = - sin
(9)
and
cos
=
1-^ r
r (1
(10)
cos
(H)
(12)
hence,
FIG. 76.
FIG. 77.
Furthermore,
D=
Sector
OEAF - AJEO.F.
sin 2
6;
sin 2
(13)
sin
2
(14)
S =D +
and, by
(3),
Dy
(15)
(16)
For
different values of
the
values of
are calculated from equations
206
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
equation (8) then follows, for every value of <f>, the corand by (4) the responding value of p, herefrom the value of q value of J.
From
94.
0>9
the values of
ratio of radii:
^-
u
-
tion equal to 4 times, 1 times, and 0.5 times the section of the
radiator.
in Fig. 78.
TABLE
III.
If
~<
1,
area only up to the values of p, where w value, at least in the application to the
shadow
by the
207
negative carbon of the arc lamp, the shaded area is not merely the circle O/, but also the area shown shaded in Fig. 77, which is shaded by the shadow cast by the sides of the lower
electrode.
From the value p', which corresponds to wl = rv the area S then increases by 2^ (p-pOj hence, if S'*= shaded area for p = jf, for any value of p>pv
07) ' V
This
is shown in Table III and in Fig. 78 as curve IV. Such curves of intensity of a plane circular radiator of radius shaded by a concentric circular shade of radius rx at distance Z
r,
[corresponding to a diameter of positive carbon 2 r, of negative carbon 2 rv and an arc length Z], are given in Figs. 79 to 82, and the numerical values given in Table IV.
Fig. 79 gives the curves for
=
T
2,
lengths,
=
&T
in, IV.
curves for
as curves
1,
lengths,
I, II, III,
0.7,
IV.
for
2r
.,
As seen from
tion,
a larger shade at greater distance, Z, light flux and a similar distribubut gives a much sharper edge of the shadow, while a smaller
Fig. 82,
same
208
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
FIG. 81.
FIG. 82.
209
210
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION,
shade at shorter distance, III, gives a far broader half shadow, which extends even to the vertical direction. This is illustrated by the distribution of the open arc and the that is, without means of diffracenclosed arc in clear globes arc the distance between the enclosed tion or diffusion. In the
r electrodes,
Z,
is
made larger,
is
greater.
is
due to the smaller current the diameter of the radiator, 2 r, smaller than in the open arc. The enclosed arc has a much sharper edge of the shadow, that is, narrower half shadow, than
as
the open arc, thus requiring means of diffusion of the light even more than the open arc.
as have been discussed under headings I, class (4). This is frequently the case where the shadow is cast by the electrodes of an
arc,
electrode
arc, in
is
more or
the
by combustion.
(2)
Plane
is
Concentric
with
End
of
Linear
Radiator.
95.
This condition
lower electrode, I = length of the linear radiator, and 2 w the diameter of the radiator. Neglecting first the diameter 2 w of the radiator, the part of the radiator which, in the
direction <,
is
approximately realized by the shadows with vertical electrodes. = diameter of the in Let, Fig. 83, 2 rA
shaded,
s
is
r t cot
<j>,
(18)
G 83
'
ratio,
'
and the reduction factor of the light, or the by which the intensity of light flux of
I,
class
(5)),
1
b
7
c *
&
(2
211
thus
is
/=
qla sin
<f>
y cot
<fn
sin
(sin
-1 cos
(21)
For values of
<f>
less
than $ lf where.
tan
,
(22)
if
is,
there
were no
diffusion, etc.
If we now consider the diameter, 2 w, of the radiator, the same distribution of intensity, except in the angle
we
get
where $/ and $/
tan </
is
given by
and
tan
I
In
has at
narrow angle the light flux fades from the value which it and which is the same as given by equation (21) : to at $/, while, when neglecting 2w, the intensity would become zero at by equations (22) and (21). As illustrations are plotted in Fig, 84 and recorded in Table IV,
this
ff
<f>
FIG. 84.
212
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
=0.25; 0.5;
1; 2, as curves I,
IV, corresponding to
to i,
and
REFLECTION.
96. As rarely the distribution of intensity and the brilliancy of the radiator are such as desired, reflection, diffraction, and diffusion are used to a considerable extent to modify the distribubrilliancy of the radiator. In irregular be irregular or regular reflection. may on the reflector is thrown back the light impinging reflection, while in reflection the in all directions, regular light irregularly
tion curve
and the
Reflection
is reflecteid
reflector.
The former
under the same angle under which it impinges on the is illustrated by a piece of chalk or other
by the
mirror.
A. Irregular Reflection. Irregular reflection is used in indirect lighting to secure diffusion and low intrinsic brilliancy of the light source by throwing the direct light against the ceiling and illuminating by the In some light reflected from white or light colored ceilings. luminous arcs, the so-called flame carbon are lamps, irregular reflection is used to direct most of the light downward by usually hollow immediately using a small circular reflector In this case the so-called "economizer." the the above arc, smoke produced by the arc largely deposits on the reflector and thereby maintains it of dull white color, the deposit of most flame carbons being calcium fluoride and oxide and thus white. In irregular reflection, the reflector is a secondary radiator; that is, if $ t = that part of the flux of light of the main radiator which is intercepted by the reflector, and a = albedo of the reflector (that is, the ratio of reflected fr j [^
light to
impinging
light, or
the "ef-
ficiency of the reflector"), the radiator is a generator of the light flux a<fr r
As an example may be
FlG 85
-
discussed
(irregular) reflector
Kg.
85.
Let 2
co
by the
213
the base of the arc, I the (vertical) length of the arc. The radius of the reflector then is r = I tan <w, and the light flux intercepted by the reflector is calculated in the manner as discussed under heading II, Class (2) ; that
is,
if
is
the
maximum
or horizontal intensity of the arc L, the intensity in the direction (180 deg. 0) will be
7 sin<.
(1)
The
reflector
the radiator
the light
then intercepts the entire light flux issuing from between 180 deg. and 180 ^, and the part q of <o and 90 deg., which is flux issuing between 180
given
by
q
r, -I
-^-n
cot (180
L
<)
=
is
tan
co
cot
<j>;
(2)
intercepted
by the
reflec-
= =
(3)
and the
in this angle,
7T
<
<f><
(180
&>), is
^o
(1
2) ^o sin
<f>
<
/o (sin
tan
& cos
<j>).
(4)
Therefore the light flux intercepted by the reflector within the = & (or rather, <j> = 180 deg. to <f> = 180 w) is to angle <f> =
*/-
<
=
3
ct>
to
<f>
is
2
7r/
g sin
cty
tan
o>
7r/
tan
/I f
-+
5
cos
<^
sin
<f>
d<f>
cos 2 *A
1
>^,
(5)
214
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
by the
reflector
and the
as secondary radiator,
where a
=
is
albedo.
reflector is
As the
intensity
a plane circular radiator, its maximui in the downward direction, and is given under heac
as
ing
I, class (2),
$ "=^/
7T
a*,,
fr
"
cos
<
aa> cos
The
reflect<
c
<
<
<
-? is
7
JT
4-
ff
IQ (sin
<f>
-4-
aw
cos
<f>) 5
(!
and
in the
only under
tl
angle
<
<j>
<
n
/
s=
a>,
and
is
(sin
<j>
tan
to
cos
<
FIG. 86.
For
is
<y
75deg. =
and a
0.7,
The
distributee
215
gives
J (sin
<j>
and in
(10) gives
(sin
<f>
TABLE
V.
B. Regular Reflection.
by a polished reflector or mirror forms of luminous arcs, the reflector some is represented by a second radiator, which has the same shape as the main radiator and is its image with regard to the plane of the reflector. If a is the albedo of the radiator and J the maximum
97.
With
regular reflection
216
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
maximum
intensity of the
The reflector then cuts out of the light flux of the radiator that part intercepted by it, and adds to the light flux that part of the (virtual) light flux of the secondary radiator which passes through the plane of the reflector. As example may be considered the intensity distribution of a
vertical
Z,
shaped
top of the arc. Let wl be the angle subtended by the inner, 6> the angle subtended by the outer edge of the reflector, from 2
the base of the arc, as diagrammatically illustrated in Fig. 87; then the intensity of the light flux of the main radiator
for
is
7
for
7 sin
<f>,
and
is
(11)
(12)
(2),
where, by
henee,
tan
<o
cot
<f>,
(13)
Ii
= ^
7
7 (sin
<$>
tan
ut cos
$),
(14)
and
is
zero for
(n
(t)~*
All the light flux issuing from the main radiator between the upper vertical and the angle a>t (0 < <f> < wj 1' - / sin (15)
(f>
is
reflector.
217
co
vertical,
the part
<w
<
<f>
<
-^
Q
I,
is
- qJ
sin
<
(16)
reflector.
by
(13),
qt
it is
:
=
"-=
tan
o) t
cot
<j>,
(17) (18)
7X
^i
7 tan
77
w
*
cos <,
for
*p
~*
and the
(19)
angle
a>
7'= 7
is
sin
&
reflector, with the exception of that part which hole in the reflector. the passes through
received
by the
a>
7 tan
o)2
cos
<j>,
(20)
is
received
of that part
which
The total light flux intensity reflected by the reflector, or the useful light flux of the virtual or secondary radiator, thus is, if a albedo of the reflector,
Within the angle ~><f> 2
>
o>
vertical,
T=
r
(72
o>
2
7t )
=
l
a7 (tan
tan
a> t )
cos <;
(21)
><j>
>w
-
vertical,
<f>
(I'
0,
7t )
(sin ^ .
/>)
tan
^ cos #)
(22)
and
for
>
>
pw .
(//
0;
(23)
218
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
of vertical hence, the light intensity of the illuminant, consisting for mirror reflector, radiator and ring-shaped
0<C 9^"^ ^t
is
I=/ sin&
for
(24)
&i<
2~~
j/_j_
<f>< 4>2*s
]9H =
(1
tt)
sin
IT
<j>
CL
tan
fo
cos
<f>) } \
(25
for
a (tan
tan
^)
cos
<}
(26)
for
r
/*
7
(sin
$ - tan
&>
cos $),
(27)
and
for
=
1
0.
For
ft>-=
60
==
^,
a=
0.7,
the in-
tensity distribution
plotted
in
Fig.
88 and recorded in
Table V.
FIG. 88.
we have:
7-7
7 7
7
difficult
siii&
(1.7 sin
(sin
<
(26) (27)
7 7
<f>
1.21 cos
$,
7 (sin
+ -
98.
As
it is
to produce
usually some
superim-
For the
a horizontal plane
radiator.
219
by a plane
to
&2 by
,
(6), is
^-rfoa'C^-aO,
where
of is the albedo of irregular reflection. This light flux gives in the lower hemisphere the
<f>
(28)
maximum
(29)
intensity for
as
"
Iff
(co2
oO,
is
72
"
cos
I, of
<f>
and
If
(^ - ^)
cos
&
(30)
this intensity
light is obstructed by the shadow of the lower electhe light intensity of the main radiator, I', in the then trode,
some
<
<j>
<-
is
reduced to
(31)
for
<f>
<
<j>
v where tan
=T
as discussed
is
the
Thus, with a linear radiator of length l a diameter of the lower electrode of 2 rv a ring-shaped mirror reflector subtending, from the base of the arc, the angles ^t and 6>2 , and of the albedo of regular reflection a and the albedo of irregular reflection a!, the light intensity distribution within the angle is < <f> <
y
/
within
= //
(o>2
(32)
<l>i<'<f>
< ^is
cos
J
within
Z
J
(sin
0+[a'
6>
K - ^) - ^]
1
^;
(33)
<
^>
<
a> ) t
o>
is
7
|(1
a)sin0 + U'(fc>2
- atan^
cos$|; (34)
220
within
RADIATION, LIGHT,
o>
3
AND ILLUMINATION.
< - is
<
4>
7=7Jsin <+| a
within
(tan
w2
tan ajj
+&
TT
(^2
~~
r ii
^i/
cos
^1
PI >
(35)
-<
JU
<?S
<
OJ is 2
(sin
<
tan
o>
cos <),
(36]
and within
FIG. 89.
distribution curve of such an illuminant 89 and recorded in Table V for the values Fig.
The
is
plotted in
<!= 60 deg. =
^;
u2
0.10,
85 deg.
^-gF";
a=
this gives
0.60;
a; =
and
-~=
1.
^.
(32) 7 (33) / (34) 7 (35)
27 deg>
<f>,
(36) 7
= = -
0.044 7 cos
7 (sin
<f>
(sin
<f>
FIG. 90.
given in Fig. 90 the distribution curve of the magnetite arc, which is designed of the type of Pig. 89 for the purpose of giving more nearly uniform illumination in
is
As comparison
street lighting.
221
DIFFRACTION, DIFFUSION,
AND REFRACTION.
99. Many radiators are of too high a brilliancy to permit their use directly in the field of vision when reasonably good reduction of the brilliancy of the illumination is desired.
illuminant
by
becomes necessary. This is accomplished by surrounding the radiator by a diffracting, diffusing, or prismatically refracting
envelope. Diffraction
is
The nature of both phenomena is different to a considerglobe. able extent, and a frosted globe and an opal globe thus are not
equivalent in their action on the distribution of the light flux. This may be illustrated by Fig. 91. Let, in Fig. 91, 1A, R represent the light-giving radiator,
for simplicity
assumed as a
point,
glass.
and
of light, C 3 issuing in traversing the diffracting sheet (?, scattered over an angle, that is, issues as a bundle of beams Z), of approximately equal intensity in the middle and fading at the edges. The direction of the scattered beam of light D, that
sheet, as
a plate of ground
represent a diffracting
beam
is,
is,
its
center line,
is
the
same
beam
made by
by a
shown
in Fig. 91, 1 B. Here the main beam of light C passes through, as C", without scattering or change of direction,
as
but with very greatly reduced intensity; usually also with a change of color to dull red, due to the greater transparency of opal glass for long waves. Most of the light, however, is irregularly reflected in the opal glass, and the point or area at which the beam C strikes the sheet G becomes a secondary radiator and radiates the light with a distribution curve corresponding to the shape of (?, that is, with a maximum intensity at right angles to the plane of G, as illustrated in Fig. 91, 1 B. A point P thus receives from a radiator R, enclosed by adiffracting globe (?, a pencil of light, as shown in Fig. 91, 2 A, and from the point P the radiator appears as a ball of light, shown densely shaded in 3 A, surrounded by a narrow zone of half light,
222
RADIATION, LIGHT,
lightly shaded,
AND ILLUMINATION.
shown
and in the interior of a non-luminous or luminous envelope. faintly If the radiator R is enclosed by a diffusing globe, Fig. 91, B 2, as the point P receives light from all points of the envelope
3-B
FIG. 91.
secondary radiator, and a ray of direct light from the radiator R. From the point P the entire globe G thus appears luminous, and through it shows faintly the radiating point R as sketched in
}
SB.
An incandescent-lamp
is
clearly
223
but faintly visible, surrounded by a brightly luminous globe, while an incandescent filament in a frosted globe appears as a ball of light surrounded by a non-luminous or faintly luminous
depends on the shape of the diffusing envelope, but does not much depend on the shape of the diffracting envelope; that is, a diffracting
envelope leaves the distribution curve of the radiator essentially unchanged, and merely smooths it out by averaging the light flux over a narrow range of angles, while a diffusing envelope entirely changes the distribution curve by substituting the diffusing globe as secondary radiator, and leaves only for a small part of the light the intensity distribution of the that of the direct beam C"
of the filament is not visible.* globe, but the outline 100. The distribution of light flux thus essentially
primary radiator unchanged. Thus, for a straight vertical cylindrical envelope surrounding a radiator giving the distribution curve shown in Fig. 92, curve I,
FIG. 92.
the distribution curve is changed by diffraction (frosted envelope), to that shown in Fig* 92, curve II, but changed to that
Fig. 92, curve III, by diffusion (opal envelope). The latter consists of a curve due to the transmitted light and of the
shown by
same shape as I, and a curve due to the diffused light, or light coming from the envelope as secondary radiator. The latter is
the distribution curve of a vertical cylindrical radiator, as discussed under heading I, class (5),
of essential
importance
224
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
shape of the
diffracting envelope
is
of less importance.
TABLE
VI.
It is obvious that frosted glass does not perfectly represent if the frosting diffraction, but some diffusion occurs, especially
Opal glass also in the does not give perfect diffusion, but, secondary radiation or impinging beam horizontal issuing from it, the direction of the
is
due to etching,
less if
due to sand-blasting.
a means of
decreasing the brilliancy by increasing the size of the virtual illuminant, and at the same time permits the control of the
225
It probably is the most efficient way, intensity distribution. least as involving the percentage of loss of light flux by absorption.
shown diagrammatically
FIG. 93.
be directed into the horizontal (or any other desired) direction, and the entire lens then appears luminous, as virtual radiator. Usually in this case, instead of a complete lens, individual sections thereof are used, as prisms, as
shown
in Fig. 94,
and
this
FIG. 94.
method
where the light does not pass through, but is reflected and turned back from the back of the prism, "prismatic reflection." Such prismatically reflecting or refracting envelopes and shades have found an extensive use.
LECTURE
XI.
distribution of the light flux in space, and thus the illumination, depends on the location of the light sources, and on
102.
The
The character
a general it is used illumination of low and approximately uniform intensity for street lighting; a general illumination of uniform high intensity in meeting-rooms, etc. ; a local illumination of fairly high intensity
nation depends on the purpose for which
at the reading-table, work bench, etc. ; or combinations thereof, as, in domestic lighting, a general illumination of moderate intensity,
combined with a local illumination of high intensity. -Even the local illumination, however, within the illuminated area usually should be as uniform as possible, and the study of the requirements for producing uniformity of illumination either
is
The
i,
/, of the
beam reaching
this
point, and inversely proportional to the square of the distance of the point from the effective center of the light source:
'-?
f
CD
If the beam of light makes the angle $ with the vertical direction, the illumination, i is thus in the direction 0, the
horizontal illumination, that is, the illumination of a horizontal plane (as the surface of a table), is
ih
cos
<f>
7cos<
,_ x
,
(2)
226
227
i sin
(3)
L is a light source at a distance lv above If, then, in Fig. 95, a horizontal plane P, then, for a point A at the horizontal dis-
FIG. 95.
tance
from the lamp, L (that is, the distance fa from the point of the plane P, vertically below the lamp L), we have:
fa
tan
<
(4)
from the
light is
cos
(5)
A
.
is
=
is
7 cos
2
<f>
-17"
7 cos 3
<j>
(6)
(7)
is
7 cos 2
<j>
sin
<
(8)
where 7
tion ^.
is
on the
228
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
must vary
horizontal plane P, the intensity of the light source with the angle $ according to the equation (6) :
cos2
or,
if
(9)
we denote by /
hence,
:i
CU)
gives the intensity distribution of the light source required to produce uniform total illumination iQ on a horizontal plane be-
neath the light. In the same manner follows from (7) and (8) To produce uniform horizontal illumination
is
ih
on a plane
beneath the light source L, the intensity curve of the light source
given by
cos
^ (12) '
and, to produce uniform vertical illumination iVQ of objects in the plane P beneath the light source I/,
T
cos
2
<
/0
sin
(13)
Where
P which
are to be illuminated
different shapes as on a dining-table, work bench, may of the total etc., uniformity illumination, i, is desirable; where all the objects which shall be illuminated are horizontal as
have
the surface of a drafting-board constancy of the horizontal illumination ih is desirable, while where vertical objects are to be illuminated conas, for instance, to read labels on bottles
stancy of the vertical illumination iv is desirable. By "horizontal illumination" ik is here understood the illumination of a horizontal plane, which is due to the vertical component of the total light flux, while the "vertical illumination"
iv is
component of the
229
In Fig. 96, the intensity curves of the light source required to give uniform total illumination i (11) in a horizontal plane are plotted as curves I, II and III; the intensity distribution for uniform horizontal illumination ih (12) is plotted as curve ^
IV, and the intensity distribution for uniform vertical illumination iVQ (13) in the horizontal plane beneath the light source
is
are plotted as curve V. For convenience, curves IV and of the half The numerical values shown in the upper diagram.
Table I. With increasing angle <f>, increases the required intensity very rapidly, and, as is obvious,
for lv
1 are recorded in
becomes
infinite for
<f>
90 deg.
I.
TABLE
(Pigs.
95
and
96.)
103. Therefore, in the problem, as it is usually met, of producing uniform intensity % over a limited area, subtending angle 2 a} beneath the light source, the intensity of the light source
230
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
FIG. 96.
FIG. 97.
231
< at. Beyond (f> = to, the intensity < should follow (11) for as would be most economical, if may rapidly decrease to zero no light is required beyond the area subtended by angle 2 co. This, for instance, is the case with the concentrated lighting of a = & may follow a However, the intensity beyond <f> table, etc.
different curve, to satisfy
for instance,
Thus in to produce uniform illumination in a vertical plane. domestic lighting, for the general uniform illumination of a room
by a
(11)
if 2 ^ is the angle subtended by the floor up to the angle aj and for $ > oj the intensity of the room from the light source curve would foEow the equation,
(14) ^ }
,
which gives uniform illumination in the vertical plane, that is, of the walls of the room. In Fig, 98 are shown intensity curves of a light source giving uniform illumination in the horizontal plane beneath the lamp, to and the same uniform illumination in the vertical from = & to <f> = 90 deg., as diagrammatically shown in from plane of a room that is, uniform illumination of the floor Fig. 97; in the center a located its and (approximately) walls, by lamp the a) between where is the of the ceiling, (average) angle of the from to the the the direction and vertical edge lamp
(*>j
<
floor:
I for
0}
30 deg.; or diameter of
2 = --== 1.15.
floor
-r
height of walls
2 tan 30 deg.
II for
oj
v3
III for
<*>
+
-*
height of walls
V3 -
3.46.
floor
IV
for
a)
height of walls
These curves are drawn for the same total flux of light in the lower hemisphere, namely, 250 mean hemispherical candle power;
232
or,
RADIATION, LIGHT,
1570 lumens.
AND ILLUMINATION.
downward
intensities
The
I:
vertical or
/ are
in this case:
oi
(o
II:
Ill:
*>
IV:
a)
= = = =
30 deg.; 7 45 deg.; /
60 deg.; J 75 deg.; J
= = =
428
195
cp.
cp.
95 cp.
41.5 cp.
The values are recorded in Table II, in column I, for equal downward candle power J and in column a, for equal light flux, corresponding to 1 mean hemispherical candle power.
,
TABLE
cal,
<f>
II.
(Figs. 97 to 99.)
INTENSITY CURVES.
<f>
w degrees from vertiUniform illumination from vertical ^ = to and =* w to horizontal vertical plane) from (a) Uniform illumination (on
90 deg. No illumination beyond 4> =* 0. 7 for unity illumination at a and 6 for mean hemispherical candle
=
(6)
power
1,
or 2
IT
lumens.
233
These curves in Fig. 98 consist of a middle branch, giving uniform floor illumination, and two side branches, giving uniform side illumination, and are rounded off where the branches join.
FIG. 98.
30, Fig. 99 gives the intensity curves for the same angles, a> 5, 60, and 75 deg., for uniform illumination only in the hori-
FIG. 99.
zontal plane beneath the lamp, but no illumination beyond this; for <j> > CD, the light flux rapidly decreases.
of 150
The curves in Fig. 99 are also plotted for equal total light flux, mean hemispherical candle power, or 940 lumens. 'The
234
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
curve, 0, giving (approximately) uniform illumination within an = 10 deg., is added to the set; this curve, angle of 20 deg., or for CD
however, is plotted for one-tenth the light flux of the other curves, 94 lumens, or 15 mean hemispherical candle power.
The
vertical or
downward
I:
a)
intensities 7
Ill:
IV: 0:
7
7
= = = -
Fig. 99 best illustrates the misleading nature of the polar diagram of light intensities. It is hard to realize from the appearance
of Fig.
flux,
99 that curves
and curve
I, II, III and IV represent the same light one-tenth the light flux, that is, little more
than half the light flux of a 16-cp. lamp. Curve 0, however, illustrates that enormous light intensities can be produced with very little light flux, if the light flux is concentrated into a sufficiently narrow beam. This explains the enormous light intensities given by search-light beams: for CD 1 deg., or a concentration of the light flux into an angle of 2 deg. which is about the angle of divergency of the beam of a we would get 7 = 700,000 cp. in the beam, good search light 15 mean with hemispherical, or 7.5 mean spherical, candle power light source; and a light source of 9000 mean spherical candle a 160-ampere 60- volt arc would thus, when concenpower trated into a search-light beam of 2 deg., have an intensity in the beam of 7 = 210 million candle power, when allowing 75 per cent loss of light flux, that is, assuming that only 25 per cent of the light flux is concentrated in the beam. The numerical values of Fig. 99 are given as 6 in Table II, for
equal light flux corresponding to 1
mean
B.
104. To produce uniform illumination in a plane beneath the illuminant, a certain intensity distribution curve is required, as discussed in A for other problems of illumination, correspondingly different intensity curves would be needed to give the
;
desired illumination.
235
produce economically any desired distribution curve of a given illuminant. Therefore, the problem of is to determine, from the purpose for illuminating engineering is which the illumination used, the required distribution of illumination, and herefrom derive the intensity curve of the illuminant which would give this illumination. Then from the existing industrial illuminants, or rather from those which are available for the particular purpose, that is selected whose intensity distribution curve approaches nearest to the requirements, and
from the actual intensity curve of this illuminant the illumination which it would give is calculated, so as to determine how near it
fulfils
the requirements.
intensity curve of the illuminant, required to give the desired illumination, depends on the location of the illuminant
The
Thus if, with a chosen industrial illuminant no location and number of light sources, the desired can be found which approaches intensity curve desired illumination, sufficiently to give a fair approach to the a different location, or different number of light sources would have to be tried. Here, as in all engineering designs which
and the number
of illuminants used.
involve a large
number of independent variables, judgment based on experience must guide the selection. If so, practically always some industrially available illuminant can be found which sufficiently approaches the intensity curve required by
the desired illumination*
of street lighting.
This problem is: with a minimum expenditure of light flux to produce over the entire street a that is, at minimum cost This illumination may be fairly low, sufficient illumination.
economic reasons, where many miles of streets in sparsely settled districts have to be illuminated. This requires as nearly uniform illumination as possible, since the minimum illumination must be sufficient to see by, and any excess above this represents not only a waste of light flux, but,
for
if
reduces the effectiveness of the illumination at the places, where the intensity is lower, by the glare of the spots of high illumination. Uniformity of street illumination thus is of special importance
the excess
is
great,
it
for
2B6
as
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
European cities, the relatively small mileage of streets per thousand inhabitants economically permits the use of far greater light fluxes, and then uniformity, while still desirable, becomes
less essential.
TABLE
III
(Figs 100
and
101.)
is
mostly, used
237
candle power:
FIG. 100.
direct-current enclosed carbon arc, with clear inner II. The of the character discussed in Pig. 82. a curve globe: direct-current enclosed carbon arc, with opal inner globe: a
I.
The
0.80
08 04
06
08 10 12
14 16
18 20 22 24 26
80 38 34
curve of the character discussed in Fig. 92. III. The magnetite arc or luminous arc, with clear globe a curve of the character discussed in Fig. 89. The numerical values are recorded in Table III, per 100 mean spherical candle power.
*.
238
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
follows, by equations (6) and (4), the (total) in a horizontal plane beneath the lamp, at the intensity, i, horizontal distance ZA from the lamp, where lv is the height
Herefrom then
of the
lamp above
= =
-r
l>v
as ab-
20,
and
lamps
105.
of 200
mean
With
>
and equal
FIG. 102.
heights 4, as shown diagrammatically in Fig. 102, the illumination of any point A of the street surface is due to the light flux of a number of lamps, and not only to the two lamps 1 and 2,
between which the point A is situated. As, however, the illumination rapidly decreases with the distance from the lamp, it is sufficient to consider only the four lamps nearest to the point A. The illumination of a point A of the street surface, at a horizontal distance lh from a lamp, 1, then is:
i
=\+
i2
iB
i4 ,
(15)
1, 2, 3, 4,
where iv
respectively.
Let
*=p
and
= x;
(16)
p p + 2p
x,
x, x,
x,
(17)
239
COS
COS
(18)
cos"
/4
where Iv I2 I3
,
I*
respective directions
<f> 2 ,
<f> B ,
<
4.
0.1
0.3
0.9
0.1
20
10
60
80
100
120
140
ICO
180
800
Herefrom are calculated the illumination, i, plotted in and 104 and recorded in Table IV for lv * 20 ft.; p - 100 ft., Pig. 103, and p - 10, hence ZAo = 200 ft., l ho
for equal light flux of
Figs. 103
5,
hence
Fig. 104,
200 mean spherical candle power per lamp. the same with seen, light flux per lamp, the distribution curve III of Fig. 100 gives the highest and the curve I the lowest intensity at the minimum point midways between the lamps, while inversely I gives the highest and III the lowest intensity near the lamp; that is, I, the carbon arc with clear inner globe, gives the least uniform, and III, the luminous arc, the most uni-
As
240
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
form, illumination, while the carbon are with opal inner globe, II, stands intermediate.
TABLE
tan tan
Z
IV.
STREET ILLUMINATION.
tan tan
4> 3
$2
=x =P
_lh ~~
lv
4>4
= =
p
2
+
P
x
x
^o
I*'
The
I.
ratio of
maximum
to
minimum
illumination
is
p = 10
II.
p =
'5
III.
Carbon arc with clear globe: Carbon arc with opal globe: Luminous, or magnetite, arc:
17.6
6.9
3.1
1.8
3,3
1.25
241
between the lamps, or greater elevation of the lamps above the street surface, give a more uniform illumination, so that, for p = 5, III gives only 25 per cent intensity variation, while, for = 10, I gives a very unsatisfactory illumination, alternating >*p
darkness and blinding glare.
100
120
ICO
180
200
\
\
In Figs. 105 and 106 are plotted, and recorded in Table III, the illuminations for equal minimum intensity midways between the 200 ft., between the lamps, lamps, and for equal distances lhQ
for
p = p -
5,
or
Zy
10, or
19
= -
40
20
ft.
ft.
height above the street level, Fig. 105. height above the street level, Fig. 106.
To produce this minimum intensity of 0.1 candle feet, with 200 feet distance between the lamps, would require the following mean spherical candle powers
:
p10,
I.
or
,=20
1190
750
ft.;
p5,
or
Zv
~40
ft.
clear globe:
800 690
580
II.
III.
490
242
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
produce required three distribution curves. The carbon arc gains in efficiency and in uniformity of illumination by increasing the elevation from 20 to 40 ft., while the due to the greater distance arc loses in efficiency
magnetite from the illuminated surfaces
in the light flux, It is interesting to note the great difference for the minimum illumination, same the to
this
by the
0.
Let Kg. 107 represent the intensity distribution of an incandescent lamp with reflector, suitably designed for approximately uniform illumination in a horizontal plane below the lamp. Such a distribution curve can, for instance, be produced
106.
FIG, 107.
by a
ical
by
is
(Fig. 108) located eccentric in a spherspiral filament globe G, of which the upper part is clear glass and covered a closely attached mirror reflector R, while the lower part
frosted, as shown diagrammatically in Fig. 108. this arrangement, half of the light flux issues directly, with approximately uniform intensity in the lower hemisphere,
With
<f>
from from
to
A
<f>
<
17
<f>
<f>
to
at
The other
is
248
from the mirror, and, due to the eccentric location of the of about filament, the reflected rays are collected into an angle 45 deg. from the vertical, and cross each other, thereby producing
the intensity maximum
at
<
30 deg.
The
is
intrinsic
brilliancy
sufficiently
reduced,
distribution
and
the
curve smoothed out, by the frosting of the globe as far as not covered
by the
reflector.
The
hemisphere beyond
<
<f>
then
is
only
that reflected
frosting.
by the
val-
The numerical
Table V.
The mean
candle power
spherical of the
lamp
dle
is
12.93, or
163
canFIG. 108.
lumens; the
mean
hemisphere is 20.20, or 127 lumens, and the mean candle power in the upper hemisphere is 5.66, or 36 lumens. Table V gives the distribution of illumination i in a horizontal
plane beneath and above the lamp, for different horizontal distances 4 and the vertical distance lv 1, by equation (6), and the horizontal illumination. ihy by equation (7), as discussed
in A.
These are plotted in Fig. 109, for the lower hemisphere upper hemisphere in the upper, curve. Assuming now that a room of 24 ft. by 24 ft, and 10 ft. high is to be illuminated by four such lamps, located 6 inches below the ceiling in such a manner as to give as nearly as possible uniform illumination in a plane 2.5 ft. above the floor (the height
5! table, etc.)-
244
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
TABLE
V.
As the illumination
in the space
is
due
to several lamps and thus is higher than that at the same horizontal distance outside of a lamp, for approximate uniformity of illumination, the distance between the lamps must be con-
siderably greater than twice their distance from the side walls
04
06
OS
10
-20
_IQ.
no.
246
of the
RADIATION, LIGHT,
room.
AND ILLUMINATION.
cally in Fig. 110, at 5 ft. from the side walls and 14 ft. from each in the other, the (total) illumination in the lines A, B, C, As this plane is test plane 2.5 ft. above the floor is calculated.
the illumination curve in a plane is derived from that in Fig. 109, by 3 = 49, and multiplying the abscissas dividing the ordinates by 7
7 7
ft.
ft.
first
by
7.
400-
800-
\
100.
FIG. 111.
The
illumination,
,
i,
,
at
any
point, P, then
is
derived by adding
the illumination ia ib ici id of the four lamps a, 6, c, d, taken from curve in Fig. Ill for the horizontal distances of point from the lamps: lha lhbJ lhc lhd These component illuminations
, , .
are plotted in Figs. 112 to 115; as a, b, d in Fig. 112; as C} a , BI> in Fig. 113, etc., and their numerical values, in thousandths In Fig. 116 are shown of candle feet, recorded in Table VI.
A A A A
the four curves of the resultant direct illumination, superimposed upon each other. 107. To this direct illumination is to be added the diffused
illumination
resulting
from
reflection
by
ceiling
I
and
walls.
Let
at a2
= =
0.75
0.4
= =
(19)
J
may
The
0.
as follows:
ceiling receives as direct light the light issuing in the hemisphere, or 36 lumens per lamp, thus a total of
Z,
The
upper
=
x
36
144 lumens,
(20)
247
some reflected light from the walls. total light flux received by the ceiling, and $! 2 flux received by the walls, the light flux received light
and
if
also receives
Thus,
total
by the
(21)
ceiling is
where which
from the
;
walls,
received
by the
ceiling.
is
And
The
(22)
walls receive as direct light the light issuing from the the lower hemisphere, between the horizontal, <f> in 90 lamps
248
deg.,
RADIATION, LIGHT,
<
AND ILLUMINATION.
= & (Fig. 110), from the lamp to the and the direction, lower edge of the walls. This angle a> varies, and averages 30 deg. for that half of the circumference, PQR (Fig. 110), at which the walls are nearest, and 60 deg. for that half, RSTUP, Hence the for which the walls are farthest, from the lamp.
1.0
0.8
0.6
0.2
A(Z
A&
Ac
8
1*0
12
16
20
21
0.6
0.6
Q
0.2
B&&0
12
18
20
2*
by the
fW / sin $ d<
=
4
I sin
$ d<S>
83 lumens;
(23)
or,atotal"of!/2
83
332 lumens.
(24)
249
In addition hereto, the walls receive some of the light flux fleeted by the ceiling. The total light received by the walls
ms
is:
$2 - L2 + &A*,,
here b is that fraction of the light flux issuing hich is received by the walls.
LO
(25)
from the
ceiling,
0.8
0.0
Ca
C6
Ci
Cc
1.0
04
12
15
20
03
0.2
J**l
8
12
Da
U
is
).
And
Of the
/,
a2 (L,
A*
(26)
and &2
a part
by the ceiling as secondary generator, obstructed by the floor, a part received by the walls.
250
RADIATION, LIGHT,
floor is
AND ILLUMINATION.
The
a square plane, of the same size, 24 by 24 ft., as the The light 10. radiator, that is, the ceiling, and at the distance be calculated intercepted by the floor can thus approximately
as discussed in Lecture X, II,
1,
and circular shades, by replacing the quadratic shade and radia= 24 2 and r tor by circular shades of the same area, rV
,
13.5, at the
same distance
10,
0.74.
Calculated as discussed in Lecture X, II, 1, the floor receives 55 per cent and the walls 45 per cent of the light reflected by the
ceiling.
the same Assuming, approximately, that the walls receive the as the from reflected ceiling of the ceiling, light percentage or the from reflected walls, receives of the light
b2
bv
(27)
28 ) 2Q )
=
1
_
*
(30)
V-"
1
+
ceiling is
and the
light reflected
from the
is
(30)
$/ =
*2'=
144 lumens
are the values of light reflected from the ceiling walls respectively.
Of that from the ceiling, the floor receives (1 and of that from the walls, the floor receives b^ =
0.45; hence,
LIGHT INTENSITY
AND ILLUMINATION.
251
the diffused light on the floor plane, and thus also, sufficiently approximate, on the test plane 2.5 ft. above the floor, is
=
and as
145 lumens,
576 sq. ft., the flux of diffused this plane contains x in test foot the plane, or the diffuse illumination, light per square
is
2
A =
=
-r
0.250 foot-candle.
wo
600
600
400
300
200
100
FIG, 116.
108. Adding this diffuse illumination, shown as G, to the directed illumination, gives the total illumination, i, shown in Pigs. 112 to 115, and recorded in Table VI. as A, B, C, From these curves are taken the values of the distance,
and plotted in Fig. 117. The points of equal illumination, then, are connected by curves, and thus give what may be called equi-luminous curves, or equi-potential
curves of illumination.
These equi-luminous curves are plotted for every 0.05 footcandle, except that the curves 0.875 and 0.925 are added in
252
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
dotted lines. As seen, the illumination is a minimum of 0.600 in the corners of the room and a maximum of 0.950 at a point between the lamps and the center of the room, and is between 0.800 and 0.950 everywhere except close to the edges of the
room.
FIG. 117
TABLE
VII
(Fig. 117.)
EQUI-POTENTIAL CURVES.
253
the
direct light, which reaches the test plane, 2.5 ft. above directed light from the lamps, issues within the angle = 0, up to from <j> = 40 deg. to = 70 from the vertical,
floor, as
<
75 lumens per lamp; or, a total of directed light in deg., 300 lumens. The diffused light in the test plane of 4 X 75 the test plane is 576 X 0.25 == 144 lumens, and the total light in the test plane thus is 444 Ijimens; while the total light issuing from the four lamps is 4 X 163 '= 652 lumens, giving an 444 *= efficiency of illumination of 0.68; or, 68 per cent: the 652
is
and
444
average horizontal illumination in the test plane
is
-i*
576
770; while the average total illumination, from Fig. 117, is about im = 870. The difference is due to the varying direction in which the directed light traverses the test plane. Measurement of the illumination of a room by illuminometer, to give correct values, thus must take in consideration the
which the light traverses every point; the light flux intercepted by a horizontal surby measuring the result face, represents only the horizontal illumination,
different directions in
D.
109. Assuming a table, of 5 ft. by 13 ft., to be illuminated so as to give as nearly as possible uniform horizontal illumination ih With a light source of the distribution curve, Fig. 107, but of four times the intensity, and using two such lamps, they
.
would be located vertically above the table, at a distance from jach other which would be chosen so that, midways between he lamps, the illumination is approximately the same as verti5ally beneath the lamps. In the same manner as discussed in (7, the illumination is
118, using,
A, B,
in Fig.
About the most uniform horizontal illumination then is given lamps 5 ft. above the table, 8 ft. from each
254
RADIATION, LIGHT,
ft.
AND ILLUMINATION.
The illuminations
from the edge of the table, as shown in Fig. 118. in the lines A, 5, and (7, and their components are plotted in Figs. 119, 120, 121, and recorded in Table VII.
FIG. 118.
TABLE
VIII.
255
the curves as given in Figs. 119 to 121 may then be the equi-luminous curves at the table surface, as done plotted In this case, which in Fig. 117 of the preceding paragraph.
represents concentrated illumination, diffusion but the light is all directed light.
is
not considered,
4.0
3.0
2.0
1.0
4,0
Ba
3.0
8.0
*
8.0
2.0
1.0
1.0
FIG. 120.
FIG. 121.
LECTURE
XII.
light issuing
;
from
it;
that is the light flux density in space and more particularly at the illuminated objects; the illumination, that is, the light flux density reflected from the illuminated objects, and the effect produced thereby on the human eye. In the latter, we have left the field of physics and entered the realm of physiology, which is not as amenable to exact experimental determination, and where our knowledge thus is far more limited than in physical science. This then constitutes one of the main difficulties of the art of illuminating engineering: that it embraces the field of two difphysics and physiology. The light flux entering the eye is varied in its physical quantity by the reaction of the eye on light flux density in contracting or expanding the pupil. The effect of the light flux which enters the eye is varied by the fatigue, which depends on intensity and also on color. Distinction is due to differences in the light flux
ferent sciences
objects, that is, differences of illumination, which may be differences in quality, that is, in color, or differences in intensity, that is, in brightness, and as
effect
of
The
we have
to deal in illumi-
nating engineering thus are: The intensity of the light source or the illuminant, and its brilliancyj that is, the flux density at the surface of the
illuminant;
The
flux of
light,
that
is,
257
that
is,
in space,
and
is,
illumination, that
The intensity of a light source is measured in candles. The unit of light intensity, or the candle, is a quantity not directly related to the absolute system of units, but reproduced from specificaby comparison with maintained standards, and for white light is probably between 0.04 and 0.02 watt. Intensity has a meaning only for a point source of light; that is, an illumitions or
nant in which the flux of light issues from a point or such a small area that, at the distance considered, it can be considered as a " thus is a physical quantity of the "Intensity of light point. same nature as "intensity of magnet pole," which latter also presupposes that the total magnetic flux issues from a point, and thus is applicable only when dealing with such distances from the source of the light flux or magnetic flux, that the flux can be assumed as issuing from a point. Frequently the intensity of a light source is different in different directions, and then
either the distribution curve of the light intensity is required for characterizing the illuminant, or the average of the intensities in
all
directions in space
is
used,
and
is
called the
"mean
spherical
intensity" The unit of light intensity, or the candle, is the intensity which produces unit flux density at unit distance from the light
source, and thus produces a total flux of light equal to 4?r units (the surface of the sphere at unit distance from the light
The unit of light flux is called the lumen, and one source). of candle light intensity thus produces 4 n lumens of light flux a (just as magnet pole of unit intensity produces 4 n lines of
magnetic force).
The light flux is the essential quantity which characterizes the usefulness of an illuminant, and it is the raw material from which all illuminating engineering starts. Any source of light
the diffused can be measured in units of light flux or lumens daylight entering the windows of a room, or the visible radiation of the mercury lamp or a Moore tube as well as that of a
by adding all the flux densities intercepted point source any surface enclosing the source of light,
In a point source of
light;
by
is
the total
258
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
by 4
x.
In any iUuminant
which
of an intensity, not a point source, of light can be source the which at except at such distances
is
we cannot speak
interior illumination this is rarely candle power, as measure of the the the case. Since, however, the most familiar quantity in become has intensity of light, even sources of light characterizing illurninants, very commonly tube or the diffused Moore as a sources which are not point candle in power," and when are expressed "equivalent daylight a of candle mercury lamp, or of the thus speaking of the power mean the candle power we the from windows, diffused daylight would which of give the same total flux of a point source light, the or daylight from the windows, of light as the mercury lamp, " " candle The equivalent etc. power, or frequently merely called " " mean spherical candle power, thus is the total light flux divided is not a unit of intensity, but a unit of 4 hence in
by
JT,
reality
light flux.
This explains the apparent contradiction between the claims that sources of light, as the mercury lamp or the Moore tube, cannot be expressed in candle powers, while at the same time their in candle power per watt: meanspecific consumptions are given refers to the total flux of which ing equivalent candle power,
and thus is a definite and measurable physical quantity. While it is not probable that the custom of rating illuminants in candles, regardless of their shape, will quickly disappear, and
light,
no objection
exists against
it,
provided that
it is
understood to
mean the equivalent candle power, it is preferable to use the correct unit of light flux, and express the output of a source of light
in lumens, adding where necessary the equivalent candle power in parenthesis. Obviously, the use of the candle power in any horizontal, or terminal, or maximum canparticular direction
has a meaning only in characterizing the distribution of the light flux, as applicable for a particular purpose, as street its light flux lighting, but; when used for rating the illuminant by unintentional or deception. Incandesoutput, is an intentional
dle
power
cent lamps have been rated, and to some extent still are, in horizontal candle power, but in this case the horizontal candle power has ceased to mean the actual horizontal candle power, but is
the horizontal candle power which with a certain standard distribution of light flux would correspond to the light flux of the
259
lamp, and thus also is merely a practical measure of the light flux, retained by convenience: one horizontal candle power represents 0.78 mean spherical. or equivalent candle power of the standard distribution curve, a-nd thus 4 TT X 0.78 lumen. In general, intensity, or candle power, thus is an angular measure, useful in characterizing the distribution of the light flux, but not the total light flux. 111. Light-flux density is the light flux per unit area traversed by it, thus is measured in lumens per square meter (or square
foot), just as the magnetic density netic force per square centimeter.
measured in lines of magIn illumination, as unit of employed, and not the centimeter, as
is
and 10 2 thus
is
the reduction
Frequently
used as
practical unit of length. For a point source of light the light flux density is the intensity of the light source, in candles (in the direction towards the
point of observation, if the distribution is not uniform in all directions), divided by the square of the distance, in meters, or feet, and the light flux density thus is frequently expressed in meter-candles, or foot-candles. Thus at 10 feet distance from a 16 candle power lamp, the light flux density is 0.16 foot-candle, or 0.16 lumen per square foot. Very commonly, therefore,
the light flux density produced by sources of light which are not points, is also expressed in meter-candles or foot-candles which numerically is the same value, that is, the same quantity,
as lumens per square meter or square foot, but physically would refer to the equivalent candle power of the light source.
the light flux density reflected from the illuminated object, and as flux density thus is measured also in lumens per square meter or square foot, or in meter-candles or
Illumination
is
foot-candles.
is the light flux density at the surface of the illumias flux density thus could also be measured in lumens per square meter or square foot, but, as this would usually give enormous values, brilliancy of the light source generally is meas-
Brilliancy
nant,
and
ured in lumens per square centimeter, or per square millimeter. It is a quantity which is of high importance mainly in its physiological effect.
260
istics of
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
the iUuminant, while flux density is a function of the but not of the source of light: space traversed by the light flux, in the space from the surface of of with the same source light,
the illuminant to infinite distance, all light flux densities exist between the maximum -at the surface of the illuminant (its and zero. Brilliancy thus is the maximum of the
brilliancy) While intensity and brilliancy depend upon light-flux density. the shape of 'the illuminant, light flux is independent thereof.
Illumination
a quantity which depends not only on the source illumiof light, that is, light flux and flux density, but also on the flux the is thus and density light nated objects and their nature,
is
as modified
ever, the
by the illuminated
objects.
is
term "illumination"
density/' irrespective of the illuminated objects. 112. The light flux thus is the raw material with which
the first problem then is illuminating engineering starts, and to distribute the light flux through space so as to give at all
for satisfactory illumipoints the light flux density required nation. Some problems, as the lighting of a meeting place, schoolroom, etc., require a uniform or general, and fairly high intensity
of illumination, while in street lighting intensity of illumination is desirable.
local or concentrated illumination
is needed. Usually, however, or concentrated illumination, of fairly a combination of a local of lower intensity, high intensity, with a general illumination we desire to where those at the former is required: places at the readingis work being done, distinguish details, as where the while work bench, dining-table etc., general illumina-
table,
merely for orientation in the space, and thus may be of lower intensity, and for reasons of economy, and also physiological reasons, should be of lower intensity. We thus have to distinguish between local or concentrated, and general or uniform, illumination, and a combination of both, and have to distribute the light flux in accordance theretion
is
produce a high flux density at the points or areas requiring high concentrated illumination, a low and uniform flux density throughout the remaining space. This can be done by choosing a light source of the proper distribution curve, as, for instance, in street illuadnation a lamp
with, that
is,
261
horizontal and 20 deg. giving most of the light flux between the below the horizontal; in many cases of indoor illumination a light source giving most of the light between the vertical
and an angle of from 30 to 60 deg. from the vertical depending on the diameter of the area of concentrated illumination and the height of the illuminant above it. It can also be done by
modifying or directing the light flux of the illuminant by reflection or diffraction and diffusion, either from walls and ceilings of the illuminated area, or by attachments to the illuminant,
Furtheras reflectors, diffusing globes, diffracting shades, etc. the use secured can be flux distribution the by required more,
a number of illuminants, and with a larger area this usually Frequently the desired flux distribution is produced by using an illuminant giving more light flux than necesin those directions where sary, and destroying the excess of flux
of
is
necessaiy.
it is is
not wanted, by absorption. Obviously this arrangement uneconomical and thus bad illuminating engineering; the desired flux distribution should be secured economically, that waste of light flux by absorption, and is, without unnecessary this usually can be done by a combination of a number of light sources of suitable distribution curves. The most economical method of securing the desired distribution curve obviously is to cheose a light source coming as near to it as possible, and
then modifying
113.
it
by
reflection or diffraction.
is one of physics, and the result, can be measured by photometer the ittumination, objective is, or luminometer, and thus checked. The duty of the illuminatwith the same ing engineer, however, does not end here, but distribution of. light same the that is, illumination, objective flux throughout the entire illuminated area, as measured by be very satisfactory, or it photometer, the illumination may on whether the physiobe depending unsatisfactory, may entirely and very often or are satisfied are violated; requirements
Thus
far,
the problem
that
tiring,
or uncomfortable, but when judged by the density and the Even distribution of the light flux, should be satisfactory.
numerous commercial illuminants, designed to give suitable distribution curves, fail to do justice to their light flux and its distribution, by violating fundamental physiological requirements.
262
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
that is, the effects physiological problems of illumination, flux in space, of distribution light the objective entering between
The
and the subjective effects produced on the human eye, thus are the most important with which the illuminating engineer has to must be recognized is that the deal, and the first feature which measured as by the photometer, is no objective illumination,
criterion of the subjective illumination, that is, the physiological effect produced by it, as regard to clearness, comfort and satisfaction,
and
it is
of
judged.
pupil The pupil of the eye autoat or near matically reacts, by contraction, on high brilliancy on which we of the the that retina, the sensitive spot, point is, to a someand we at which of the look, focus the image object
The
contraction of the
what
lesser extent
else in
the
field
thereby that is, produces the same result as if the objective illumination had been correspondingly reduced, intensified by
eye,
of vision. If, therefore, points or areas of high brilliancy are in the field of vision, especially if near to objects at which we the higher the brilliancy, look, the pupil contracts the more of amount the reduces and light flux which enters the
the uncomfortable effect of seeing high brilliancy. The existence of points of high brilliancy in the field of vision thus results in a great waste of light flux, and additional discomfort, and, for
must satisfactory illumination, points of high brilliancy thus of sources of vision. field of the be kept out high brilliancy Light
so that they cannot directly be seen, but the illumination accomplished by the light reflected from ceilings, illuminant indirect lightetc., or from reflectors attached to the
must be arranged
we ing; or at least the light sources should be located where with moderate-sized that to look at are rarely liable is, them, rooms, at or near the ceilings. Or light sources of moderate
should be used, as the Moore tube, the mantel. Or, with illuminants of the Welsbach mercury lamp, as the electric arc, the incandescent lamp high brilliancy, of the (especially the tungsten filament), etc*, the brilliancy
intrinsic
brilliancy
illuminant must be reduced by enclosing it with a diffusing or as an opal or frosted or diffracting globe or shade,
holophane globe,
etc.
263
in which the illumination, however, can be satisfactory a tungsten from eye at any time can be exposed to the direct rays of removing the high filament or an arc. While the methods loss of considerable a brilliancy of the illuminant usually involve the frosted in light flux, by absorption at the refracting surface, or opal globe, etc., and the objective illumination thus is deare anywhere creased, if the methods of reducing the brilliancy the eye, and thus reasonably arranged, the light flux entering
No
the subjective illumination, is increased, and often very greatly. Thus while frosting an incandescent lamp decreases its light flux by about 15 per cent, in spite thereof usually more light flux enters the eye from the frosted lamp than from a clear glass
distance.
therefore, inefficient to use illuminants of high brilliancy in the field of vision, and in addition makes the illumination
uncomfortable and thereby unsatisfactory. Physiologically the one of the most important brilliancy of the light source thus is
quantities. 114. (6) Fatigue.
flux den-
the nerves of the eye decrease sity, that is, high illumination, in sensitivity, by fatigue, and inversely, in lower illumination or in darkness, increase in sensitivity. This reaction, or adjustment of the sensitivity of the nerves of vision to different intensienables us to see equally well in illuminations 1 (as daylight and varying in intensity by more than 10,000 to room a well-illuminated artificial light). Thus, when entering
ties of illumination,
appears glaring, until gradually the impression fades down to normal. Inversely, coming from a well-lighted room into a space of much lower illumination, it first appears practically dark, until gradually the eye adjusts nerves of vision increase in sensitivity by their itself, that is, the
it
first
and then we again see fairly well. similar in their Fatigue and contraction of the pupil thus are effect for high action, in that they reduce the physiological The contraction of the pupil, however, is almost intensities. brilinstantaneous, and is a protective action against excessive a is the liancies in the field of vision, while fatigue gradual within the adjustment to the average intensity of illumination, operating range of the human eye. By exposure for a considerable period to the fairly high illumirest,
264
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
nation required when working by artificial light, the sensitivity of the eye decreases, the illumination appears less bright, and
thus a higher illumination is required than would be sufficient in the absence of fatigue, and the continuous use and absence of rest cause the sensation of strain, that is, irritation or an
uncomfortable
feeling,
as
especially noticeable
when working
or reading for a considerable length of time in rooms having a high uniform intensity of illumination, as meeting-rooms, some libraries, etc. If, however, the eye can rest even momentarily,
by a change to lower intensity of illumination, fatigue is decreased, never becomes as complete and uncomfortable, and the concentrated illumination of the working-table appears brighter than it would without the possibility of rest.
necessary not only to provide a sufficiently high intensity at the place where needed, but it is just as necessary to keep the intensity of illumination as low as permissible, wherever it is not needed, so as to afford to the eye rest from the. fatigue.
cases, as meeting-halls, schoolrooms, this may not be a uniform high intensity required, to be able to but possible, work or read anywhere in the room. Where, however, it is not necessary, it is not merely uneconomical to provide a uniform high intensity of illumination, but it is an illuminating engineering defect, and a high intensity should be provided, as concen-
In some
trated illumination, only at those places where required, as at the reading-tables of the library, but the general illumination
we
should be of lower intensity. While we rarely realize the cause, feel the superiority of the combination of high concentrated
and lower general illumination, by speaking of such illumination as home-like, restful, etc. Especially in places where considerable work has to be done by artificial illumination, as in libraries,
factories, etc., to get satisfactory results, it is important to consider this effect of fatigue, and to properly combine a moderately low general illumination with a local higher intensity of
illumination at the places of work. The latter can usually be given by a light source having a downward distribution, located
sufficiently high
above the place of work. The average standing or reading lamp, however, generally is not sufficiently high to, accomplish the result. Obviously, in such local illumination,
265
is the quality, of at the the color, light: fatigue high intensities occurs
more with yellow and orange rays than with white light, and very little with green and bluish-green light. Thus, in artificial illumination, in which practically always the yellow and
orange rays greatly preponderate, the question of fatigue is far more important than with the bluish-white diffused daylight, and the irritating effects of fatigue thus are mostly felt with
artificial illumination.
Objects are seen and distinguished by is, color, and in intensity, that is, If there were no brightness, of the light reflected by them. in differences in color or intensity throughout the field of vision, we would see light but would not distinguish objects. Therefore,
115.
(c)
Differences.
in good illumination, the differences in color and in intensity should be sufficiently high to see clearly by them, but still limited
so as not to preponderate to such extent as to distract the attention from smaller differences. The differences in intensity,
to give distinction, should be high, but at the same time are limited by the phenomena of fatigue and of the contraction
intensity must still be sufficiently high to see clearly, and the maximum intensity not so high as to cause fatigue and contraction of the pupil, much beyond that corresponding to the average intensity, otherwise the vision becomes indistinct and unsatisfactory, and uncomfortable by too much contrast; that is, the intensity differences must give a sufficient, but not an excessive, contrast, if the illumination is
of the pupil:
the
minimum
is,
only under the control of the illuminating engineer. In some cases the illuminating engineer can control or advise regarding the color of objects, as the walls, ceilings, etc. In most cases,
however, the absolute color of the illuminated objects is not within the control of the illuminating engineer: for instance, in street lighting, the color of the street surface, its surroundings, as vegetation, houses, etc., are fixed and cannot be changed for
effects of illumination.
So
also in
tion.
266
trolled
AND ILLUMINATION.
and thereby
slight color differences increased and made more distinct, or decreased and thus obliterated. For instance, the color resulting dirt is usually the color of carbon and of iron, brown or reddish brown, that is, colors at the long yellowish wave end of the spectrum. Spots and blemishes due to dirt or age, thus are made more distinct by using an illuminant deficient in the long waves of light, as the mercury lamp, while inversely they are decreased by using a reddish-yellow illuminant, as the incandescent lamp or the candle. Thus the white arc lamp and still more so the bluish-green mercury lamp shows blemishes and slight color differences of age and dirt harsh and exaggerated, while the yellow light softens them and makes them disappear; and while, for a ballroom, the yellow light
thus preferred, and the mercury arc or even the ordinary white carbon arc would give a harsh and disagreeable effect, inversely the yellow light would be unsuitable where such slight It is therefore essential differences should be distinguished. for the illuminating engineer to choose as far as it is feasible the proper color of light, and an otherwise good illumination may be spoiled by using too white or too yellow a light.
is
The main distinction of objects, however, is due to differences in intensity or brightness, and, for producing these, the shadows are of foremost assistance, and indeed the differences of intensity,
shadows.
objects, are to a large extent those due of the shadow thus is one of the most
important subjects of illuminating engineering. If we have no shadows, but a perfectly diffused illumination, even if the
intensity of illumination is sufficient, the illumination is unsatisfactory, as we lose the assistance of the shadows in distinguishing
and therefore find seeing more difficult, the illumination and uncomfortable. The use of shadows for illumination requires that we must have directed light, that is, light coming from one or a number of sources, and thus causing shadows, and not merely diffused illumination, that is, light coming from all directions and thus causing no shadows. While, however, in general perfectly diffused illumination is unsatisfactory, an illumination having only
objects,
restless
directed light
as
is*
also unsatisfactory.
arc,
from a single
If the light is all directed, the shadows are absolutely black, we can-
267
not see anything in them, and, in attempting to see the objects in the shadows, the illumination becomes tiring to the eyes,
and restless. For satisfactory illumination, it therefore is necessary to have sufficient directed light to mark the edge of the objects by their shadow, and thereby improve distinction, but at the same time sufficient diffused light to see clearly in the shadows; that is, a proper proportion of directed and diffused light is
irritating
all the objects assume practically the same in flour mills or foundries, a diffused illumination without as color, shadows would make the illumination so bad as to be practically
useless.
a drafting-room, where all the objects requiring distinction are in one plane, as the drafting board, and the distinction is exclusively by differences of color and intensity, but not by shadows, a perfectly diffused illumination is required, and shadows would be objectionable and misleading, and this is one of the cases where directed light is objectionable. While with a single light source all the light issuing from it is directed light, by using a number of illuminants, the overlap of their light fluxes causes more or less light to reach objects from all directions, and thereby gives the effect of diffused light, except at those places where the shadows cast by the different
cases, as
In other
sources coincide, and by proper positions of sufficient numbers of light sources this can be avoided. The use of a
light
number
116.
means
of increasing the
light in the proper proportion, but the In some simple direction of the latter also is of importance.
of diffused
and directed
cases this
is
obvious, as, in writing, the directed light should left side above the table, so as not to
to
iUunrination
by the length of not extend too far from the object to which it is related, otherwise it loses its close relation to it and becomes misleading and thereby interferes with good illumination. Thus the directed light'should come from above, that is, in a direction making a considerable angle with the horizontal, so as to limit the length
The purpose of the shadow in mark the edge of the object, and its height the shadow. The shadow, therefore, should
268
of the
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
vertical, as
the latter
would Perhaps an angle of 45 to be most satisfactory. would horizontal the with 60 degrees in the usual form cast shadows horizontal The
practically of street lighting therefore are not satisfactory for best illumi-
nation.
While in nature of less importance. indoors we are the cast sun, by only,
is
familiar with seeing several shadows due to the diffused dayOf high importance, however, is light from several windows. so far as it determines the outer in of the illuminant, the
of the object, and thereby make intensity difference at the edge The shadow, however, has another it easier to see the object.
The purpose
of the
shadow
is
to give
an
we should not see, as no object edge, its outer end, and that such that it cannot be mistaken be must it ends there, or at least The of an for the problem thus is not merely to
object. edge to cast a shadow, but the shadow provide sufficient directed light one should be such that only side, at the edge of the object, is other the edge of the shadow, which tersharply defined, while minates on the flat surrounding surface, should gradually fade or blur. If we have to look closely to determine that the outer
the strain edge of the shadow is not the edge of another object, and the edge of an the of distinguishing between object edge and thus uncomfortable illumination of a shadow makes the in clear arc a a cast In the shadows by single unsatisfactory. between the edge glass globe, this difficulty of distinguishing
shadow and the edge of an object is especially marked, and, combined with the invisibility of objects in the shadow, makes such shadows appear on first sight like ditches or obstructions.
of a
In the use of shadows in illuminating engineering it thus is necessary to have the outer edge of the shadows blur or gradually a fade, and this requires that the source of directed light be not outer the at the light point, but a sufficiently large area to scatter edge of the shadow, preferably even more than is the case
This requires enclosing with the shadows cast by the sun. by a fairly large opal globe or other similar device; that is, have the light issue from a fairly large luminous
the illuminant
area.
It
of the
shadows
269
or failure of an illumination.
Color sensitivity.
The maximum
of sensitivity of the
eye shifts with decreasing illumination from yellow to bluish in green, and where a low intensity of illumination is used, as in the rich shorter which is street lighting, a source of light
a white light, is superior in its physiological illuminating value to a yellow light of the same or even higher light flux, while inversely at high values of illumination, as for decorative purposes, the yellow light is more
waves, that
is,
effective.
Therefore
it is
illumination of
a mistake to choose a yellow light source for very low intensity, or a white or bluish-green
effects. Thus, light for illumination attempting high intensity for the average street lighting of American cities, the white arc
is
superior to the yellow flame arc, but, to produce a glare of light, the latter would be superior. While there are further physiological effects which are of im-
portance in illuminating engineering, the above four may illustrate the long step which exists between the distribution of the or light flux as measurable by the photometer, and the success
failure of the illumination represented by it, The requirements of satisfactory illumination
can thus be
grouped in two main classes, referring respectively to economy and to comfort, and the characteristics are: (1) General or uniform, and local or concentrated illumination, and combination of both. This is of importance for economy: to avoid the production of unnecessary light flux; and comfort: to
reduce the effect of fatigue.
of (2) Diffused and directed illumination, and combinations both, and the theory of the shadow. This is of importance for the comfort of illumination, in securing clearest distinction. in economy, to (3) Quality or color of light, of importance
suit the color to the intensity of illumination, and to comfort, in increasing or softening differences in color shades.
(4)
Massed and distributed illumination, as controlling the and thereby the economy and also
the diffusion. (5) Direct illumination and indirect illumination, shaded, diffracted, diffused, or reflected light, in its relation, to the bril-
270
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
the effect of the contraction liancy of the light source, and thereby comfort. and on the of economy pupil, Some of the common mistakes made in illumination are:
(1)
light.
(2)
Exposure
field of vision,
as
naked
filaments.
(3)
(4)
Unsuitable proportion of diffused and directed light. Improper direction of directed light and thereby improper
length of shadows. (5) Sharp edges of shadows. In order to illustrate the preceding principles, some typical
be considered (a) Domestic lighting. 118. Domestic lighting usually requires a combination of a concentrated illumination of fairly high intensity locally at the illumination of low work-table, dining-table, etc., and a general
cases
may
Occasionally, as in intensity, to secure comfort and economy. and absent is local only general illuminalighting halls, etc., the the general illumiroom sick in a instance for tion required, while illumination local nation is absent and only required.
In
dif-
fused light should be such as to give the proper effect of shadows. The problem of domestic illumination thus is to produce a definite distribution of light flux density, with a definite proportion between diffused and directed light. If we deviate from the
side,
the
room appears
cold
we
gloomy.
The
directed
is diffused light; the light issuing from a number of illuminants the light of the in proportion to the number of sources by overlap and walls from reflected The light fluxes of the illuminants. the between The proportion light ceilings is diffused light. reflected from walls and ceilings, or the indirect light, and the direct light from the illuminants, varies with the reflecting power The of walls and ceilings, that is, their brightness or darkness.
be proportion between directed and diffused light thus can numthe changed, and the diffused light increased by increasing ber of illuminants, and also by increasing the brightness of walls
271
brightness of walls and ceilings, the a local high and general low desired distribution of the light flux a can be produced by single illuminant having the intensity
With a given
proper distribution curve of light flux. In this case, however, usually we get too much directed, and not enough diffused, light. The same distribution of light flux can be produced by a number
of illuminants properly located : nearer together for the local than In the latter case we get more for the general illumination.
diffused
and thus by choosing the number of light sources it is possible, with any given brightness of walls and ceilings, to get the desired distribution of light flux and at the same time the proper proportion of directed and diffused With a different brightness of walls and ceilings, the dislight.
and
tribution curve of a single light source, required to give the desired light flux distribution, is correspondingly changed, and,
the lighter the walls and ceilings, the more light is reflected, giving a diffused general illumination, and thus less direct light from the
required for the general illumination. With increasing reflecting power of walls and ceilings, the proportion of diffused light increases, and the number of light sources which are required to give the proper proportion between directed and
illuminant
is
decreased, and inversely it is increased with increasing darkness of walls and ceiling. Therefore, in a room with light walls, a smaller number of light sources is required for good illumination than in a room with dark walls, assuming the
diffused light
is
same
intensity of local
119.
The problem
distribution of illumination, with a definite proportion between directed and diffused light, thus leaves one independent variable the brightness of walls and ceilings. This is necessary, as the
problem of domestic illumination is twofold to get the proper illumination by means of the daylight, and also to get it for artificial illumination. During daytime, the windows are the source of light, the directed light issues from the windows, the diffused light from the walls and ceilings and by the overlap of the light from several windows. The proper distribution between local and general illumination during daytime", and at the same time the proportion of directed and diffused light, thus determines the number of windows and the brightness of walls and
:
ceilings, in the
manner as discussed
before.
272
RADIATION, LIGHT,
reflecting
AND ILLUMINATION.
As the
power
it
light considerations,
of walls and ceilings is fixed by daycannot be chosen, or at least only to a of artificial illumination, but, as
limited extent,
by considerations
not necessary, since by a combination of a found above, distribution curves of number suitable light sources of proper solved. To some be illumination of artificial may the problem the walls and artificial of the daylight, to due light
this is
extent,
Qther.
quality
reflecting
is
power
for the
As
artificial light
deficient in blue
or greenish shade of walls and ceilings gives them a greater reflectwhich usually artificial light ing power for daylight than for a with and inversely reddish-yellow shade. is desirable
(&)
Street Lighting.
of street illumination is to produce a unireasons of economy, the intensity must For form low intensity. of streets, American in cities, in which the mileage be low, at least times is greater than in many for the same population, usually
120.
The problem
European cities, and, at the same time, the same type nant is usually required for the entire area of the city.
of illumi-
The low
of light which has intensity of illumination requires the quality at low effect densities, that is, white the highest physiological as the physiologically inefficient yellow light light, and excludes would be the bluish green of better Still for low intensities. much not is but Quite the mercury lamp, liked, due to its color. the is greenish yellow of the Welsbach mantel satisfactory also
for these
low
intensities.
The American
practice of preferring
the white light of the carbon or magnetite arc thus is correct and in agreement with the principles of illumination, and the
even if it were not yellow -flame arc can come into consideration of only in frequent trimming handicapped by the necessity is illumination of a those specific cases where high intensity cities. of some large used, as would be only in the centers
Uniformity of illumination is specially important in street lightto the ing, where the observer moves along the street, and, due
low
is
a distribution curve is required which gives a maximum intensity somewhat below the horizontal, no light in the upper hemisphere, and very little downward light. Street lamps therefore should be judged and compared by the illumination given midways be-
intensity, the decrease of subjective illumination especially objectionable. For a street illuminant,
by
fatigue
273
or,
minimum intensity,
in other words, by the intensity in a direction approximately 10 deg. below the horizontal. This also is in agreement with
However, it is veiy important that the downward intensity be very low, and in this respect it is not always realized that the light thrown downward is not merely a waste of light flux, but is harmful in producing a glaring spot at
practice.
American
by the
fatigue caused
minimum
Most objectionable in this respect is bon arc and those types of lamps giving a downward
by it, reducing the point between the lamps. the open direct current cardistribution,
but even with the enclosed arc lamp the distribution of light on the street surface is still far from uniform, and the intensity too high near the lamp, and in this respect improvements are
desirable.
greatest defects of the present street illumination, it inferior in subjective illumination even far lower illumination given by the full moon, are the to the
121.
The
absence of diffused light, and especially the improper direction and termination of the shadows, and also the high brilliancy of the illuminant. The light of the usual street lamp is practically all directed light, issuing in a nearly horizontal direction from a point source. Thus the shadows are far longer than permissible,
and terminate sharply and without blur; objects in the shadows are practically invisible, and the end of the shadow looks like the edge of an object, thus producing a misleading effect, which To give a somewhat results in unsatisfactory illumination.
better direction to the light requires considerable increase of the height of the lamp above the street surface. This also would
essentially decrease the intensity of illumination
the lamp,without appreciably affecting the intensity at the minimum point, and thus would give a more uniform and thereby better illumination. No valid reason usually exists against
greatly increasing the height oi; the lamps, except that of the greater cheapness of short lamp posts ; which is hardly justifiable.
however, more difficult to give a proper blur to the ends of shadows, so as to distinguish them from edges of objects. This would require an increase of the surface of the illuminant, by
It
is,
opal or frosted globe, etc. Enclosing the arc by an opal globe, however, scatters the light more uniformly in all directions, and
274
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
interferes with the thereby spoils the distribution curve, and an with illumination: of opal globe, the required uniformity not differ very much does direction downward in the intensity from that in the horizontal, while with lamps 20 feet above the and at distances of 200 feet from each other, the street
downward intensity for uniform illumination should be not much = more than one-twenty-fifth of that under an angle of sin
<
level,
= 2- or 12 dee. below the horizontal. Very much better is 100 the effect of a frosted or sand-blasted globe. The best way of and at the same time maintaining a proper distribution curve its reduce brilliancy and blur the diffusing the light, so as to on the principle shadows, appears the use of prismatic diffraction, Obviously, of the Fresnel lenses of lighthouses (holophane). where the lamps are close together, as in the center of large cities, their light fluxes overlap and thereby give a better diffusion, and, at the same time, the midway point between lamps is under a
thus a more downward disgreater angle against the horizontal; For the largest part of flux tribution of the light permissible. not apply. does this American street lighting, however, arc of 122. In the early days lamps for American city using were frequently used, and such tower lighting, lighting towers in some cities. One or a number lighting has still survived a on of arc lamps are installed high tower and were supposed to like artificial suns, from spread their light over an entire
there, city district.
This method of city lighting was found unsatisfactory, as it did not give enough light. It is unsatisfactory, however, not in principle, but because it was too ambitious a scheme. If, in street illumination, we double the distance between the lamps, each unit must have four times the light flux to get the same minimum flux density, as the distance is doubled, and the flux
density decreases with the square of the distance. At twice the distance between the lamps, each lamp thus must have four times the light flux, and each mile of street thus requires twice the power. Reducing the distance between lamps to onehalf reduces the
power
to one-half with
it is
the
same minimum
use as
In street lighting units of illuminants as possible, and bring them together as close as possible, and correspondingly lower their
illumination.
therefore of advantage to
many
275
cost of taking intensity, up to the point where the increasing and of units care of the larger number increasing cost of poles the for and connections decreasing cost of energy.
compensates
There
is
is fairly
practice.
When, however, you come to square and exposition lighting, no you find that the distance between the illuminants has
on the efficiency. Let us assume that we double the distances between the lamps which light up a large area. Then each lamp requires four times the light flux to get the same minimum flux density between the lamps, but at twice the distance between the lamps each lamp illuminates four times the a large area, area, and the total power per square mile of lighting of lamps number the of like an exposition, thus is independent or far close them apart, together used, and, whether you place the same you require the same total flux of light, and if you keep between proportions of height from the ground and distance and maximum between variation lamps, you also get the same to be the minimum intensity. But, supposing placed lamps
effect
points also are further illumination by having satisfactory apart, a less rapid intensity variation. That points to the conclusion would be to that, for exposition lighting, the most efficient way of number use a relatively moderate high-power sources of
further apart, the
maximum
or
minimum
on high towers at distances from each other of the same magnitude as the height of the towers. We would get a greater illumiuniformity and better physiological effect by having the total same the would nants further apart, and they require the if as same the lamps you bring power, light flux, and therefore close to the ground, and place them very close to each other. The tower lighting therefore is the ideal form for lighting a large When the arc was first introduced, it was so much superior area.
light
before, that people vastly overthat rated it. They thought they could light the whole city towers would have been the these by it, and in trying to do so that even with the effiit found was proper way, but very soon the not streets, but the whole only ciency of the arc, to light an area of the city, would require entirely impracticable amount a scheme for city ambitious too It thus was of light flux.
to
lighting,
but
it
City illumi-
276
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
this first
down from
For the light only the streets. latter purpose, however, lighting towers are inefficient, since much of the light flux is wasted on those places which we no
whole city to an attempt to
longer attempt to light. In exposition lighting, however, the most effective general illumination would be given by white
on high towers, leaving the concentrated or decorative illumination to the incandescent lamp and flame arc, of yellow
arcs
color.
LECTURE
XIII.
and number of light sources, while the relation, to the satisfactory character of the illumination, of the direction of the light, its subdivision and diffusion, etc., are physiological questions. Very little, however, is known on the latter, and the entire field of the physiological effects of the physical methods of
unexplored. As result thereof, not yet an exact science, as is, for illuminating engineering much further physiological but instance, apparatus design, the requirements and to determine is needed investigation
illumination
is
still
largely
is
physical side of illuminating engineering: to produce a throughout the illuminated space, is an engineering problem, which can be solved with any desired degree of exactness, usually in a number of different ways.
definite light flux density
The
The solution of the physical problem of light distribution, however, does not yet complete the problem of illuminating engineering, does not yet assure a satisfactory illumination, but with the same distribution of light flux density throughout the illuminated surface, the illumination may be anything between
entirely unsatisfactory and highly successful, depending on the fulfillment or failure to fulfill numerous physiological requirements.
Some
taken into consideration in the physical design of the illumination, and thus no excuse exists to fail in their fulfillment, though
Such, for instance, is the requirement of low intrinsic brilliancy in the field of vision, of the color of the Other physiological requirements are still very little light, etc.
it is
frequently done.
277
2T8
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
understood or entirely unknown ; while on others not sufficien quantitative data are available for exact engineering calculator "Thus, for instance, the usual suburban street illuminatior with arcs spaced at considerable distances from each other an< located on fairly low posts, is very much inferior to the illumina tion given by moonlight, even when allowing for the differenc
in intensity. Here the reason of the unsatisfactory characte of the former illumination is mainly the almost horizontal direc tion of the light flux. perfectly vertical direction of the ligh
flux again
is
unsatisfactory in
many
cases,
satis
by a direction of the light flux whicl makes a considerable angle with the horizontal as well as th vertical direction. Thus, when dealing with directed light, th.
factory results are given
have very
W< is of essential physiological importance. exact knowledge to guide in the determinatioi of the proper angle in which to direct the light flux; it is knowi that in general approximately horizontal and approximately vertical direction of the light flux are objectionable, and an in
direction angle
little
termediary angle gives best results. However, the horizonta direction usually is objectionable by excessive contrasts, thi vertical direction by flatness in the appearance of the illuminatec objects, and, depending on the nature of the objects, sometime!
the one, sometimes the other feature may be more objectionable Hence, the best angle of incidence of the light depends on the nature, that is, the shape and location, of the illuminated objects
on the purpose
stant, but
is
of the illumination, etc., and thus is not cona function of the problem, which is' still largelj
unknown. 124. Not represented by the physical distribution curve ol illumination, but very marked in their physiological effect is In most the difference between directed light and diffused light.
problems of illumination, either entirely directed light or entirely diffused light is unsatisfactory, and a combination of directed light and diffused light is required, as discussed in the preceding
pages.
in
No
which directed
exact knowledge, however, exists on the proportion light and diffused light should be combined
nor how this proportion varies with the nature, color, etc., of surrounding objects, with the purpose of the illumination, etc. That it varies is well known, as for
for satisfactory illumination,
PHYSIOLOGICAL PROBLEMS.
279
seems best suited, while for other purposes mainly directed light seems more satisfactory. Furthermore, the relations between directed and diffused light have in the illuminating engineering practice been obscured to some extent by the relation between high and low intrinsic brilThus, to liancy and between direct and indirect lighting. eliminate the objectionable feature of high intrinsic brilliancy of
the illuminant, direct lighting
by
which was largely directed lighting, has been replaced by indirect lighting, by reflection from ceilings, etc., which is diffused lightWhere such change has resulted in a great improvement of ing. the illumination, it frequently has been attributed to the change from directed to diffused lighting, while in reality the improvement may have been due to the elimination of high brilliancy light sources from the field of vision, and engineers thereby led to the mistaken conclusion that perfectly diffused lighting is the preferable form. Again, in other instances such a change from direct to indirect lighting has not resulted in the expected improvement, but the indirect lighting been found physiologically unsatisfactory, and the conclusion drawn that the elimination of high brilliancy from the field of vision has not been beneficial, while in reality the dissatisfaction with the indirect light was due to the excess of diffused light and absence of directed light, and this improper proportion between directed and diffused light more than lost the advantage gained by eliminating the light In this case sources of high brilliancy from the field of vision. the proper arrangement would have been to reduce the brilliancy
of the light sources,
by
necessary directed light. Thus, in illuminating engineering, as in other sciences, it is very easy to draw erroneous conclusions from experience by attributing the results to a wrong cause. Any change in the
arrangement usually involves other changes: as in the above instance, the change from high to low brilliancy commonly causes a change from directed to diffused light; by attributing the results to a wrong cause, serious mistakes thus may be made
in basing further work on the results. 125. In discussing diffused light,
meaning
of "diffused light"
is
to
280
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
define diffused light as light which traverses the space in all directions and thus casts no shadow, is not correct, since even diffused
if
in Fig. 122
P is
the sur-
FIG. 122.
and
A a flat
circular
shade at distance
above
is as the ground, the intensity distribution of the light in plane shown in Fig. 122 for I = 0.2 } thus showing a fairly dark
shadow beneath the center of A, but a shadow which blurs so very gradually that with most objects it is not marked. The light from a single point source
is
in Fig. direction only, as shown as If we now enclose the point 123. source in an opal globe, which then
radiator, as discussed as before, diagrammatically shown as in Fig. 123, the light flux traverses
becomes the
each point not in a single direction but in all directions within a narrow angle
a,
which
is
the
radiator
With
and thus increasing angle a, C, Fig. 123, the pencil of rays, which traverses
point P, gradually spreads, until,
when
get perfectly to daylight. Hence, with a gradual change of the diameter of the illumdeg.,
FIG. 123.
a becomes 180
light,
we
diffused
similar
inant,
from a to a = 180 deg., the light gradually changes from directed to diffused light. Thus, no sharp dividing line
PHYSIOLOGICAL PROBLEMS.
can be drawn between directed
light,
281
and
the directed light from a light source of considerable diameter (that is, a diameter which is not neglible compared with the dis-
tance of the illuminated objects from the light) already has to some extent the character of diffused light. Diffused light thus may be defined as light given by a radiator which subtends a spherical angle equal to a considerable part of
the sphere. This makes the term "diffused light" a relative term. Near to a radiator of considerable size, the light given
distance
it is
inverse squares holds; but approaching the radiator so far that this law of inverse squares (flux density inverse proportional to the square of the distance) does not hold, the light approaches
somewhat the character of diffused light. The physiological effects, however, during a gradual change from a = 0, or directed light, to a = 180 deg. or diffused light, apparently do not change uniformly, but new effects appear and others disappear. 126. The main objection to directed light from a single source results from the absence of light in the shadows. Using, however, two or more illuminants, that is, combining directed light of several widely different directions, the shadow cast by one illuminant is illuminated by the other illuminants, and thus an Thus with two light effect produced very similar to diffusion. which both a at sources sources, at light point give the same illumination, the intensity in the shadow cast by one illuminant is still 50 per cent, that is, the illumination the same as if equal volumes of directed and of diffused light were combined, and
,
to a considerable extent the physiological effect is the same. It is not completely so, however. In the illumination by equal
volumes of diffused light and directed light from a single source, each object casts a single shadow, in which the illumination is reduced to half. When producing an equivalent diffusion by two light sources, an object casts two shadows, in which the illumination is reduced to half (if the two light sources give equal illumination), but, where the shadows overlap, a perfectly black and lightless shadow is produced. The more the two
282
half
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
shadows overlap to a complete shadow, the less the combination of the two light sources is equivalent to diffusion. At the same time, occasionally the existence of two or more half shadows and of their compound shadows may assist distinction, be advantageous. In short, there is a vast and and
largely
thereby of illumination, unexplored field in the physiology to have will study and investiwhich the illuminating engineer
gate.
While one point source of light gives directed light, two sources at distances from each other give an effect equivalent to diffusion, and three or more sources still more so, until in the theoretical case of an infinite number of point sources distributed
number of distribor, practically, a very large through space With a change diffusion. we buted illuminants get perfect of number a to illuminants, the illumifrom a single very large to directed from diffused, and thus, for nation thus changes
a moderate number of illuminants, directed and diffused, but nevertheless
is
intermediate between
different character from that given physiologically of entirely of illuminant very large diameter, that is large by a single
angle a, as discussed above. thus have true diffused light, as daylight, the equiva127. lent diffusion given by the combination of several light sources, which depends on their relative location, and the equivalent
We
diffusion given by a large relative diameter of the light source. The latter again varies with the shape of the light source, and in extreme cases, as a linear straight radiator, as a Geissler tube-
get an illumination which, at any point in one direction, and practically diffused of space, is practically In such at directed in a direction right angle to the former.
(Moore tube), we
may
again get different physiological phenomena. For a instance, a straight rod, held parallel to the radiator, casts held at when directed shadow right while, light sharp black With diffused light. angles to the radiator, it casts no shadow that the shape objects of more irregular shape, it can be seen
cases
we
and appearance of the shadows give a rather interesting problem, and the physiological impression made by such illumination thus is different again, from that of ordinary directed or diffused
light or their combination.
PHYSIOLOGICAL PROBLEMS.
283
physiological effect depends on the relative position of the light sources to the illuminated objects, irrespective of the intensity of illumination. Thus, for instance, in the illumination shown in
Fig. 117, cal effect
is
curve of
on the same curve of equal illumination, the physiologinot constant, but varies from point to point. On the 850 near the center of the room, an object casts four
shadows of approximately equal intensity, in different directions. The shadows are sufficiently marked to assist in seeing, and the illumination in the shadow is quite high; thus the illumithe same curve 850, near the shadows fall in nearly the same direction, only one is marked, and by the overlap of the shadows a large compound shadow is formed, in which the illumination is very low, distinction difficult, and the illumination thus unsatisfactory. Thus with the same physical value of illumination, on the same curve 850, the physiological effect in this case changes from a very satisfactory illumination at one place,
nation
On
to a quite unsatisfactory illumination at another place. Thus, in this instance, while the solution of the illuminating problem,
given in Fig. 117, is physically perfect, that is, the illumination very uniform throughout the entire room, and the efficiency high, physiologically the illumination is satisfactory only in the middle of the room, but becomes more and more unsatisfactory the further
light sources.
outside of the square formed by the four Physiologically the illumination would probably
we go
be improved by locating the light sources in the four corners of the ceiling, or in the centers of the four sides of the ceiling. Physically, this arrangement of lamps in the corners of the room would greatly reduce the efficiency, thus require either more power, or lower the average illumination; the arrangement of the lamps at the sides would decrease the efficiency less, but would considerably impair the uniformity of illumination, giving a lower illumination near the corners of the room.
Furthermore, in illuminating engineering, enters as an important and largely unknown factor, the effect on the physical &nd
physiological illumination, of
space,
and
of the observer ;
the objects in the illuminated that is, the light flux distribution
physiological effect, as depending on the location of light sources and distribution of their light flux through the illuminated space, is not sufficient to solve the problem of
and
its
284
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
to the changes illumination, but "consideration must be given For instance, in illumination. the of use from the resulting
for giving distinction in near the walls. nants, as it exists in a pronounced degree
from reflection from walls and and would be nearly sufficient the compound shadow of all four illumi-
Thus
even there the illumination would be moderately fair. Howillumination to see in the ever, when relying on this diffused the to close walls, it may not be present, or shadow of objects of the observer, since, as seen shadow the largely reduced by casts also shadows, though the blur at above, diffused light as to make them very little such is shadows these the edges of when noticeable. approaching close to the walls to look Thus, it shaded from the direct light and find we at an
object,
may
light, thus giving unsatisfactory the illumination. light sources in the corners or the Locating of the centers of the sides room, we get pronounced shadows of the objects located against the walls of the room, and thereby
in this case, physioagain unsatisfactory illumination, although the objects which without room the logically, considering merely be satisfactory. would illumination the in it, may be located still of illumination sacrifice to Thus we may have uniformity
further,
by arranging
room, and
density directed and of diffused light, and the direction of the directed is physiologically correct, because the changes resulting
light,
in the center of the ceiling. flux Thus, occasionally, illuminations designed for uniform the even are not satisfactory, proportion of though
illumination, are not sufficiently considered. 129. The cause of most of these difficulties in dealing with
not a illuminating problems is that, physiologically, light is combined cannot bo flux densities vector quantity; that is, light
by the parallelogram
law.
forces Fig. 124, acting on the the parallelogram law to a resultant
Two magnetomotive
C; that
is,
and B,
and
B is
PHYSIOLOGICAL PROBLEMS.
point
285
of space is perfectly characterized by two quantities the resultant intensity, (7, and its direction. only If, however, in Fig. 125, A and B represent the two light flux densities produced at point P by two light sources Lt
and
Z/ 2 ,
their physiological
and
may
be entirely different from that of one light flux combining A and B by the parallelogram law.
derived by
FIG. 124.
FIG. 125.
In some respects the action of the two separate flux densities and B is the same, or nearly the same, as that of a resultant
flux density C; the illumination of an opaque plane a, located so that both light sources and L2 are on the same side of the 1 If, however, the illuminated plane is transplane, is the same.
parent or translucent, and also in regard to the effects of polarization, reflection etc., the effect of the two separate flux densities
Entirely single resultant (7. the light sources Lj and L2 are on different sides of the plane. Thus, with a plane c located in the direction C, the resultant flux density C would give no illumination, while in reality by A and B both sides of the plane are Thus, with the plane in any direction fairly well illuminated.
differs
if
and
from that of a
a*
between
amount
in
any
it
PB,
receives
more
light
and PA it receives the same would receive from (7; but = ?r o>, between PA and from A and B than it would receive
PL
286
RADIATION, LIGHT,
(7,
AND ILLUMINATION.
infinitely
and receives
more
no
light in the
light from C). is, Within this angle T, both sides of the plane are illuminated by A and B, which obviously is never possible by a resultant
vector C.
In the illumination
tual illumination
result, if light
of
by A
a plane, the differences between the acand B and the illumination which would
intensity of illumination.
With an
however, the phenomenon becomes illumination of a sphere S by the resultant C would be as shown in Fig. 126, half the sphere dark, the other half light, and with a maximum intensity at c, shading off towards zero at the terminator mn. The actual illumination as shown in Fig. 127 gives a
FIG. 127.
black segment of angle w, while more than half the circumference of the sphere is illuminated. The maximum intensity is at the same place c, and of the same intensity as in Fig. 126 but
the total light flux received by the sphere is far greater than would be received from the resultant C, and is the sum of the Thus light fluxes received from the two light sources. In the illumination of a sphere the light flux densities are added, irrespective of their direction, and not vectorially com:
bined.
In the illumination of a plane, by light sources which all lie on the same side of the plane, the light flux densities are vectorially combined.
PHYSIOLOGICAL PROBLEMS.
With other shapes
densities.
287
As in general illumination for distinguishing objects we have to deal with all possible shapes, it thus follows that for the general problem of illumination the resultant effect is most nearly
related to the "total flux density or "total illumination" as derived by adding, irrespective of their direction, all the light flux densities, as was done in the preceding lectures when dealing
"
with light flux distribution. Only in special cases, as the illumination of a draughting table, the flux density in one particular " direction is of importance, and was used as the horizontal illumination" in the instance represented by Figs. 119 to -121. 130. While the resultant effect, or the total illumination, is derived by adding the flux densities irrespective of their direction, in the physiological effect, that is, the appearance, the direction plays an essential part. Thus a sphere located as in Fig. 127 looks different than it looks in Fig. 126, even if it receives the same total light flux. Still more marked is this difference with more complex shapes of the illuminated objects. Thus a landscape looks different with every different position of the sun in the sky, and different again in the diffused light of a cloudy day,
Under some irrespective of the intensity of the illumination. conditions sharp contrasts appear, where under other illuminations the appearance is flat, and with the change of illumination contrasts disappear in some places, appear in others, etc.; that is, the appearance of a complex body very greatly varies with
its
With
artificial
illumination
it
then
is
illuminating engineer to design the illumination so as to bring out contrasts where required by the purpose of the illumination, reduce them where too great or unnecessary, etc. If we consider
the possible personal equations of the user of the illumination as depending on his physical nature, occupation or state, furthermore the effect of the color of light and the marked physiological
effect which even slight variations in the color shade produce, it can be seen that the success of illuminating engineering problems still largely depends on the judgment of the designer, and this judgment is not yet guided by any extended exact experi-
288
RADIATION, LIGHT,
AND ILLUMINATION.
still
ence, thus rather uncertain. An enormous amount of work is " to be done mainly in the field of engineering physiology,"
same exactness
before the design of a system of illumination can approach the as for instance the design of long-distance trans-
INDEX.
PAGE
Absolute color in illumination Absorption of excess of light flux
of light
by body
spectrum
Acclimatization to radiation
Acetylene flame
standard
Acoustic scale of frequency Actual or objective color
Albedo of ceiling
radiator
reflector
walls
whiteness Allotropic modifications of carbon Alternating arc Alternating current field, frequency and wave length
as polarized
265 261 28 27 59 130 178 14 33 38 246 85 212, 215 246 30 81 114, 116, 125
.
.
17
wave
Amyl
acetate
lamp
spectrum
stability curve
stream
street illumination
as unidirectional conductor
289
290
INDEX.
139
Arc voltage curve ............................................... Area lighting ................................................... Armature reaction of arc machine ................................. Artificial illumination, domestic lighting .......................... ................ more harmful than daylight ................................... main arc arc starting Auxiliary
275
163 271
54
112
26
SI Base filament .................................................. Beam of searchlight, intensity .................................... 234 96 Biological phosphorescence ....................................... 32 Black ........................................................ 29 body ..................................................... radiation ............................................ 84, 88 134 of hydrocarbon flame ......................... 58 Blood, opaque for ultra-violet light ............................... 58 waves ............................ for light long transparent 51 Blue light, specific effect .......................................... 268 ............................. in illumination shadow of the Blurring
............................................... ..................................... Bolometer measuring radiation power .............................. Brightness of walls and ceiling in domestic lighting ................. Brilliancy and contraction of pupil ................................ of light sources ...................................... 256, objectionable effect ..................................... of radiator .......................................... 189, ........................... Brush, arc machine ..........
vision
54 78 166
270
262 259 263 221 163
101
170
48
123 124
Calculation of
..................................
247 238
128 186 258
177
INDEX.
Carbon, arc, incomplete rectification lamp as incandescent radiator not a typical arc
in street illumination
".
291
PAGE
117
76
109
236, 240
135
195 77
79
Cathode of arc
Ceiling, albedo
108
Change carbons
Characteristics of the arc
246 82 137
63 64 97 133 95 63 158 64 197 197 190 203 210 203 126 153 48 118 265 172 33
29, 31, 36
on plants
luminescence
of flame
phosphorescence
rays
Chimney
of luminous arc
lamp
Chlorophyl
Circular cylinder as radiator line as radiator
plane as radiator
shading circular radiator shading linear radiator radiator shaded by circular plane Circulating flame lamp Clutch of arc lamp Cold light Color change of light of arc
differences in illumination
photometry
Colored
body
lights,
comparison
radiation
radiator of
magnesium flame
Colorless
body
Color of light and economy
fatigue
street lighting
colored light
42 85 134 269 272 32 29, 31, 36 269 265 285 270 236 , 42
292
Comparison
INDEX.
of globes regarding light flux distribution
PAGE 224
232 202 209 215 260 269 98, 105 98 162 65 98, 105 26
illumination curves
radiators
and shadows
reflectors
Concentrated illumination
or local illumination
Conduction, continuous
disruptive
spectrum
Continuity of the arc at the cathode Contraction of pupil
Control of subjective color in illumination Core of arc flame
HI
38,
262 265
HO
101
Corona
Crater of the are as radiator
Crookes' radiometer
Cylindrical radiator
191 10
195
271 273
256,259
48, 57, 59
and
52 24 265 265
I 56
lamp
Diffracting globe and light flux distribution Diffraction grating and light distribution
223 26 221 26
267,269 251,266 246 279 278 280 223
281 221 281
iUumination
in indoor lighting
light, definition
and directed light, proportions shadow Diffusing globe and light flux distribution
Diffusion, equivalent and light distribution
280
267, 269
INDEX.
Directed light
293
PAGE
266 278 269 112
61
angle of direction Direct and indirect illumination Discontinuity of the arc at the anode
Disease germs, action of light Disinfecting action of light
Disruptive conduction
voltage
60 98 99 100 106
Distribution curve
and design
of incandescent
lamp
Downward
candle power
184
21
Ear as analytic organ Economies of flame arc lamp Efficiency and arc length
of illuminant
212
146 186 118, 122 74, 81 253 18 15
light production
light production
by arc by incandescence
room illumination
Electric waves, engineering importance
123 126
and vapors
98 95 198
32 148 160
Energy
from radiation
236 65 288
181 251
diffraction
294
Ether as
INDEX.
PAGE
carrier of energy form of matter
4
79
275
21
Eye perceiving
structure of
37
265 263 38 39
151 199
Fireworks
Flames as illuminants
Flicker photometer
Fluorescence
spectrum
Fluorescent bodies
of radiation
of radiation
and temperature
scale of acoustic
of ultra-violet radiation
Frosted globe
diffraction
96 98 158 212 123, 160 212 128 173 110 156 66, 94 27, 69 30 256, 259 13, 31 7 73 14 14 262 221
128 100
.
Gas flame
pressure and disruptive voltage
81 128
98
104 100
104
General illumination
or uniform illumination
260
German candle
269 178
INDEX.
Germicidal action of light
ultra-violet light as protection against ultra-violet light Globes, comparison of light distribution Glass,
295
PAGE
60
13 55 224 100
opaque for
Glow
of Geissler tube
Grey body
radiation
84,
Gypsum, transparent
Harmful
30 93 13 56 48
52
effect of light
on vegetation
radiation
violet
and
ultra-violet
Harmless radiation Harmlessness of artificial illuminants Harmonics of radiation Heat evaporation feeding arc Heat evaporation from positive terminal of arc
luminescence
at positive terminal of arc radiation
48 56 20
123
109
91, 93,
96
1
109
rays
Hefner lamp
Helium
Hemispherical candle power Hertzian waves, frequency and wave length High frequency currents, frequency and wave length
light,
63 178 78 185
16,
17 17
61
therapeutic action
Hollow
191
Holophane globe
Horizontal candle power of incandescent lamp illumination
of
room
:
intensity
of light
table illumination
262 258 226, 287 253 184 182 253 128 136
9 256 256 177, 179, 256, 259 226, 229 236 232
244 254
296
INDEX.
PAGE
226 261 260 234 262 253 226 226 227 253
31 76
"
Illumination, horizontal
objective
problems
of streets
by
arcs
lamp
uniform
vertical
photometry
Indirect
and
direct illumination
lighting
Integrating photometry
Interference
rings Intermediary color in
photometry
172
Intermediate carbon
International candle
Intrinsic brilliancy, see Brilliancy.
83 178
6 119
Iridescence
Iron arc
giving ultra-violet light Irregular reflection and light distribution
Irritation
by uniform
intensity of illumination
13 28 212 264
Kerosene lamp
Kirchhoff's law of radiation
128
85
151
177, 186, 256, 259
Lamps, arc
Light flux
INDEX.
Light flux, combination by addition comparison of radiators
density
distribution
297
PAGE
285 197 177, 256, 259 223 223 60 177, 186
166 17
distribution
by by
frosted globe
opal globe
as germicide
intensity
measurement
Lightning phenomena frequency and wave length Light not a vector quantity
as physiological effect
284 168 74
202, 209, 215
comparison
224
256, 259
as
wave motion
and wave length
8 274 177 6
136 17
16
Lime
by
circular flame
38
160 7
186
arc
Longitudinal vibration
Lumen
as unit of light flux
Luminescence
of arc
chemical
of flame
257 94 117 97
133
91
43, 174
by heat
Luminometer
chart
175
123, 160
Luminous arc
distribution
efficiency
lamp
radiator
149 157
195
298
Luminous arc
INDEX.
PAGE
in street illumination
240
129
flame
Magnesium flame
Magnetite arc
constants
distribution
in street lighting
Maximum
Mean
candle power
visibility
46
180, 184, 257
spherical intensity
of light
Measurement
and radiation
Mechanism
Mercury
of arc
lamp
166 42 152
77
140, 145
123
13
117 114
165 195
180, 188
rectifier
Methane
Mica opaque for Micron
ultra-violet light
56 125 81 31 128
13
61
Minimum
Mirror
visible
amount
of light
reflector
and
light distribution
203
107, 110, 125
108 4
75,
84
INDEX.
Objects, effect on light distribution Objective or actual color
color in illumination
299
PAGE
283 33 265 261 283
14
illumination
lamp
diffusion
128
Opal globe
and nature
of
shadow
Opaque
body
colors
Osmium lamp
Overlap of light fluxes in illumination Oxygen in flame
148 160 17 79
267
132
Ozone production by
Paraffme candle
ultra-violet light
64
131
171
light flux
284
61
57 178
efficiency
Pentane lamp Periodic system of elements and radiation Permeability and refractive index
Physical phosphorescence Physiological effect of sensation
in light
measurement
measure of
light
problems of illumination
illuminating engineering
unit of light
Phosphorescence Photography
63
169
61
59
286 190 64
189 187
300
Polarized
INDEX.
PAGE
wave
Anode.
109
Power burn
effect of radiation
Problems of illumination
Protection against ultra-violet light Protective device of arc lamp
mechanism
Protoplasm,
effect of radiation
of light
262 60 96 90 269
31
13
1
,
Radiant heat
Radiation efficiency
as a form of energy measurement measured as power
86
1
power
also see Light.
166 166 72
202, 209
Radiators, comparison
of light
Radio-luminescence
187 135 14 95 95 95 61 58 17
*
by
arcs
Red fluorescence
light,
chemical action of
*
62 120
INDEX.
Red mercury
arc
301
PAGE
121
Reduction factor of incandescent lamp Reflected light from walls and ceiling, calculation
Reflection affecting light distribution
Reflectors, comparison
Refraction law
and
light distribution
spectroscope
Refractive index
and
refraction
182 250 212 28 215 219 215 212 215 23 221 25 23 24 24 126 28, 215 224
164 27
Room illumination,
Rounded
calculation
by incandescent lamp
circular surface as radiator
82 247 242
193
Sand blasted
Saprophytic
globe, diffraction
bacilli, effect of light
221
and frequency
maximum,
Series arc
lamp
of arc lighting
system
Shadow
blurring of, in illumination of diffused light
in illuminating engineering of negative carbon
of negative terminal of arc
number
of
60 234 212, 216 87 43, 47 263 40 54 46 135 157 162 202 268 280 266 203 148 268 266
302
Shadow photometer
INDEX.
PACKS
171
273 269
HO
,
effect
160 52
257 98
78
199
Smoky
Sound
flame
as longitudinal vibration
130 1 29
8 17
1
Spark voltage
radiation Specific effects of high frequency arc of Spectrum
51
US
108
by
diffraction
26 134 96 17 25 287
189 ISO
by
refraction
lamp
182
142, 144
143
142
Standard candle
Starting of arc
170 106
112
151
151
151
70,
75
57, 59
by
arcs
INDEX.
Subjective color, contrpl in illumination illumination
303
PAGE 265
262 135 59 27 17 54 65 253
59 80 108 79 73 74 89 70 128 84 178
61
Sulphur flame
wave length
Table illumination
and frequency
of
of radiation
maximum
law of standard
Therapeutic use of light
effects of radiation
57
Titanium
arc,
white
carbide arcs
Total illumination
of
room
Tower
253 274
112.
18 31
Transparent
body
color
Transversal vibration
Tungsten lamp
as refractory element Also see Wolfram.
28 32 31 31, 32, 36 7 80 78
109
12
Typical arc
Ultra-red rays
14, 17
304
Ultra-violet arc
INDEX.
PAGE
lamp
wireless telegraphy
12
burn burn in
iron arc
lamp
light of arc
light light
and
fluorescence
effect
harmful
therapeutic action
radiation, frequency
rays
frequency and wave length Unidirectional conduction of electric arc Uniform distribution illumination curve
or general illumination illumination
'
in street lighting
Uniform and
local illumination
total illumination
Vacuum
arc
of the arc
:
,.
Vapor pressure
4 2
,
in a
medium
Vertical illumination
*.
23 227 52 52 177
221 216 17 10 168 14 74 37 90
Virtual radiator
and
reflector
power measurement
range
and temperature
Visibility range of radiation
Visual pyrometers
Wails, albedo
Warm
light
240 48
INDEX.
"Waste of light flux
805
PAGE
261
31
6 10 92, 136 32 29
Water
as
Wave
body
iron arc
Whiteness or albedo
Willemite fluorescence
Wireless telegraph waves, frequency and
ultra-violet
119 30
13
wave length
15,
burn
17 54
Wolfram
as refractory element
77
also see
Tungsten.
14,
17
58
56
140 117
362'